SPF: fix the explanation URL
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.92"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552018, 2019
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.cindex "documentation"
375This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378capable of showing a change indicator.
379
380This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
387very wide interest.
388
389.cindex "books about Exim"
390An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
394
395The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
399
400.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402Debian-specific features in the file
403&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
405information.
406
407.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
409.cindex "change log"
410As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
415
416Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
420
421All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
423
424.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427directory are:
428
429.table2 100pt
430.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
438.endtable
439
440The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
443
444
445
446.section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
447.cindex "website"
448.cindex "FTP site"
449The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
452
453.cindex "wiki"
454.cindex "FAQ"
455As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
462
463.cindex Bugzilla
464An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
468
469
470.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472The following Exim mailing lists exist:
473
474.table2 140pt
475.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
479.endtable
480
481You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
486via this web page:
487.display
488&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
489.endd
490Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
491lists.
492
493.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494.cindex "bug reports"
495.cindex "reporting bugs"
496Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
500
501
502
503.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
504.cindex "FTP site"
505.cindex "HTTPS download site"
506.cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507.cindex "distribution" "https site"
508The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
509.display
510&url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
511.endd
512The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
514
515The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
518
519If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522here are top-level directories.
523
524There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531.display
532&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
533&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535.endd
536where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539most portable to old systems.
540
541.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542.cindex "distribution" "public key"
543.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550&_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
552
553At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
557
558The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
559.display
560&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
563.endd
564For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
567
568.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
572.display
573&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577.endd
578These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
580
581
582.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
583.ilist
584.cindex "limitations of Exim"
585.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
591.next
592.cindex "domainless addresses"
593.cindex "address" "without domain"
594Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
598arrival.
599.next
600.cindex "transport" "external"
601.cindex "external transports"
602The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
608.next
609Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
612other means.
613.next
614Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618a number of common scanners are provided.
619.endlist
620
621
622.section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
628
629
630.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6393, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
642
643Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646interface to Exim's command line administration options.
647
648
649
650.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651.cindex "terminology definitions"
652.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655below) by a blank line.
656
657.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664rise to further bounce messages.
665
666The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
669otherwise.
670
671The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
674until a later time.
675
676The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678the part of an email address following the @ sign.
679
680.cindex "envelope, definition of"
681.cindex "sender" "definition of"
682A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
688
689.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690.cindex "header section" "definition of"
691The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
695line.
696
697.cindex "local part" "definition of"
698.cindex "domain" "definition of"
699The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
702
703.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708host it is running on are &'remote'&.
709
710.cindex "return path" "definition of"
711&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
712message's envelope.
713
714.cindex "queue" "definition of"
715The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718normally no ordering of waiting messages.
719
720.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
725
726.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
732
733
734
735
736
737
738. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740
741.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742.cindex "incorporated code"
743.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
744.cindex "PCRE"
745.cindex "OpenDMARC"
746A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
747
748.ilist
749Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
755.next
756.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761following statements:
762
763.blockquote
764Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
765
766This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
769version.
770This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774restrictions applied to it).
775.endblockquote
776.next
777.cindex "SPA authentication"
778.cindex "Samba project"
779.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
783under the Gnu GPL.
784.next
785.cindex "Cyrus"
786.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791conditions expressed therein.
792
793.blockquote
794Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
795
796Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
798are met:
799
800.olist
801Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
803.next
804Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
807distribution.
808.next
809The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812details, please contact
813.display
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
816 5000 Forbes Avenue
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
820.endd
821.next
822Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
823acknowledgment:
824
825&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
827
828CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
835.endlist
836.endblockquote
837
838.next
839.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
840.cindex "X-windows"
841.cindex "Athena"
842The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
846
847.blockquote
848Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
850
851All Rights Reserved
852
853Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859software without specific, written prior permission.
860
861DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
867SOFTWARE.
868.endblockquote
869
870.next
871.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
876source code.
877
878.next
879Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
882.endlist
883
884
885
886
887
888. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890
891.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
893
894
895.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896.cindex "design philosophy"
897Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
903
904
905.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906.cindex "policy control" "overview"
907Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
912
913.ilist
914.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
923error code.
924.next
925An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
927.next
928When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
932.next
933When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
938.next
939Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
942.next
943After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945runs at the start of every delivery process.
946.endlist
947
948
949
950.section "User filters" "SECID12"
951.cindex "filter" "introduction"
952.cindex "Sieve filter"
953In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958of filtering are available:
959
960.ilist
961Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
962by RFC 3028.
963.next
964Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
966.endlist
967
968User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
969
970
971
972.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974.cindex "format" "of message id"
975.cindex "id of message"
976.cindex "base62"
977.cindex "base36"
978.cindex "Darwin"
979.cindex "Cygwin"
980Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987not always case-sensitive.
988
989.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
995somewhat eccentric:
996
997.ilist
998The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001way of representing the date and time of day).
1002.next
1003After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004received the message.
1005.next
1006There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1007.olist
1008.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1013.next
1014If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016(1/100) of a second.
1017.endlist
1018.endlist
1019
1020After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1025
1026
1027.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028.cindex "receiving mail"
1029.cindex "message" "reception"
1030The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033there are several possibilities:
1034
1035.ilist
1036If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1039.next
1040If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1046.next
1047If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1052.next
1053A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1057.endlist
1058
1059
1060.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072users to change sender addresses.
1073
1074Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076(either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1081
1082Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087message is received.
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1101
1102.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111affect file system performance.
1112
1113The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1118
1119.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1131
1132
1133
1134.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135.cindex "message" "life of"
1136.cindex "message" "frozen"
1137A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1143
1144.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1149to be sent.
1150
1151.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1156
1157.cindex "message" "log file for"
1158.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1167systems.
1168
1169.cindex "journal file"
1170.cindex "file" "journal"
1171All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178minimize the possibility of data loss.
1179
1180Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184deliveries caused by crashes.
1185
1186
1187
1188.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190.cindex "router" "definition of"
1191.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1197
1198.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206the driver's features in general.
1207
1208A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1212to be bounced.
1213
1214A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1220
1221.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1227
1228To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1231configuration.
1232
1233The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241configured to fail the address.
1242
1243The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1249
1250The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255the address is bounced.
1256
1257
1258
1259.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260.cindex "router" "for verification"
1261.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266&%-bvs%& command line options.
1267
1268When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281.cindex "router" "running details"
1282.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283.cindex "router" "result of running"
1284As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1288the following:
1289
1290.ilist
1291&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293original address ceases
1294.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1299end of routing.
1300
1301Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1306.next
1307&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1312.next
1313&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1318.next
1319&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1322.next
1323&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326next time the message is considered for delivery.
1327.next
1328&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1330.endlist
1331
1332If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1337
1338Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342facility for this purpose.
1343
1344
1345.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346.cindex "case of local parts"
1347.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353routed addresses are shown.
1354
1355
1356
1357.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1363
1364.ilist
1365.cindex affix "router precondition"
1366The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371of any other conditions.
1372.next
1373Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376address.
1377Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382.next
1383If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388.next
1389Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392.next
1393Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395.next
1396If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397of domains that it defines.
1398.next
1399.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402.cindex affix "router precondition"
1403If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410.next
1411.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413.vindex "&$home$&"
1414If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418remaining preconditions.
1419.next
1420If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424could lead to confusion.
1425.next
1426If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427set of addresses that it defines.
1428.next
1429If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430specified files is tested.
1431.next
1432.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1436.endlist
1437
1438
1439Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1446
1447
1448
1449.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452
1453.ilist
1454If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459filtering'&.
1460.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462
1463Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469filter.
1470.next
1471Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475processed entirely independently of each other.
1476.next
1477.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486.next
1487When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494addresses to the same domain.
1495.next
1496Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504.next
1505.cindex "queue runner"
1506When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515.next
1516.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522.next
1523If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526messages to other addresses.
1527.next
1528.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531&'deferred'&.
1532.next
1533When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1536.endlist
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544.cindex "queue runner"
1545Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552passed its retry time.
1553You can run several queue runners at once.
1554
1555Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1560as permanent.
1561
1562
1563
1564.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573also apply.
1574
1575If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578deferred,
1579.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1584one connection.
1585
1586
1587
1588.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599
1600.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603automatically.
1604
1605.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1612of the list.
1613
1614
1615
1616.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631
1632.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634
1635.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639
1640.table2 140pt
1641.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 documented"
1644.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1648 instructions"
1649.endtable
1650
1651Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652following subdirectories are created:
1653
1654.table2 140pt
1655.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662.endtable
1663
1664The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666that may be useful to some sites.
1667
1668
1669.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675system.
1676.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680overridden if necessary.
1681.cindex compiler requirements
1682.cindex compiler version
1683A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1684
1685
1686.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687.cindex "PCRE library"
1688Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696If your operating system has no
1697PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729possibilities:
1730
1731.olist
1732A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734.next
1735.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739filename is used unmodified.
1740.next
1741.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745.next
1746If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749.next
1750To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17522.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756page with far newer versions listed.
1757It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759suited to Exim's usage model.
1760.next
1761.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764operates on a single file.
1765.endlist
1766
1767.cindex "USE_DB"
1768.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1773.code
1774USE_DB=yes
1775.endd
1776Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1778
1779At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1785
1786As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788in one of these lines:
1789.code
1790DBMLIB = -ldb
1791DBMLIB = -ltdb
1792.endd
1793Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1797this example:
1798.code
1799INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1801.endd
1802There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1804
1805
1806
1807.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1819
1820There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1826
1827There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1833be logged.
1834
1835.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838facilities, you need to set
1839.code
1840WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1841.endd
1842in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1844
1845
1846.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1853
1854This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1859do this.
1860
1861
1862
1863.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1865.cindex "RFC 2047"
1866The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1873
1874However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1879.code
1880HAVE_ICONV=yes
1881.endd
1882to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1883
1884
1885
1886.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1890.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1891Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1892command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1893start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1894&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1895line option).
1896
1897If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1898OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1899implementing SSL.
1900
1901.new
1902If you do not want TLS support you should set
1903.code
1904DISABLE_TLS=yes
1905.endd
1906in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1907.wen
1908
1909If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1910.code
1911USE_OPENSL=yes
1912TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1913.endd
1914in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1915OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1916.code
1917USE_OPENSL=yes
1918TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1919TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1920.endd
1921.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1922If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1923.code
1924USE_OPENSL=yes
1925USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1926.endd
1927.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1928If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1929.code
1930USE_GNUTLS=yes
1931TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1932.endd
1933in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1934library and include files. For example:
1935.code
1936USE_GNUTLS=yes
1937TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1938TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1939.endd
1940.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1941If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1942.code
1943USE_GNUTLS=yes
1944USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1945.endd
1946
1947You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1948specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1949given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1955
1956.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1957.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1958.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1959.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1960Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1961SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1962alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1963already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1964should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1965&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1966&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1967EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1968you might have
1969.code
1970USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1971CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1972EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1973.endd
1974in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1975files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1976.code
1977exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1978.endd
1979in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1980the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1981All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1982can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1983&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1984configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1985further details.
1986
1987
1988.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1989.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1990Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1991&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1992it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1993where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1994library files.
1995
1996Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1997defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1998currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1999as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2000over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2001Exim used to
2002have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003withdrawn.
2004
2005
2006
2007.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2008.cindex "lookup modules"
2009.cindex "dynamic modules"
2010.cindex ".so building"
2011On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2012the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2013on demand.
2014This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2015library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2016dependencies.
2017Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2018
2019Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2020installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2021measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2022for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2023Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2024see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2025
2026Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2027&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2028For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2029on demand:
2030.code
2031LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2032LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2033LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2034.endd
2035
2036
2037.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2038.cindex "build directory"
2039Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2040created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2041operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2042For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2043&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2044.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2045Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2046
2047If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2048a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2049&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2050&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2051then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2052number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2053makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2054directory, should this ever be necessary.
2055
2056If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2057&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2058FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2059
2060
2061
2062.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2063The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2064unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2065output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2066appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2067each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2068get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2069.code
2070FULLECHO='' make -e
2071.endd
2072The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2073command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2074given in addition to the short output.
2075
2076
2077
2078.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2079.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2080The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2081consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2082values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2083more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2084convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2085order:
2086.display
2087&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2089&_Local/Makefile_&
2090&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2091&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2092&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2093&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2094.endd
2095.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2096.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2097.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2098where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2099architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2100process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2101and are often not needed.
2102
2103The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2104called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2105the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2106values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2107Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2108fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2109of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2110that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2111to find out what values are being used on your system.
2112
2113
2114&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2115therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2116needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2117file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2118default values are.
2119
2120
2121.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2122If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2123or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2124need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2125putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2126.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2127when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2128formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2129compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2130called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2131Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2132default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2133containing the lines
2134.code
2135CC=cc
2136CFLAGS=-std1
2137.endd
2138If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2139these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2140
2141Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2142files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2143the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2144
2145
2146.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2147.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2148.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2149.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2150Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2151lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2152not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2153and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2154which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2155case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2156.code
2157LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2158LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2159LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2160.endd
2161and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2162&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2163libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2164.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2165However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2166the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2167files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2168binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2169errors.
2170
2171.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2172.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2173Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2174about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2175being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2176makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2177variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2178name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2179&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2180with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2181syntax. For instance:
2182.code
2183LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2184LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2185AUTH_GSASL=yes
2186AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2187AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2188AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2189.endd
2190
2191.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2192Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2193subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2194.code
2195EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2196.endd
2197must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2198chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2199
2200.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2201The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2202operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2203with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2204monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2205The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2206.code
2207X11=/usr/X11R6
2208XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2209XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2210.endd
2211These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2212example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2213.code
2214X11=/usr/openwin
2215XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2216XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2217.endd
2218If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2219definition of all three of these variables into your
2220&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2221
2222.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2223If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2224variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2225default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2226command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2227
2228.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2229There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2230use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2231EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2232binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2233libraries.
2234
2235.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2236The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2237files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2238necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2239&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2240
2241
2242.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2243.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2244.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2245The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2246&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2247normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2248recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2249are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2250
2251
2252
2253.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2254.cindex "building Eximon"
2255A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2256where the files that are involved are
2257.display
2258&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2259&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2260&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2261&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2262&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2263&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2264.endd
2265.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2266As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2267&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2268&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2269variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2270EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2271LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2272.ecindex IIDbuex
2273
2274
2275.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2276.cindex "installing Exim"
2277.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2278The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2279arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2280whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2281.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2282The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2283going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2284&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2285install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2286some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2287it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2288chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2289
2290.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2291Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2292in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2293exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2294by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2295is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2296alternative files, no default is installed.
2297
2298.cindex "system aliases file"
2299.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2300One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2301default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2302The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2303SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2304If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2305and outputs a comment to the user.
2306
2307The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2308aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2309kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2310&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2311Exim's configuration if necessary.
2312
2313The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2314and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2315running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2316directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2317other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2318over SMTP.
2319
2320It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2321distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2322command such as
2323.code
2324make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2325.endd
2326This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2327paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2328configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2329For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2330but this usage is deprecated.
2331
2332.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2333Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2334&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2335upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2336directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2337INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2338
2339For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2340to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2341installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2342for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2343called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2344of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2345from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2346
2347.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2348If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2349real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2350command:
2351.code
2352make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2353.endd
2354The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2355script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2356the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2357directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2358command:
2359.code
2360(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2361.endd
2362.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2363There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2364
2365.ilist
2366&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2367to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2368.next
2369&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2370installed binary.
2371.endlist
2372
2373INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2374.code
2375make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2376.endd
2377The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2378to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2379without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2380.code
2381make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382.endd
2383
2384
2385
2386.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2387.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2388Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2389reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2390distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2391&<<SECTavail>>&).
2392
2393If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2394source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2395install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2396
2397
2398
2399.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2400.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2401When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2402exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2403directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2404necessary.
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2410.cindex "testing" "installation"
2411Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2412syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2413Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2414.code
2415exim -bV
2416.endd
2417If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2418Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2419the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2420other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2421Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2422example,
2423.display
2424&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2425.endd
2426should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2427.display
2428&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2429.endd
2430a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2431This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2432user agent. For example:
2433.code
2434exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2435From: user@your.domain.example
2436To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2437Subject: Testing Exim
2438
2439This is a test message.
2440^D
2441.endd
2442The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2443In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2444arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2445
2446.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2447If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2448&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2449of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2450&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2451with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2452.display
2453&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2454.endd
2455You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2456produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2457For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2458relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2459&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2460
2461.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2462.cindex "lock files"
2463One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2464local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2465&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2466writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2467is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2468directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2469that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2470&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2471approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2472&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2473agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2474see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2475
2476One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2477the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2478&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2479port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2480&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2481incoming SMTP mail.
2482
2483Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2484be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2485within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2486that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2487production version.
2488
2489
2490.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2491.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2492Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2493general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2494is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2495operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2496binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2497normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2498or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2499.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2500a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2501privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2502and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2503
2504.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2505.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2506Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2507example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2508&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2509described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2510as follows:
2511.code
2512sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2513send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2514mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2515newaliases /usr/bin/true
2516.endd
2517Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2518your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2519favourite user agent.
2520
2521You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2522have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2523various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2524command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2525use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2526&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2527
2528
2529
2530.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2531.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2532If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2533version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2534call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2535.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2536.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2537to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2538new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2539version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2540configuration file.
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2546.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2547The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2548.code
2549/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2550.endd
2551If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2552fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2553for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2554(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2555solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2556.code
2557pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2558.endd
2559to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2560
2561Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2562still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2563(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2569. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2570
2571.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2572.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2573.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2574Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2575each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2576options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2577some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2578combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2579The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2580
2581
2582.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2583.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2584If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2585were present before any other options.
2586The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2587standard output.
2588This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2589that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2590&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2591
2592.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2593If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2594were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2595&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2596format.
2597
2598.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2599If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2600&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2601Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2602
2603.cindex "&'runq'&"
2604.cindex "queue runner"
2605If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2606were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2607option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2608
2609.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2610.cindex "alias file" "building"
2611.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2612If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2613&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2614This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2615the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2616command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2617
2618
2619.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2620Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2621available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2622user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2623EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2624&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2625
2626.ilist
2627.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2628.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2629The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2630&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2631supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2632configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2633
2634.cindex '&"From"& line'
2635.cindex "envelope from"
2636.cindex "envelope sender"
2637Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2638&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2639Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2640See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2641users to set envelope senders.
2642
2643.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2644.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2645.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2646.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2647For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2648header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2649&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2650
2651Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2652protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2653locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2654have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2655users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2656that are available to trusted users.
2657.next
2658.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2659.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2660The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2661Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2662The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2663
2664Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2665operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2666necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2667the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2668
2669By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2670Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2671However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2672option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2673
2674Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2675is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2676false.
2677.endlist
2678
2679
2680&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2681edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2682getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2683&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2689Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2690of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2691a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2692format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2693on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2694with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2695outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2696
2697. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2699. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2700. creates a man page for the options.
2701. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2702
2703.literal xml
2704<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2705.literal off
2706
2707
2708.vlist
2709.vitem &%--%&
2710.oindex "--"
2711.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2712This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2713therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2714rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2715
2716.vitem &%--help%&
2717.oindex "&%--help%&"
2718This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2719The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2720no arguments.
2721
2722.vitem &%--version%&
2723.oindex "&%--version%&"
2724This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2725displayed.
2726
2727.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2728 &%-Am%&
2729.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2730.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2731These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2732ignored by Exim.
2733
2734.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2735.oindex "&%-B%&"
2736.cindex "8-bit characters"
2737.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2738This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2739clean; it ignores this option.
2740
2741.vitem &%-bd%&
2742.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2743.cindex "daemon"
2744.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2745.cindex "queue runner"
2746This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2747the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2748that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2749
2750The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2751(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2752disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2753stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2754
2755By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2756all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2757ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2758&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2759
2760When a listening daemon
2761.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2762.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2763is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2764configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2765in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2766PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2767running as root.
2768
2769When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2770process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2771used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2772
2773The SIGHUP signal
2774.cindex "SIGHUP"
2775.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2776.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2777.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2778.cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2779.cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2780.cindex reload configuration
2781can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2782whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2783means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2784of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2785referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2786because these are reread each time they are used.
2787
2788.vitem &%-bdf%&
2789.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2790This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2791from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2792
2793.vitem &%-be%&
2794.oindex "&%-be%&"
2795.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2796.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2797Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2798prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2799files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2800of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2801
2802If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2803to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2804used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2805function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2806test data. A line history is supported.
2807
2808Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2809continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2810continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2811string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2812configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2813message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2814is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2815
2816&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2817files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2818the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2819of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2820
2821Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2822defined and macros will be expanded.
2823Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2824available to admin users.
2825
2826.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2828.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2829.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2830This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2831of a file. For example:
2832.code
2833exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2834.endd
2835The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2836message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2837variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2838no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2839recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2840&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2841line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2842&%-be%&).
2843
2844.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2845.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2846.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2847.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2848This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2849tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2850system filters are recognized.
2851
2852.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2853.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2854.cindex "filter" "testing"
2855.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2856.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2857.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2858.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2859This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2860to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2861there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2862supplied.
2863
2864If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2865can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2866filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2867.code
2868exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2869.endd
2870This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2871variables that are used by the user filter.
2872
2873If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2874.code
2875# Exim filter
2876# Sieve filter
2877.endd
2878it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2879that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2880&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2881redirection lists.
2882
2883The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2884detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2885with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2886separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2887
2888When testing a filter file,
2889.cindex "&""From""& line"
2890.cindex "envelope from"
2891.cindex "envelope sender"
2892.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2893the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2894or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2895that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2896can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2897options).
2898
2899.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2900.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2901.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2902This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2903tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2904&$qualify_domain$&.
2905
2906.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2907.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2908This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2909tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2910process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2911suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2912actually being delivered.
2913
2914.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2915.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2916.cindex affix "filter testing"
2917This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2918file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2919prefix.
2920
2921.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2922.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2923.cindex affix "filter testing"
2924This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2925file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2926suffix.
2927
2928.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2929.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2930.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2931.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2932.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2933.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2934.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2935.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2936This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2937standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2938after a full stop. For example:
2939.code
2940exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2941exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2942.endd
2943When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2944of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2945conversion to the canonical form is
2946&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2947
2948Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2949include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2950This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2951messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2952test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2953
2954&*Warning 1*&:
2955.cindex "RFC 1413"
2956You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2957information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2958an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2959connection.
2960
2961&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2962are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2963occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2964
2965Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2966written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2967lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2968can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2969and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2970session were authenticated.
2971
2972The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2973output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2974acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2975
2976Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2977plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2978specialized SMTP test program such as
2979&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2980
2981.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2982.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2983This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2984verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2985updating the callout cache database.
2986
2987.vitem &%-bi%&
2988.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2989.cindex "alias file" "building"
2990.cindex "building alias file"
2991.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2992Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2993Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2994this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2995tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2996recognized.
2997
2998If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2999configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3000the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3001The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3002use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3003if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3004&%-bi%& is a no-op.
3005
3006. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3007.vitem &%-bI:help%&
3008.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3009.cindex "querying exim information"
3010We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3011information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3012consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3013synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3014options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3015
3016.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3017.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3018.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3019This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3020recognised DSCP names.
3021
3022.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3023.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3024.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3025This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3026Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3027useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3028&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3029compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3030way to guarantee a correct response.
3031
3032.vitem &%-bm%&
3033.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3034.cindex "local message reception"
3035This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3036locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3037command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3038argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3039default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3040if no other conflicting option is present.
3041
3042If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3043qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3044options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3045suppressing this for special cases.
3046
3047Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3048the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3049
3050.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3051The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3052action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3053
3054The format
3055.cindex "message" "format"
3056.cindex "format" "message"
3057.cindex "&""From""& line"
3058.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3059.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3060of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3061compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3062.code
3063From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3064From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3065.endd
3066(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3067is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3068authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3069matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3070option, which can be changed if necessary.
3071
3072.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3073The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3074&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3075preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3076trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3077
3078.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3079.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3080.cindex "testing", "malware"
3081.cindex "malware scan test"
3082This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3083(depending on the used scanner interface),
3084using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3085this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3086the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3087not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3088will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3089
3090Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3091using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3092user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3093This option requires admin privileges.
3094
3095The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3096there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3097administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3098
3099.vitem &%-bnq%&
3100.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3101.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3102By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3103without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3104is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3105envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3106&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3107defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3108
3109Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3110being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3111content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3112header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3113syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3114
3115The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3116messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3117addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3118unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3119
3120
3121.vitem &%-bP%&
3122.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3123.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3124.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3125If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3126main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3127of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3128arguments, for example:
3129.code
3130exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3131.endd
3132.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3133.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3134.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3135However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3136configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3137users, the output is as in this example:
3138.code
3139mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3140.endd
3141If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3142output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3143
3144If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3145configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3146backward compatibility.)
3147If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3148is the name of the file that was actually used.
3149
3150.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3151If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3152name will not be output.
3153
3154.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3155.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3156If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3157directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3158respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3159sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3160written directly into the spool directory.
3161
3162If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3163.code
3164exim -bP +local_domains
3165.endd
3166it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3167local part) and outputs what it finds.
3168
3169.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3170.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3171.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3172If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3173followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3174that driver are output. For example:
3175.code
3176exim -bP transport local_delivery
3177.endd
3178The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3179options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3180using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3181&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3182settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3183&%authenticators%&.
3184
3185.cindex "environment"
3186If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3187variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3188variables.
3189
3190.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3191If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3192are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3193for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3194The output format is one item per line.
3195For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3196the exit status will be nonzero.
3197
3198.vitem &%-bp%&
3199.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3200.cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3201.cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3202This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3203standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3204just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3205admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3206to allow any user to see the queue.
3207
3208Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3209.code
321025m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3211 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3212 <other addresses>
3213.endd
3214.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3215.cindex "size" "of message"
3216The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3217(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3218identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3219envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3220&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3221the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3222before the sender address.
3223
3224.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3225If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3226&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3227
3228The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3229displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3230been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3231expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3232displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3233complete.
3234
3235
3236.vitem &%-bpa%&
3237.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3238This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3239that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3240alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3241of just &"D"&.
3242
3243
3244.vitem &%-bpc%&
3245.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3246.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3247This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3248to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3249&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3250
3251
3252.vitem &%-bpr%&
3253.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3254This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3255chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3256lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3257going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3258
3259.vitem &%-bpra%&
3260.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3261This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3262
3263.vitem &%-bpru%&
3264.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3265This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3266
3267
3268.vitem &%-bpu%&
3269.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3270This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3271addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3272forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3273router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3274
3275
3276.vitem &%-brt%&
3277.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3278.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3279.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3280This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3281arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3282and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3283.code
3284exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3285Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3286.endd
3287See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3288argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3289&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3290contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3291retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3292with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3293rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3294sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3295used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3296.code
3297exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3298Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3299.endd
3300
3301.vitem &%-brw%&
3302.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3303.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3304.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3305This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3306a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3307complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3308would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3309&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3310
3311.vitem &%-bS%&
3312.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3313.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3314.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3315This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3316for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3317submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3318input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3319input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3320&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3321believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3322
3323The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3324dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3325provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3326
3327As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3328messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3329Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3330&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3331
3332Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3333as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3334QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3335
3336.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3337If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3338error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3339was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3340was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3341
3342More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3343&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3344
3345.vitem &%-bs%&
3346.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3347.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3348.cindex "local SMTP input"
3349This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3350on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3351policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3352Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3353messages to the MTA.
3354
3355In
3356.cindex "sender" "source of"
3357this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3358set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3359Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3360the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3361&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3362&%-bnq%& option is used.
3363
3364.cindex "inetd"
3365The
3366&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3367using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3368whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3369&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3370above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3371Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3372the listening daemon.
3373
3374.vitem &%-bt%&
3375.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3376.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3377.cindex "address" "testing"
3378This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3379as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3380written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3381user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3382sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3383
3384If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3385right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3386
3387Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3388&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3389security issues.
3390
3391Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3392(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3393written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3394&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3395genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3396program.
3397
3398.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3399The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3400failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3401code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3402
3403.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3404&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3405addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3406This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3407always shown.
3408
3409&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3410routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3411message,
3412.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3413you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3414&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3415default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3416whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3417those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3418doing such tests.
3419
3420.vitem &%-bV%&
3421.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3422.cindex "version number of Exim"
3423This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3424number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3425It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3426specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3427name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3428
3429As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3430configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3431values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3432detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3433alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3434realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3435dynamic testing facilities.
3436
3437.vitem &%-bv%&
3438.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3439.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3440.cindex "address" "verification"
3441This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3442taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3443not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3444happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3445(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3446including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3447
3448If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3449failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3450usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3451
3452If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3453right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3454
3455Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3456&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3457security issues.
3458
3459Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3460that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3461router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3462verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3463address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3464
3465If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3466address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3467latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3468causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3469addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3470and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3471to succeed.
3472
3473When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3474and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3475considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3476
3477The
3478.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3479return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3480failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3481code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3482
3483If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3484address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3485sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3486calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3487
3488.vitem &%-bvs%&
3489.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3490This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3491than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3492might happen.
3493
3494.vitem &%-bw%&
3495.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3496.cindex "daemon"
3497.cindex "inetd"
3498.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3499This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3500similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3501and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3502
3503In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3504listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3505inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3506each port only when the first connection is received.
3507
3508If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3509which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3510
3511.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3512.oindex "&%-C%&"
3513.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3514.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3515.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3516This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3517list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3518compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3519but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3520file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3521proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3522
3523When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3524from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3525runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3526However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3527file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3528which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3529listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3530CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3531not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3532
3533Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3534configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3535even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3536running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3537delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3538test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3539in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3540
3541If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3542prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3543must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3544However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3545CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3546usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3547unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3548
3549ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3550to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3551broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3552configuration file.
3553
3554The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3555syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3556caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3557require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3558specified by this option.
3559
3560
3561.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3562.oindex "&%-D%&"
3563.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3564This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3565(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3566unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3567If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3568completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3569
3570If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3571colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3572supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3573not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3574the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3575to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3576regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3577
3578The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3579command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3580string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3581synonymous:
3582.code
3583exim -DABC ...
3584exim -DABC= ...
3585.endd
3586To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3587quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3588example:
3589.code
3590exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3591.endd
3592&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3593Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3594
3595
3596.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3597.oindex "&%-d%&"
3598.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3599.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3600This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3601error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3602database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3603filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3604writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3605return code.
3606
3607When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3608standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3609some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3610made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3611of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3612debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3613no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3614are:
3615.display
3616&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3617&`auth `& authenticators
3618&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3619&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3620&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3621&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3622&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3623&`filter `& filter handling
3624&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3625&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3626&`ident `& ident lookup
3627&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3628&`lists `& matching things in lists
3629&`load `& system load checks
3630&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3631 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3632&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3633&`memory `& memory handling
3634&`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3635&`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3636&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3637&`queue_run `& queue runs
3638&`receive `& general message reception logic
3639&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3640&`retry `& retry handling
3641&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3642&`route `& address routing
3643&`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3644&`tls `& TLS logic
3645&`transport `& transports
3646&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3647&`verify `& address verification logic
3648&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3649.endd
3650The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3651for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3652tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3653is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3654generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3655turn everything off.
3656
3657.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3658.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3659The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3660with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3661unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3662rather than stderr.
3663
3664The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3665&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3666However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3667daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3668automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3669run in parallel.
3670
3671The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3672of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3673in processing.
3674
3675.cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3676.cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3677The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3678UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3679When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3680Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3681
3682If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3683any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3684
3685.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3686.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3687This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3688starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3689subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3690behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3691
3692.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3693.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3694This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3695handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3696described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3697
3698.vitem &%-E%&
3699.oindex "&%-E%&"
3700.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3701This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3702failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3703and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3704generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3705could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3706follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3707new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3708
3709.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3710.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3711There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3712called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3713example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3714form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3715
3716.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3717.oindex "&%-F%&"
3718.cindex "sender" "name"
3719.cindex "name" "of sender"
3720This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3721message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3722entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3723their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3724between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3725
3726.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3727.oindex "&%-f%&"
3728.cindex "sender" "address"
3729.cindex "address" "sender"
3730.cindex "trusted users"
3731.cindex "envelope from"
3732.cindex "envelope sender"
3733.cindex "user" "trusted"
3734This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3735message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3736by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3737users to use it.
3738
3739Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3740trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3741options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3742of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3743domain.
3744
3745There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3746can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3747never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3748string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3749examples of shell commands:
3750.code
3751exim -f '<>' user@domain
3752exim -f "" user@domain
3753.endd
3754In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3755with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3756&%-bv%& options.
3757
3758Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3759it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3760refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3761though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3762
3763White
3764.cindex "&""From""& line"
3765space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3766given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3767locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3768&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3769if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3770
3771.vitem &%-G%&
3772.oindex "&%-G%&"
3773.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3774This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3775.code
3776control = suppress_local_fixups
3777.endd
3778for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3779bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3780in future.
3781
3782As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3783this option.
3784
3785.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3786.oindex "&%-h%&"
3787.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3788This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3789Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3790headers.)
3791
3792.vitem &%-i%&
3793.oindex "&%-i%&"
3794.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3795.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3796This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3797line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3798no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3799command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3800
3801.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3802.oindex "&%-L%&"
3803.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3804This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3805file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3806Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3807read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3808effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3809
3810The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3811
3812.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3813.oindex "&%-M%&"
3814.cindex "forcing delivery"
3815.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3816.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3817This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3818any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3819delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3820and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3821
3822Retry
3823.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3824hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3825the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3826to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3827which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3828for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3829
3830The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3831not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3832produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3833use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3834
3835.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3836.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3837.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3838.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3839This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3840message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3841id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3842active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3843can be used only by an admin user.
3844
3845.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3846 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3847.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3848.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3849.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3850.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3851This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3853an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3854given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3855must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3856
3857.vitem &%-MCA%&
3858.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3859This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3860by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3861connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3862
3863.vitem &%-MCD%&
3864.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3865This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3866by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3867remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3868
3869.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3870.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3871This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3872by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3873alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3874
3875.vitem &%-MCK%&
3876.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3877This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3879remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3880
3881.vitem &%-MCP%&
3882.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3883This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3885which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3886
3887.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3888.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3889This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3890by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3891started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3892together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3893signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3894messages through the same SMTP connection.
3895
3896.vitem &%-MCS%&
3897.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3898This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3899by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3900SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3901connection.
3902
3903.vitem &%-MCT%&
3904.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3905This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3906by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3907host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3908
3909.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3910.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3911This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3914The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3915
3916.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3917.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3918.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3919.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3920This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3921but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3922that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3923provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3924order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3925However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3926respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3927overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3928If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3929&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3930and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3931
3932.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3933.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3934.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3935.cindex "sender" "changing"
3936This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3937given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3938&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3939be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3940is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3941This option can be used only by an admin user.
3942
3943.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3945.cindex "freezing messages"
3946.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3947This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3948prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3949either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3950However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3951attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3952user.
3953
3954.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3955.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3956.cindex "giving up on messages"
3957.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3958.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3959This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3960including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3961their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3962is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3963Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3964user.
3965
3966.new
3967.vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3968.oindex "&%-MG%&"
3969.cindex queue named
3970.cindex "named queues"
3971.cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3972This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3973queue to the given named queue.
3974The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3975string to define the default queue.
3976If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3977a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3978.wen
3979
3980.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3981.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3982.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3983This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3984as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3985message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3986altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3987
3988.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3989.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3990.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3991.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3992.cindex "removing recipients"
3993This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3994(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3995the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3996addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3997(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3998can be used only by an admin user.
3999
4000.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4001.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
4002.cindex "removing messages"
4003.cindex "abandoning mail"
4004.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4005This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4006bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4007the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4008only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4009placed in the queue.
4010
4011. .new
4012. .vitem &%-MS%&
4013. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
4014. .cindex REQUIRETLS
4015. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4016. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4017. a bounce message.
4018. .wen
4019
4020.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4021.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4022.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4023.cindex "expansion" "testing"
4024This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4025string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4026the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4027&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4028available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4029make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4030user. See also &%-bem%&.
4031
4032.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4033.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4034.cindex "thawing messages"
4035.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4036.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4037.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4038This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4039&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4040messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4041by an admin user.
4042
4043.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4044.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4045.cindex "listing" "message body"
4046.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4047This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4048written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4049
4050.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4051.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4052.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4053.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4054This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4055be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4056only by an admin user.
4057
4058.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4059.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4060.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4061.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4062.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4063This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4064written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4065
4066.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4067.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4068.cindex "listing" "message log"
4069.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4070This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4071the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4072
4073.vitem &%-m%&
4074.oindex "&%-m%&"
4075This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4076treats it that way too.
4077
4078.vitem &%-N%&
4079.oindex "&%-N%&"
4080.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4081.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4082This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4083level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4084it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4085had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4086database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4087than &"=>"&.
4088
4089Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4090user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4091words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4092which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4093address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4094routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4095the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4096for that message.
4097
4098.vitem &%-n%&
4099.oindex "&%-n%&"
4100This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4101For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4102When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4103option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4104
4105.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4106.oindex "&%-O%&"
4107This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4108Exim.
4109
4110.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4111.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4112.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4113This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4114alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4115description above.
4116
4117.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4118.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4119.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4120.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4121.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4122This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4123be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4124transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4125
4126.vitem &%-odb%&
4127.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4128.cindex "background delivery"
4129.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4130This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4131including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4132messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4133delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4134processes to finish.
4135
4136When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4137leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4138and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4139This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4140
4141If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4142(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4143overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4144setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4145
4146.vitem &%-odf%&
4147.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4148.cindex "foreground delivery"
4149.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4150This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4151accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4152&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4153and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4154
4155The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4156process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4157during deliveries.
4158
4159However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4160false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4161
4162If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4163message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4164process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4165restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4166
4167
4168.vitem &%-odi%&
4169.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4170This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4171Sendmail.
4172
4173.vitem &%-odq%&
4174.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4175.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4176.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4177.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4178This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4179including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4180not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4181are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4182process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4183&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4184conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4185forces queueing.
4186
4187.vitem &%-odqs%&
4188.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4189.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4190This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4191However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4192&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4193configuration file is in effect.
4194
4195When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4196message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4197also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4198in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4199done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4200runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4201messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4202host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4203configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4204&%-qq%& option.
4205
4206.vitem &%-oee%&
4207.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4208.cindex "error" "reporting"
4209If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4210example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4211message.
4212
4213.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4214Provided
4215this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4216exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4217is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4218This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4219
4220.vitem &%-oem%&
4221.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4222.cindex "error" "reporting"
4223.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4224This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4225return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4226This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4227
4228.vitem &%-oep%&
4229.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4230.cindex "error" "reporting"
4231If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4232error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4233.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4234The return code is 1 for all errors.
4235
4236.vitem &%-oeq%&
4237.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4238.cindex "error" "reporting"
4239This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4240effect as &%-oep%&.
4241
4242.vitem &%-oew%&
4243.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4244.cindex "error" "reporting"
4245This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4246effect as &%-oem%&.
4247
4248.vitem &%-oi%&
4249.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4250.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4251This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4252line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4253single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4254lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4255&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4256
4257.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4258.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4259This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4260
4261.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4262.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4263.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4264A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4265with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4266over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4267&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4268other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4269
4270The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4271number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4272.code
4273exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4274.endd
4275An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4276followed by a colon and the port number:
4277.code
4278exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4279.endd
4280The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4281port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4282are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4283whichever one is last.
4284
4285.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4286.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4287.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4288See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4289option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4290name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4291This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4292authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4293
4294.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4295.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4296.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4297See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4298option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4299This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4300where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4301&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4302
4303.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4304.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4305.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4306See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4307option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4308overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4309messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4310default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4311specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4312&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4313
4314.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4315.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4316.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4317See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4318option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4319using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4320&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4321
4322.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4323.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4324.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4325See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4326option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4327delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4328messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4329abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4330running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4331
4332The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4333The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4334is sending the bounce.
4335
4336.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4337.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4338.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4339.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4340See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4341option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4342&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4343or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4344SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4345&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4346one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4347be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4348
4349.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4350.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4351.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4352See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4353option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4354present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4355uses the name it is given.
4356
4357.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4358.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4359.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4360See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4361option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4362local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4363used, when there is no default.
4364
4365.vitem &%-om%&
4366.oindex "&%-om%&"
4367.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4368In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4369message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4370expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4371
4372.vitem &%-oo%&
4373.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4374.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4375This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4376whatever that means.
4377
4378.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4379.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4380.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4381.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4382This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4383value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4384written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4385without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4386because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4387
4388.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4389.oindex "&%-or%&"
4390.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4391This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4392set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4393by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4394described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4395
4396.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4397.oindex "&%-os%&"
4398.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4399.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4400This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4401applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4402the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4403for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4404
4405.vitem &%-ov%&
4406.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4407This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4408
4409.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4410.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4411.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4412.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4413.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4414This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4415is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4416of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4417in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4418file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4419
4420.vitem &%-pd%&
4421.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4422.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4423This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4424chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4425option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4426needed.
4427
4428.vitem &%-ps%&
4429.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4430.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4431This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4432chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4433option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4434started.
4435
4436.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4437.oindex "&%-p%&"
4438For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4439.display
4440&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4441.endd
4442It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4443host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4444Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4445to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4446or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4447Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4448
4449.vitem &%-q%&
4450.oindex "&%-q%&"
4451.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4452This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4453configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4454relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4455and &%-S%& options).
4456
4457.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4458If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4459the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4460waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4461for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4462process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4463have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4464
4465If
4466.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4467.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4468.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4469the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4470passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4471proceeding.
4472
4473When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4474process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4475mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4476this to be repeated periodically.
4477
4478Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4479random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4480If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4481MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4482
4483It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4484order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4485&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4486
4487.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4488The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4489behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4490appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4491
4492.vitem &%-qq...%&
4493.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4494.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4495.cindex "queue" "routing"
4496.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4497An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4498stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4499every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4500transports are run.
4501
4502.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4503The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4504is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4505complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4506place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4507delivered down a single SMTP
4508.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4509.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4510.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4511connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4512This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4513intermittently.
4514
4515.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4516.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4517.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4518If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4519those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4520delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4521&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4522
4523.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4524.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4525.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4526.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4527If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4528message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4529their retry times are tried.
4530
4531.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4532.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4533.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4534If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4535frozen or not.
4536
4537.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4538.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4539.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4540The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4541be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4542for later delivery.
4543
4544.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4545.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4546.cindex queue named
4547.cindex "named queues"
4548.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4549If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4550queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4551The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4552For a periodic queue run (see below)
4553append to the name a slash and a time value.
4554
4555If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4556will specify a queue to operate on.
4557For example:
4558.code
4559exim -bp -qGquarantine
4560mailq -qGquarantine
4561exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4562.endd
4563
4564.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4565When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4566lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4567starting message id. For example:
4568.code
4569exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4570.endd
4571Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4572second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4573are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4574.code
4575exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4576.endd
4577just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4578&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4579that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4580mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4581are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4582queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4583
4584.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4585.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4586.cindex "periodic queue running"
4587When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4588starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4589(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4590&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4591single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4592combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4593.code
4594/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4595.endd
4596Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4597process every 30 minutes.
4598
4599When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4600pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4601
4602.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4603.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4604This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4605compatibility.
4606
4607.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4608.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4609This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4610
4611.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4612.oindex "&%-R%&"
4613.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4614.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4615.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4616The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4617is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4618which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4619<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4620
4621This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4622perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4623queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4624address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4625way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4626regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4627
4628If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4629you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4630.code
4631exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4632.endd
4633This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4634every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4635applied to each queue run.
4636
4637Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4638are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4639information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4640means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4641existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4642address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4643will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4644information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4645address will be skipped.
4646
4647.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4648If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4649all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4650&'ff'& is present.
4651
4652The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4653to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4654command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4655effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4656an arbitrary command instead.
4657
4658.vitem &%-r%&
4659.oindex "&%-r%&"
4660This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4661
4662.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4663.oindex "&%-S%&"
4664.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4665.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4666This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4667message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4668conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4669has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4670
4671.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4672.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4673This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4674recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4675&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4676
4677.vitem &%-t%&
4678.oindex "&%-t%&"
4679.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4680.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4681.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4682.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4683When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4684input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4685from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4686from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4687takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4688
4689.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4690If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4691is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4692the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4693and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4694Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4695Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4696argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4697Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4698instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4699&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4700
4701.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4702If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4703recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4704lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4705with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4706&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4707
4708RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4709message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4710added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4711not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4712nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4713In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4714are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4715once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4716&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4717
4718.vitem &%-ti%&
4719.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4720This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4721compatibility with Sendmail.
4722
4723.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4724.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4725.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4726.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4727This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4728incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4729&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4730&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4731
4732
4733.vitem &%-U%&
4734.oindex "&%-U%&"
4735.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4736Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4737documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4738syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4739set. Exim ignores this option.
4740
4741.vitem &%-v%&
4742.oindex "&%-v%&"
4743This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4744describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4745receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4746dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4747the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4748selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4749unconditional.
4750
4751.vitem &%-x%&
4752.oindex "&%-x%&"
4753AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4754National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4755It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4756this option.
4757
4758.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4759.oindex "&%-X%&"
4760This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4761to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4762
4763.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4764.oindex "&%-z%&"
4765This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4766Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4767Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4768under most shells.
4769.endlist
4770
4771.ecindex IIDclo1
4772.ecindex IIDclo2
4773
4774
4775. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4776. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4777. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4778. creates a man page for the options.
4779. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4780
4781.literal xml
4782<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4783.literal off
4784
4785
4786
4787
4788
4789. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4790. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4791
4792
4793.chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4794 "The runtime configuration file"
4795
4796.cindex "runtime configuration"
4797.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4798.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4799.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4800.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4801.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4802Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4803binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4804because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4805control.
4806
4807If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4808writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4809The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4810errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4811not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4812actually alter the string.
4813
4814The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4815reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4816most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4817give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4818existing file in the list.
4819
4820.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4821.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4822.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4823.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4824.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4825.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4826The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4827specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4828configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4829group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4830CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4831
4832&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4833to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4834easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4835CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4836who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4837
4838Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4839be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4840since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4841compromise the Exim user account.
4842
4843A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4844is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4845defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4846configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4847CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4848&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4849configuration.
4850
4851
4852
4853.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4854.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4855A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4856option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4857&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4858unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4859CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4860is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4861is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4862installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4863specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4864
4865Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4866with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4867listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4868testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4869delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4870Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4871the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4872can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4873message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4874&%-M%&).
4875
4876If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4877prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4878start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4879There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4880filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4881
4882One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4883option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4884configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4885non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4886If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4887completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4888
4889The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4890to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4891necessarily be discarded.
4892WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4893considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4894values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4895is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4896transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4897values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4898
4899Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4900share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4901If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4902looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4903and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4904file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4905each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4906
4907In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4908different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4909help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4910
4911
4912
4913.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4914.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4915.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4916Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4917option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4918are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4919is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4920space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4921
4922.ilist
4923&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4924&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4925.next
4926.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4927&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4928are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4929.next
4930&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4931addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4932&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4933.next
4934&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4935define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4936&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4937.next
4938&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4939If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4940defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4941are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4942&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4943.next
4944&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4945when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4946chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4947.next
4948&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4949want to use this feature, you must set
4950.code
4951LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4952.endd
4953in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4954facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4955.endlist
4956
4957.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4958.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4959.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4960Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4961
4962Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4963leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4964# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4965and does not introduce a comment.
4966
4967Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4968the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4969backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4970lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4971appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4972
4973A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4974default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4975change settings as required.
4976
4977The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4978described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4979respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4980items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4981onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4982described.
4983
4984
4985
4986.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4987.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4988.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4989.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4990.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4991You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4992using this syntax:
4993.display
4994&`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4995&`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4996.endd
4997on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4998the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4999second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5000The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5001the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5002is required.
5003
5004Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5005configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5006If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5007because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5008
5009The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5010comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5011for example:
5012.code
5013hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5014 .include /some/file
5015.endd
5016Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5017process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5018inclusion appears.
5019
5020
5021
5022.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5023.cindex "macro" "description of"
5024.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5025If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5026&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5027definition, and must be of the form
5028.display
5029<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5030.endd
5031The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5032in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5033continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5034space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5035a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5036
5037Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5038definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5039ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5040
5041.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5042Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5043files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5044scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5045replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5046for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5047the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5048define
5049.display
5050&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5051&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5052.endd
5053but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5054error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5055before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5056consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5057line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5058comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5059
5060
5061.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5062Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5063(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5064&'='&. For example:
5065.code
5066MAC = initial value
5067...
5068MAC == updated value
5069.endd
5070Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5071subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5072the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5073Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5074.code
5075MAC = initial value
5076...
5077MAC == MAC and something added
5078.endd
5079This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5080from a number of other files.
5081
5082.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5083The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5084&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5085used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5086using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5087file to be ignored.
5088
5089
5090
5091.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5092As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5093up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5094strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5095.code
5096ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5097 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5098.endd
5099This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5100.code
5101data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5102.endd
5103In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5104address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5105section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5106
5107
5108.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5109Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5110differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5111All of these macros start with an underscore.
5112They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5113(see below).
5114
5115The following classes of macros are defined:
5116.display
5117&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5118&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5119&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5120&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5121&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5122&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5123&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5124&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5125&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5126&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5127&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5128&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5129.endd
5130
5131Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5132
5133
5134.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5135.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5136.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5137You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5138&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5139portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5140read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5141
5142The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5143be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5144that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5145line. Thus:
5146.code
5147.ifdef AAA
5148message_size_limit = 50M
5149.else
5150message_size_limit = 100M
5151.endif
5152.endd
5153sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5154(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5155otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5156is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5157obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5158
5159Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5160it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5161in this line"& will always be true.
5162
5163Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5164to clarify complicated nestings.
5165
5166
5167
5168.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5169.cindex "common option syntax"
5170.cindex "syntax of common options"
5171.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5172For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5173each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5174lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5175these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5176space) and then the value. For example:
5177.code
5178qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5179.endd
5180.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5181.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5182.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5183Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5184accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5185line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5186word &"hide"&. For example:
5187.code
5188hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5189.endd
5190For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5191.code
5192mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5193.endd
5194If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5195all instances of the same driver.
5196
5197The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5198that are found in option settings.
5199
5200
5201.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5202.cindex "format" "boolean"
5203.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5204.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5205.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5206Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5207different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5208the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5209if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5210boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5211&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5212the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5213.code
5214queue_only
5215queue_only = true
5216.endd
5217The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5218.code
5219no_queue_only
5220queue_only = false
5221.endd
5222You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5223
5224
5225
5226
5227.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5228.cindex "integer configuration values"
5229.cindex "format" "integer"
5230If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5231hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5232number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5233with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5234hexadecimal number.
5235
5236If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5237it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5238if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5239When the values
5240of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52411024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5242and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5243used.
5244
5245
5246.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5247.cindex "integer format"
5248.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5249If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5250interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5251Such options are always output in octal.
5252
5253
5254.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5255.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5256.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5257If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5258integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5259
5260
5261
5262.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5263.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5264.cindex "format" "time interval"
5265A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5266the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5267
5268.table2 30pt
5269.irow &%s%& seconds
5270.irow &%m%& minutes
5271.irow &%h%& hours
5272.irow &%d%& days
5273.irow &%w%& weeks
5274.endtable
5275
5276For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5277intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5278is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5279
5280
5281
5282.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5283.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5284.cindex "format" "string"
5285If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5286or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5287consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5288the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5289removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5290Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5291appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5292therefore equivalent:
5293.code
5294trusted_users = uucp:mail
5295trusted_users = uucp:\
5296 # This comment line is ignored
5297 mail
5298.endd
5299.cindex "string" "quoted"
5300.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5301If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5302double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5303continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5304
5305.table2 100pt
5306.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5307.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5308.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5309.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5310.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5311.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5312 character"
5313.endtable
5314
5315If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5316character, that character replaces the pair.
5317
5318Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5319insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5320trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5321current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5322in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5323and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5324
5325
5326.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5327.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5328Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5329by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5330circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5331is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5332strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5333However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5334backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5335within a quoted configuration string.
5336
5337
5338.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5339.cindex "user name" "format of"
5340.cindex "format" "user name"
5341.cindex "groups" "name format"
5342.cindex "format" "group name"
5343User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5344above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5345either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5346&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5347
5348
5349.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5350.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5351.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5352.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5353The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5354default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5355the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5356&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5357are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5358particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5359&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5360
5361In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5362input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5363&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5364in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5365on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5366start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5367example, the list
5368.code
5369local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5370.endd
5371contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5372
5373&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5374list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5375colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5376be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5377
5378.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5379.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5380.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5381Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5382introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5383with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5384character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5385above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5386.code
5387local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5388.endd
5389This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5390&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5391confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5392
5393.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5394.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5395It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5396code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5397must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5398are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5399sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5400interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5401generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5402.code
5403domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5404.endd
5405This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5406to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5407expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5408the value in quotes. For example:
5409.code
5410local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5411.endd
5412Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5413doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5414set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5415enclosing an empty list item.
5416
5417
5418
5419.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5420.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5421An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5422separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5423.code
5424senders = user@domain :
5425.endd
5426contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5427in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5428items, the second of which is empty:
5429.code
5430senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5431.endd
5432&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5433are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5434would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5435just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5436.code
5437senders = :
5438.endd
5439In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5440is at the end of the list.
5441
5442
5443
5444
5445.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5446.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5447There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5448and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5449instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5450a sequence of lines like this:
5451.display
5452<&'instance name'&>:
5453 <&'option'&>
5454 ...
5455 <&'option'&>
5456.endd
5457In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5458followed by three options settings:
5459.code
5460localuser:
5461 driver = accept
5462 check_local_user
5463 transport = local_delivery
5464.endd
5465For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5466setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5467settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5468deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5469a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5470described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5471
5472You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5473the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5474
5475The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5476passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5477transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5478authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5479them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5480server.
5481
5482.cindex "generic options"
5483.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5484Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5485and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5486same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5487&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5488.cindex "private options"
5489The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5490they all have default values.
5491
5492The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5493precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5494this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5495
5496Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5497elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5498with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5499a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5500instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5501confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5502configuration lines:
5503.code
5504remote_smtp:
5505 driver = smtp
5506.endd
5507create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5508&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5509different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5510instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5511thus:
5512.code
5513special_smtp:
5514 driver = smtp
5515 port = 1234
5516 command_timeout = 10s
5517.endd
5518The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5519these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5520lines.
5521
5522Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5523list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5524defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5525option.
5526
5527
5528
5529
5530
5531
5532. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5533. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5534
5535.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5536.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5537.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5538The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5539is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5540the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5541configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5542of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5543itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5544initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5545mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5546
5547
5548
5549.section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5550All macros should be defined before any options.
5551
5552One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5553.code
5554# ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5555.endd
5556If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5557hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5558later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5559deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5560
5561In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5562to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5563given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5564
5565
5566.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5567The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5568in the file, after the macros.
5569The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5570.code
5571# primary_hostname =
5572.endd
5573This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5574to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5575can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5576it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5577
5578The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5579.code
5580domainlist local_domains = @
5581domainlist relay_to_domains =
5582hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5583.endd
5584These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5585domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5586domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5587configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5588
5589The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5590later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5591on the local host.
5592
5593.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5594There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5595of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5596called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5597be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5598the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5599
5600The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5601list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5602controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5603domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5604domain is permitted.
5605
5606The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5607used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5608that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5609loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5610submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5611hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5612
5613Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5614we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5615and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5616
5617The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5618.code
5619acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5620acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5621.endd
5622These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5623during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5624command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5625respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5626&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5627section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5628accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5629to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5630contents of a message to be checked.
5631
5632Two commented-out option settings are next:
5633.code
5634# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5635# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5636.endd
5637These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5638content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5639scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5640details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5641
5642Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5643.code
5644# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5645# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5646# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5647.endd
5648These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5649support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5650first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5651connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5652other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5653key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5654More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5655
5656Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5657.code
5658# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5659# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5660.endd
5661.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5662.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5663.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5664.cindex "submissions protocol"
5665.cindex "smtps protocol"
5666.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5667.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5668.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5669.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5670These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5671server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5672TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5673more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5674Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5675to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5676much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5677consequences).
5678RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5679which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5680RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5681which should be used in preference to 587.
5682You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5683these ports.
5684Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5685
5686Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5687.code
5688# qualify_domain =
5689# qualify_recipient =
5690.endd
5691The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5692complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5693receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5694the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5695you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5696addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5697
5698.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5699The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5700addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5701(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5702.code
5703# allow_domain_literals
5704.endd
5705The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5706Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5707quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5708try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5709people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5710&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5711
5712The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5713.code
5714never_users = root
5715.endd
5716It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5717convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5718setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5719The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5720list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5721FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5722contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5723FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5724
5725When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5726Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5727line,
5728.code
5729host_lookup = *
5730.endd
5731specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5732in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5733information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5734or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5735Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5736because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5737unreachable.
5738
5739The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
57401413 (hence their names):
5741.code
5742rfc1413_hosts = *
5743rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5744.endd
5745These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5746Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5747terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5748of an incoming SMTP connection.
5749If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5750information, you can change this.
5751
5752This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5753and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5754.code
5755prdr_enable = true
5756.endd
5757
5758When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5759be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5760if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5761find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5762.code
5763# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5764# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5765.endd
5766show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5767and recipient addresses, respectively.
5768
5769The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5770over the default:
5771.code
5772log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5773 +tls_certificate_verified
5774.endd
5775
5776The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5777.code
5778# percent_hack_domains =
5779.endd
5780It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5781This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5782anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5783
5784The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5785concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5786message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5787occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5788address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5789bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5790are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5791always bounce messages.
5792.code
5793ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5794timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5795.endd
5796The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5797discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5798message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5799after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5800bounce message ever lasts a week.
5801
5802Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5803large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5804directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5805many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5806Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5807not often needed).
5808.code
5809# split_spool_directory = true
5810.endd
5811
5812In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5813messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5814characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5815violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5816In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5817problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5818check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5819.code
5820# check_rfc2047_length = false
5821.endd
5822
5823If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
58248BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5825that are not 8-bit clean.
5826.code
5827# accept_8bitmime = false
5828.endd
5829
5830Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5831imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5832&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5833&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5834Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5835option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5836.code
5837# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5838# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5839.endd
5840
5841
5842.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5843.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5844.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5845In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5846It starts with the line
5847.code
5848begin acl
5849.endd
5850and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5851&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5852and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5853
5854.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5855The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5856RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5857are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5858rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5859result of the ACL processing.
5860.code
5861acl_check_rcpt:
5862.endd
5863This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5864ACL, and names it.
5865.code
5866accept hosts = :
5867.endd
5868This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5869But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5870names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5871list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5872host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5873important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5874
5875What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5876messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5877input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5878manner.
5879.code
5880deny message = Restricted characters in address
5881 domains = +local_domains
5882 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5883
5884deny message = Restricted characters in address
5885 domains = !+local_domains
5886 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5887.endd
5888These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5889characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5890Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5891&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5892in Internet mail addresses.
5893
5894The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5895addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5896option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5897in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5898programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5899at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5900characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5901policy of being as safe as possible.
5902
5903The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5904to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5905first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5906&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5907reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5908&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5909
5910The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5911block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5912or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5913have to modify this rule.
5914
5915Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5916allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5917common convention of local parts constructed as
5918&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5919the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5920with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5921filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5922that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5923is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5924
5925The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5926allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5927and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5928with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5929local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5930and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5931(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5932.code
5933accept local_parts = postmaster
5934 domains = +local_domains
5935.endd
5936This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5937local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5938&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5939reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5940&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5941
5942The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5943by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5944in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5945.code
5946require verify = sender
5947.endd
5948This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5949ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5950address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5951see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5952addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5953used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5954discusses the details of address verification.
5955.code
5956accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5957 control = submission
5958.endd
5959This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5960hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5961verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5962that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5963second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5964is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5965messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5966&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5967probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5968.code
5969accept authenticated = *
5970 control = submission
5971.endd
5972This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5973Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5974likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5975authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5976examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5977fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5978.code
5979require message = relay not permitted
5980 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5981.endd
5982This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5983one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5984.code
5985require verify = recipient
5986.endd
5987This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5988fails, the address is rejected.
5989.code
5990# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5991# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5992# $dnslist_text
5993# dnslists = black.list.example
5994#
5995# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5996# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5997# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5998# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5999.endd
6000These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6001sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6002from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6003line.
6004.code
6005# require verify = csa
6006.endd
6007This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6008authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6009records.
6010.code
6011accept
6012.endd
6013The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6014address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6015.code
6016acl_check_data:
6017.endd
6018This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6019of this ACL are commented out:
6020.code
6021# deny malware = *
6022# message = This message contains a virus \
6023# ($malware_name).
6024.endd
6025These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6026viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6027suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6028virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6029.code
6030# warn spam = nobody
6031# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6032# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6033# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6034# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6035.endd
6036These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6037SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6038and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6039&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6040series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6041whatever the spam score.
6042.code
6043accept
6044.endd
6045This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6046
6047
6048.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6049.cindex "default" "routers"
6050.cindex "routers" "default"
6051The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6052by the line
6053.code
6054begin routers
6055.endd
6056Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6057messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6058accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6059matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6060manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6061.code
6062# domain_literal:
6063# driver = ipliteral
6064# domains = !+local_domains
6065# transport = remote_smtp
6066.endd
6067.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6068This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6069support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6070you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6071&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6072
6073Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6074macro has been defined, per
6075.code
6076.ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6077smarthost:
6078#...
6079.else
6080dnslookup:
6081#...
6082.endif
6083.endd
6084
6085If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6086command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6087perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6088skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6089
6090.code
6091smarthost:
6092 driver = manualroute
6093 domains = ! +local_domains
6094 transport = smarthost_smtp
6095 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6096 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6097 no_more
6098.endd
6099This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6100specified by the line
6101.code
6102domains = ! +local_domains
6103.endd
6104The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6105exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6106that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6107the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6108indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6109passed on to the following routers.
6110
6111The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6112specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6113While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6114be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6115
6116With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6117will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6118other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6119&<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6120are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6121and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6122&(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6123
6124.code
6125dnslookup:
6126 driver = dnslookup
6127 domains = ! +local_domains
6128 transport = remote_smtp
6129 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6130 no_more
6131.endd
6132The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6133
6134The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6135and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6136the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6137instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6138one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6139
6140The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6141DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6142router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6143specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6144in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6145the address fails and is bounced.
6146
6147The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6148be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6149encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6150whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6151Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6152email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6153continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6154out.
6155.code
6156system_aliases:
6157 driver = redirect
6158 allow_fail
6159 allow_defer
6160 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6161# user = exim
6162 file_transport = address_file
6163 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6164.endd
6165Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6166domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6167alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6168data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6169the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6170the next router.
6171
6172&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6173often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6174file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6175&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6176.code
6177userforward:
6178 driver = redirect
6179 check_local_user
6180# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6181# local_part_suffix_optional
6182 file = $home/.forward
6183# allow_filter
6184 no_verify
6185 no_expn
6186 check_ancestor
6187 file_transport = address_file
6188 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6189 reply_transport = address_reply
6190.endd
6191This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6192redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6193individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6194local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6195router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6196namely:
6197.code
6198# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6199# local_part_suffix_optional
6200.endd
6201.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6202show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6203is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6204by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6205variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6206presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6207the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6208
6209When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6210home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6211declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6212redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6213
6214.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6215Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6216files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6217is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6218of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6219filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6220separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6221
6222The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6223verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6224There are two reasons for doing this:
6225
6226.olist
6227Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6228checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6229unnecessary work.
6230.next
6231More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6232command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6233The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6234It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6235this time.
6236.endlist
6237
6238The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6239address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6240works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6241forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6242
6243The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6244forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6245auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6246.code
6247a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6248.endd
6249the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6250transport.
6251.code
6252localuser:
6253 driver = accept
6254 check_local_user
6255# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6256# local_part_suffix_optional
6257 transport = local_delivery
6258.endd
6259The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6260part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6261the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6262routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6263same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6264
6265
6266.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6267.cindex "default" "transports"
6268.cindex "transports" "default"
6269Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6270only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6271not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6272.code
6273begin transports
6274.endd
6275Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6276.code
6277remote_smtp:
6278 driver = smtp
6279 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6280.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6281 hosts_try_prdr = *
6282.endif
6283.endd
6284This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6285The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6286The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6287with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6288to use DANE for delivery;
6289see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6290
6291The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6292negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6293but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6294use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6295
6296The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6297with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6298usual federated system.
6299
6300.code
6301smarthost_smtp:
6302 driver = smtp
6303 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6304 multi_domain
6305 #
6306.ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6307 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6308 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6309 hosts_require_tls = *
6310 tls_verify_hosts = *
6311 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6312 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6313 # or not:
6314 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6315 #
6316 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6317 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6318 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6319 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6320 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6321 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6322 #
6323.ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6324 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6325.endif
6326.ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6327 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6328.endif
6329.endif
6330.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6331 hosts_try_prdr = *
6332.endif
6333.endd
6334After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6335can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6336that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6337happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6338All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6339then no other options are defined.
6340If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6341and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6342used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6343Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6344from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6345mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6346the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6347to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6348ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6349You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6350should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6351
6352For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6353
6354All other options are defaulted.
6355.code
6356local_delivery:
6357 driver = appendfile
6358 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6359 delivery_date_add
6360 envelope_to_add
6361 return_path_add
6362# group = mail
6363# mode = 0660
6364.endd
6365This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6366traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6367local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6368directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6369under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6370show how this can be done.
6371
6372Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6373&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6374similarly-named options above.
6375.code
6376address_pipe:
6377 driver = pipe
6378 return_output
6379.endd
6380This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6381redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6382option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6383be returned to the sender.
6384.code
6385address_file:
6386 driver = appendfile
6387 delivery_date_add
6388 envelope_to_add
6389 return_path_add
6390.endd
6391This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6392redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6393&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6394.code
6395address_reply:
6396 driver = autoreply
6397.endd
6398This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6399filter files.
6400
6401
6402
6403.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6404.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6405.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6406The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6407Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6408introduced by the line
6409.code
6410begin retry
6411.endd
6412In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6413errors:
6414.code
6415* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6416.endd
6417This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
64182 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
64191.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6420is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6421measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6422
6423If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6424if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6425temporary errors into permanent errors.
6426
6427
6428.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6429The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6430.code
6431begin rewrite
6432.endd
6433contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6434rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6435
6436
6437
6438.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6439.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6440The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6441.code
6442begin authenticators
6443.endd
6444defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6445configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6446which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6447standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6448mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6449to support most MUA software.
6450
6451The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6452.code
6453#PLAIN:
6454# driver = plaintext
6455# server_set_id = $auth2
6456# server_prompts = :
6457# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6458# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6459.endd
6460And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6461.code
6462#LOGIN:
6463# driver = plaintext
6464# server_set_id = $auth1
6465# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6466# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6467# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6468.endd
6469
6470The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6471in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6472&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6473that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6474i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6475when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6476when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6477need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6478
6479The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6480password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6481To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6482expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6483
6484Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6485usercode and password are in different positions.
6486Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6487
6488.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6489
6490
6491
6492. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6493. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6494
6495.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6496
6497.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6498.cindex "PCRE"
6499Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6500uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6501matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6502regular expressions is discussed in
6503online Perl manpages, in
6504many Perl reference books, and also in
6505Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6506O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6507. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6508. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6509. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6510
6511The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6512are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6513description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6514the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6515the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6516case-insensitive.
6517
6518In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6519it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6520or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6521second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6522.code
6523domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6524.endd
6525The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6526precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6527of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6528regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6529backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6530normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6531matched.
6532
6533There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6534recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6535string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6536these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6537it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6538match anywhere in the subject string.
6539
6540In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6541you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6542.code
6543domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6544.endd
6545matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6546You need to use:
6547.code
6548domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6549.endd
6550if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6551$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6552
6553
6554
6555. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6556. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6557
6558.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6559.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6560.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6561.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6562Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6563messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6564
6565.olist
6566A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6567cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6568lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6569can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6570&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6571The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6572.next
6573Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6574way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6575returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6576succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6577chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6578The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6579.endlist
6580
6581String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6582that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6583involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6584if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6585time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6586chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6587
6588.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6589It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6590lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6591processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6592Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6593.code
6594domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6595domains = lsearch;/some/file
6596.endd
6597The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6598No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6599defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6600The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6601file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6602.code
6603192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6604192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6605.endd
6606When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6607possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6608
6609In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6610Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6611in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6612.code
6613domain1:
6614domain2:
6615.endd
6616Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6617matches the list item.
6618
6619It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6620Consider a file containing lines like this:
6621.code
6622192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6623.endd
6624If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6625first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6626causes a second lookup to occur.
6627
6628The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6629available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6630lookup is permitted.
6631
6632
6633.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6634.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6635.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6636Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6637
6638.ilist
6639The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6640and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6641lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6642.next
6643.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6644The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6645key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6646Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6647.endlist
6648
6649The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6650the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6651default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6652.code
6653LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6654LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6655.endd
6656which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6657For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6658libraries and header files before building Exim.
6659
6660
6661
6662
6663.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6664.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6665.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6666The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6667
6668.ilist
6669.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6670.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6671.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6672&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6673string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6674indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6675re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6676aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6677tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6678.display
6679&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6680&url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6681&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6682&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6683.endd
6684A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6685because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6686However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6687you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6688.next
6689.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6690.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6691.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6692&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6693DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6694zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6695&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6696
6697.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6698For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6699when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6700using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6701the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6702that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6703other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6704.next
6705.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6706.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6707.cindex "sasldb2"
6708.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6709&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6710interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6711ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6712authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6713&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6714&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6715.next
6716.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6717.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6718.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6719.cindex "Courier"
6720.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6721.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6722&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6723is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6724if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6725other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6726use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6727calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6728utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6729by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6730.next
6731.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6732.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6733&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6734whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6735contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6736the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6737symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6738lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6739&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6740.next
6741.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6742.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6743&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6744terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6745file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6746IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6747being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6748.code
67491.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6750192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6751"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6752"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6753.endd
6754The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6755file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6756key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6757&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6758&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6759
6760&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6761&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6762lookup types support only literal keys.
6763
6764&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6765the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6766&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6767
6768.new
6769&*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6770IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6771notation before executing the lookup.)
6772.wen
6773.next
6774.new
6775.cindex lookup json
6776.cindex json "lookup type"
6777.cindex JSON expansions
6778&(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6779An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6780The key is a list of subelement selectors
6781(colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6782which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6783of the JSON structure.
6784If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6785nunbered array element is selected.
6786Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6787The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6788or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6789is returned.
6790For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6791.wen
6792.next
6793.cindex "linear search"
6794.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6795.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6796.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6797&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6798line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6799end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6800letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6801in the file is used.
6802
6803White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6804line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6805continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6806space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6807junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6808colon, for example:
6809.code
6810baduser: :fail:
6811.endd
6812Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6813middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6814that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6815wildcarding of any kind.
6816
6817.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6818.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6819In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6820characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6821If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6822matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6823contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6824quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6825quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6826
6827.next
6828.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6829.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6830.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6831&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6832the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6833&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6834reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6835aliases; the full map names must be used.
6836
6837.next
6838.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6839.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6840.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6841.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6842&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6843&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6844the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6845that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6846used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6847
6848.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6849Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6850file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6851&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6852
6853. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6854. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6855
6856.olist
6857The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6858.code
6859 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6860 *fish data for anythingfish
6861.endd
6862.next
6863The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6864example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6865.code
6866 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6867.endd
6868Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6869expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6870string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6871.code
6872 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6873.endd
6874The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6875expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6876For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6877.code
6878 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6879.endd
6880
6881If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6882either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6883ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6884colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6885escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6886
6887&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6888match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6889is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6890takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6891&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6892
6893.next
6894Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6895is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6896lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6897example:
6898.code
6899 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6900.endd
6901The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6902.endlist olist
6903
6904Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6905continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6906be followed by optional colons.
6907
6908&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6909&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6910lookup types support only literal keys.
6911
6912.next
6913.cindex "lookup" "spf"
6914If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6915(as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6916For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6917.endlist ilist
6918
6919
6920.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6921.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6922.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6923The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6924many of them are given in later sections.
6925
6926.ilist
6927.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6928.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6929&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6930are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6931records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6932.next
6933.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6934.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6935&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6936.next
6937.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6938.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6939&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6940returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6941that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6942called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6943any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6944.next
6945.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6946.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6947&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6948MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6949.next
6950.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6951.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6952&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6953the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6954.next
6955.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6956.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6957&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6958Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6959.next
6960.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6961.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6962.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6963&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6964lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6965success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6966lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6967password value. For example:
6968.code
6969*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6970.endd
6971.next
6972.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6973.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6974&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6975PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6976
6977.next
6978.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6979.cindex lookup Redis
6980&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6981passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6982
6983.next
6984.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6985.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6986&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6987that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6988
6989.next
6990&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6991not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6992.next
6993.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6994.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6995. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6996&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6997allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6998address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6999obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7000at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7001superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7002&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7003.code
7004require condition = \
7005 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7006.endd
7007The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7008the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7009this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7010one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7011.endlist
7012
7013
7014
7015.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7016.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7017Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7018completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7019reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7020options such as a list of local domains.
7021
7022When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7023of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7024temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7025or may give up altogether.
7026
7027
7028
7029.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7030.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7031.cindex "lookup" "default values"
7032.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7033.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7034.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7035In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7036that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7037
7038&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7039lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7040specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7041
7042If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7043and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7044provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7045
7046.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7047.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7048.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7049Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7050&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7051character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7052by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7053that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7054take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7055For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7056.code
7057data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7058.endd
7059Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7060looks up these keys, in this order:
7061.code
7062jane@eyre.example
7063*@eyre.example
7064*
7065.endd
7066The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7067&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7068complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7069Exim move on to try the next key.
7070
7071
7072
7073.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7074.cindex "partial matching"
7075.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7076.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7077.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7078.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7079The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7080match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7081being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7082information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7083domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7084a key in a DBM file is
7085.code
7086*.dates.fict.example
7087.endd
7088then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7089&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7090by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7091file.
7092
7093&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7094also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7095&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7096
7097Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7098keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7099be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7100partial matching keys
7101beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7102Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7103unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7104
7105Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7106the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7107is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7108is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7109fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7110start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7111remains.
7112
7113A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7114by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7115&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7116modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7117subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7118up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7119.code
71202250.dates.fict.example
7121*.2250.dates.fict.example
7122*.dates.fict.example
7123*.fict.example
7124.endd
7125As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7126finishes.
7127
7128.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7129.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7130The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7131changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7132formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7133parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7134.code
7135domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7136.endd
7137In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7138&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7139components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7140other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7141.code
7142domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7143.endd
7144For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7145&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7146
7147If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7148just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7149down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7150
7151.ilist
7152If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7153.next
7154If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7155example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7156.next
7157Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7158remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7159for &"*"& on its own.
7160.next
7161Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7162.endlist
7163
7164
7165If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7166&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7167this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7168specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7169prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7170lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7171&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7172
7173The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7174in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7175dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7176in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7177subject key is always followed by a dot.
7178
7179
7180
7181
7182.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7183.cindex "lookup" "caching"
7184.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7185Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7186lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7187of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7188single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7189
7190For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7191another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7192many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7193the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7194closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7195own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7196
7197The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7198strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7199complete.
7200
7201
7202
7203
7204.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7205.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7206.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7207When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7208is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7209the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7210.code
7211[name=$local_part]
7212.endd
7213will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7214For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7215.code
7216[name="$local_part"]
7217.endd
7218but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7219NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7220rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7221of the following form is provided:
7222.code
7223${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7224.endd
7225For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7226.code
7227[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7228.endd
7229See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7230operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7231lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7232
7233
7234
7235
7236.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7237.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7238.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7239.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7240The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7241of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7242an expansion string could contain:
7243.code
7244${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7245.endd
7246If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7247is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7248&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7249&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7250
7251The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7252and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7253If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7254
7255For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7256concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7257depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7258between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7259by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7260.code
7261${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7262.endd
7263It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7264white space is ignored.
7265For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7266an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7267separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7268
7269.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7270When the type is PTR,
7271the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7272&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7273.code
7274${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7275.endd
7276If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7277altered and nothing is added.
7278
7279.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7280.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7281For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7282each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7283port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7284The field separator can be modified as above.
7285
7286.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7287.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7288For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7289unless a field separator is specified.
7290To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7291For SPF records the
7292default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7293.code
7294${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7295${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7296${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7297.endd
7298It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7299white space is ignored.
7300
7301.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7302For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7303successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7304Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7305specified.
7306.code
7307${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7308.endd
7309
7310.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7311.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7312.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7313.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7314Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7315each followed by a comma,
7316that may appear before the record type.
7317
7318The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7319temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7320a defer-option modifier.
7321The possible keywords are
7322&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7323With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7324whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7325ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7326With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7327error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7328succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7329.code
7330${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7331${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7332.endd
7333Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7334yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7335
7336.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7337Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7338The possible keywords are
7339&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7340With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7341with the lookup.
7342With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7343is not labelled as authenticated data
7344is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7345The default is &"lax"&.
7346
7347See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7348
7349.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7350.cindex "DNS" timeout
7351Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7352The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7353(e.g. &"5s"&).
7354The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7355
7356Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7357The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7358The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7359
7360.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7361.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7362.cindex DNS TTL
7363Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7364The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7365value of the set of returned DNS records.
7366
7367
7368.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7369.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7370By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7371each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7372the pseudo-type MXH:
7373.code
7374${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7375.endd
7376In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7377returned.
7378
7379.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7380Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7381records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7382component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7383records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7384error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7385but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7386top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7387.code
7388${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7389${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7390.endd
7391Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7392the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7393the name servers for &%edu%&.
7394
7395You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7396top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7397sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7398given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7399for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7400such a list.
7401
7402.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7403A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7404records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7405&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7406not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7407result of a successful lookup such as:
7408.code
7409${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7410.endd
7411has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7412The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7413authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7414
7415.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7416The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7417and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7418(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7419.code
7420${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7421.endd
7422
7423
7424.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7425In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7426However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7427&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7428the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7429.code
7430${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7431${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7432${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7433.endd
7434In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7435the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7436to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7437case, it does not treat it as a list.
7438
7439The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7440in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7441different separator can be specified, as described above.
7442
7443
7444
7445
7446.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7447.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7448.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7449.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7450The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7451become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7452implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7453contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7454the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7455it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7456indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7457your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7458.code
7459LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7460LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7461LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7462LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7463LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7464.endd
7465If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7466same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7467
7468There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7469the way they handle the results of a query:
7470
7471.ilist
7472&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7473gives an error.
7474.next
7475&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7476Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7477.next
7478&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7479from all of them are returned.
7480.endlist
7481
7482
7483For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7484Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7485the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7486First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7487
7488
7489.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7490.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7491An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7492the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7493.code
7494data = ${lookup ldap \
7495 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7496 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7497.endd
7498.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7499The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7500secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7501encrypted TLS connection is used.
7502
7503With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7504LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7505See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7506
7507Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7508controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7509&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7510your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7511&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7512certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7513running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7514methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7515&_exim.conf_&.
7516
7517
7518.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7519.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7520Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7521and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7522within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7523reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7524
7525The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7526filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7527the string:
7528.code
7529* => \2A
7530( => \28
7531) => \29
7532\ => \5C
7533.endd
7534in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7535to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7536.code
7537! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7538.endd
7539are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7540.code
7541${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7542.endd
7543yields
7544.code
7545%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7546.endd
7547Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7548.code
7549a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7550.endd
7551The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7552base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7553by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7554.code
7555, + " \ < > ;
7556.endd
7557It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7558before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7559is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7560.code
7561${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7562.endd
7563yields
7564.code
7565%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7566.endd
7567Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7568.code
7569\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7570.endd
7571There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7572authentication below.
7573
7574
7575.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7576.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7577The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7578is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7579an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7580by starting it with
7581.code
7582ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7583.endd
7584If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7585used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7586taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7587colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7588handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7589returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7590are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7591Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7592failures, and timeouts.
7593
7594For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7595of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7596&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7597doubled. For example
7598.code
7599ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7600.endd
7601If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7602to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7603the local host) is used.
7604
7605If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7606a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7607&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7608to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7609not available.
7610
7611For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7612for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7613can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7614the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7615.code
7616ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7617.endd
7618When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7619&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7620.code
7621${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7622.endd
7623When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7624a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7625specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7626socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7627&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7628or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7629the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7630backup host.
7631
7632If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7633specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7634&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7635
7636.ilist
7637Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7638interface.
7639.next
7640Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7641.endlist
7642
7643
7644Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7645&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7646
7647
7648
7649.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7650.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7651The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7652information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7653be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7654spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7655when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7656them. The following names are recognized:
7657.display
7658&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7659&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7660&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7661&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7662&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7663&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7664&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7665&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7666.endd
7667The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7668&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7669must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7670library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7671
7672.cindex LDAP timeout
7673.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7674The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7675backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7676enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7677network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7678&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7679LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7680if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7681SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7682Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7683
7684The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7685set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7686
7687The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7688to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7689default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7690server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7691different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7692different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7693alternate list (colon-separated).
7694
7695Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7696values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7697.code
7698${lookup ldap
7699 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7700 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7701 {$value}fail}
7702.endd
7703The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7704any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7705which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7706non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7707
7708The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7709connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7710on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7711
7712When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7713removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7714some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7715quoting has two advantages:
7716
7717.ilist
7718It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7719DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7720.next
7721It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7722.endlist
7723
7724For example, a setting such as
7725.code
7726USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7727.endd
7728should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7729
7730Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7731expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7732field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7733does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7734.code
7735PASS=${quote:$3}
7736.endd
7737The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7738SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7739&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7740
7741
7742
7743.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7744.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7745The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7746as a sequence of values, for example
7747.code
7748cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7749.endd
7750The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7751search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7752the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7753values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7754you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7755directory.
7756
7757In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7758result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7759has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7760part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7761
7762If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7763strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7764quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7765backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7766Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7767(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7768Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7769output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7770same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7771
7772Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7773LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7774&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7775&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7776(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7777
7778.code
7779ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7780value1.1,value1,,2
7781
7782ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7783value two
7784
7785ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7786value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7787
7788ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7789attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7790
7791ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7792objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7793.endd
7794You can
7795make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7796results of LDAP lookups.
7797The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7798individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7799The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7800of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7801The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7802comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7803
7804
7805
7806
7807.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7808.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7809.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7810NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7811and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7812contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7813of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7814values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7815.code
7816[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7817.endd
7818might return the string
7819.code
7820name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7821home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7822.endd
7823(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7824.code
7825[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7826.endd
7827would just return
7828.code
7829Martin Guerre
7830.endd
7831with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7832for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7833operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7834
7835
7836
7837.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7838.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7839.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7840.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7841.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7842.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7843.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7844.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7845.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7846.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7847.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7848.cindex lookup Redis
7849Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7850and SQLite
7851databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7852might be
7853.code
7854${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7855 {$value}fail}
7856.endd
7857If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7858field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7859.code
7860${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7861 {$value}}
7862.endd
7863might be
7864.code
7865home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7866.endd
7867Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7868quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7869field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7870.code
7871Mister X
7872.endd
7873If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7874with a newline between the data for each row.
7875
7876
7877.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7878.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7879.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7880.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7881.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7882.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7883.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7884.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7885.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7886.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7887.cindex lookup Redis
7888If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7889&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7890or &%redis_servers%&
7891option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7892information.
7893(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7894queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7895&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7896For all but Redis
7897each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7898items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7899Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7900name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7901.code
7902hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7903.endd
7904Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7905&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7906option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7907.code
7908hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7909 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7910.endd
7911For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7912because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7913query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7914a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7915found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7916servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7917
7918For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7919own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7920If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7921information.
7922Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7923host, database number, and password.
7924.olist
7925The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7926port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7927higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7928.next
7929The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7930.next
7931The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7932.endlist
7933
7934The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7935convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7936respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7937itself are escaped with backslashes.
7938
7939The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7940escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7941
7942.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7943For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7944it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7945done by starting the query with
7946.display
7947&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7948.endd
7949Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7950.olist
7951If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7952global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7953of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7954taken from there.
7955.next
7956If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7957.endlist
7958The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7959Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7960successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7961
7962This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7963are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7964master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7965like this:
7966.code
7967mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7968 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7969 master/db/name/pw
7970.endd
7971In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7972.code
7973${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7974.endd
7975That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7976the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7977option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7978.code
7979${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7980.endd
7981
7982
7983.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7984For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7985causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7986socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7987An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7988the default value is &"exim"&.
7989The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7990.display
7991<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7992 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7993.endd
7994Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7995the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7996
7997No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7998the queries.
7999
8000If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8001or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8002
8003&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8004anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8005is zero because no rows are affected.
8006
8007
8008.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8009PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8010This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8011However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8012database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8013looks like this:
8014.code
8015hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8016.endd
8017In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8018given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8019visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8020
8021If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8022update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8023affected.
8024
8025.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8026.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8027.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8028SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8029addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8030daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8031of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8032separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8033contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8034.code
8035${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8036 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8037.endd
8038In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8039.code
8040domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8041 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8042.endd
8043The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8044quote, which it doubles.
8045
8046.cindex timeout SQLite
8047.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8048The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8049internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8050update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8051are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8052waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8053to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8054option.
8055
8056.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8057.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8058.cindex "redis lookup type"
8059Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8060Examples:
8061.code
8062${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8063${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8064.endd
8065
8066As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8067Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8068of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8069master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8070servers.
8071
8072When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8073immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8074to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8075reached.
8076
8077.ecindex IIDfidalo1
8078.ecindex IIDfidalo2
8079
8080
8081. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8082. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8083
8084.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8085 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8086 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8087.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8088A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8089email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8090contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8091are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8092arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8093
8094Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8095host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8096different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8097general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8098
8099Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8100support all the complexity available in
8101domain, host, address and local part lists.
8102
8103
8104
8105.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8106.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8107Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8108
8109&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8110splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8111
8112The result of
8113expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8114into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8115but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8116&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8117discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8118
8119
8120If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8121testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8122expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8123
8124If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8125other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8126misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8127the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8128expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8129.code
8130deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8131 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8132.endd
8133The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8134&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8135senders based on the receiving domain.
8136
8137
8138
8139
8140.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8141.cindex "list" "negation"
8142.cindex "negation" "in lists"
8143Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8144leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8145defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8146it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8147(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8148
8149The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8150subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8151subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8152subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8153was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8154.code
8155domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8156.endd
8157matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8158neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8159list is positive. However, if the setting were
8160.code
8161domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8162.endd
8163then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8164list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8165as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8166
8167Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8168the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8169item.
8170
8171
8172
8173.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8174.cindex "list" "filename in"
8175If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8176filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8177processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8178filenames are not allowed,
8179and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8180Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8181lines:
8182
8183.ilist
8184For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8185file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8186.next
8187Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8188address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8189white space or the start of the line. For example:
8190.code
8191not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8192.endd
8193.endlist
8194
8195Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8196file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8197is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8198so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8199
8200If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8201within the file is inverted. For example, if
8202.code
8203hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8204.endd
8205and the file contains the lines
8206.code
8207!a.b.c
8208*.b.c
8209.endd
8210then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8211any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8212
8213
8214
8215.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8216As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8217to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8218confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8219an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8220sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8221non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8222always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8223
8224If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8225list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8226in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8227&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8228
8229
8230
8231
8232.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8233.cindex "named lists"
8234.cindex "list" "named"
8235A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8236which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8237particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8238places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8239the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8240a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8241locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8242.code
8243domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8244.endd
8245Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8246for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8247configured with the line
8248.code
8249domains = +local_domains
8250.endd
8251The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8252except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8253.code
8254dnslookup:
8255 driver = dnslookup
8256 domains = ! +local_domains
8257 transport = remote_smtp
8258 no_more
8259.endd
8260The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8261the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8262respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8263equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8264.code
8265hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8266addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8267.endd
8268A named list may refer to other named lists:
8269.code
8270domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8271domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8272domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8273.endd
8274&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8275effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8276out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8277.code
8278domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8279domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8280.endd
8281The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8282list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8283means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8284.code
8285domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8286.endd
8287where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8288referenced lists if you can.
8289
8290Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8291address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8292lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8293.code
8294domains = +local_domains
8295.endd
8296on several of your routers
8297or in several ACL statements,
8298the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8299if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8300references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8301the same each time they are referenced.
8302
8303By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8304extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8305is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8306hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8307
8308
8309
8310.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8311.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8312.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8313At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8314configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8315write
8316.code
8317ALIST = host1 : host2
8318auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8319.endd
8320it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8321.code
8322auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8323.endd
8324Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8325list, and write
8326.code
8327hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8328auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8329.endd
8330the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8331.code
8332auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8333.endd
8334
8335
8336.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8337.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8338.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8339While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8340it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8341the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8342that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8343an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8344message. For example:
8345.code
8346domainlist special_domains = \
8347 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8348.endd
8349This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8350address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8351in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8352cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8353same list each time.
8354
8355By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8356cache the result anyway. For example:
8357.code
8358domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8359.endd
8360If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8361the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8362
8363
8364
8365.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8366.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8367.cindex "list" "domain list"
8368Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8369The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8370
8371.ilist
8372.cindex "primary host name"
8373.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8374.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8375.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8376.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8377If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8378as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8379possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8380differ only in their names.
8381.next
8382.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8383.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8384.cindex "domain literal"
8385If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8386in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8387only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8388&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8389control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8390In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8391.next
8392.cindex "@mx_any"
8393.cindex "@mx_primary"
8394.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8395.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8396If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8397has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8398.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8399&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8400are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8401local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8402but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8403preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8404
8405The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8406performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8407example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8408resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8409options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8410
8411Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8412patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8413list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8414ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8415on a router). For example:
8416.code
8417domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8418.endd
8419This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8420the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8421
8422The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8423host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8424contain negative items.
8425
8426Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8427be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8428list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8429.code
8430domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8431 an.other.domain : ...
8432.endd
8433so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8434involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8435.code
8436domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8437 an.other.domain ? ...
8438.endd
8439.next
8440.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8441.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8442.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8443If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8444are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8445domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8446list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8447matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8448list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8449&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8450
8451.next
8452.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8453.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8454If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8455expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8456function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8457Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8458default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8459with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8460are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8461
8462&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8463must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8464use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8465it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8466expression by expansion, of course).
8467.next
8468.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8469.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8470If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8471semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8472must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8473&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8474.code
8475domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8476.endd
8477The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8478key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8479only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8480is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8481or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8482&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8483other statements in the same ACL.
8484
8485.next
8486Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8487&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8488.code
8489domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8490.endd
8491This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8492works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8493
8494.next
8495.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8496Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8497a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8498original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8499select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8500value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8501expansion variable.
8502.next
8503If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8504semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8505pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8506chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8507.code
8508hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8509 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8510.endd
8511In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8512example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8513whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8514&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8515variable and can be referred to in other options.
8516.next
8517.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8518If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8519between the pattern and the domain.
8520.endlist
8521
8522Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8523.code
8524domainlist funny_domains = \
8525 @ : \
8526 lib.unseen.edu : \
8527 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8528 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8529 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8530 nis;domains.byname : \
8531 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8532.endd
8533There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8534an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8535explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8536but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8537patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8538patterns earlier.
8539
8540
8541
8542.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8543.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8544.cindex "list" "host list"
8545Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8546example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8547may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8548two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8549pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8550You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8551involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8552
8553
8554.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8555.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8556.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8557If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8558involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8559process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8560not used.
8561
8562.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8563The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8564the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8565
8566
8567
8568.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8569.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8570If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8571the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8572&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8573list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8574systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8575concerns.)
8576
8577The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8578inspecting its IP address:
8579
8580.ilist
8581If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8582with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8583to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8584&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8585This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8586with the IP address of the subject host.
8587
8588If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8589lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8590ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8591temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8592what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8593
8594.next
8595.cindex "@ in a host list"
8596If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8597domain name, as just described.
8598
8599.next
8600If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8601subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8602IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8603be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8604separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8605without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8606IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8607that can never match a client host.
8608
8609.next
8610.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8611If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8612the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8613interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8614.code
8615accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8616accept hosts = @[]
8617.endd
8618.next
8619.cindex "CIDR notation"
8620If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8621example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8622host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8623included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8624specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8625significant end of the address.
8626
8627&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8628of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8629address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8630addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8631.code
8632192.168.23.236/31
8633.endd
8634matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
863532 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8636matches.
8637
8638Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8639.code
8640recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8641 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8642.endd
8643The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8644appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8645For example:
8646.code
8647recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8648.endd
8649could make use of a file containing
8650.code
8651172.16.0.0/12
86523ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8653.endd
8654to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8655addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8656changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8657.code
8658recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8659 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8660.endd
8661The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8662list.
8663.endlist
8664
8665
8666
8667.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8668 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8669.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8670When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8671address, the pattern takes this form:
8672.display
8673&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8674.endd
8675For example:
8676.code
8677hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8678.endd
8679The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8680IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8681letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8682&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8683quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8684returned by the lookup is not used.
8685
8686.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8687.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8688Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8689patterns of this form:
8690.display
8691&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8692.endd
8693For example:
8694.code
8695net24-dbm;/networks.db
8696.endd
8697The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8698length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8699mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8700is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8701&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8702
8703When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8704of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8705terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8706to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8707recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8708(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8709For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8710converted using colons and not dots.
8711.new
8712In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8713addresses are always used.
8714The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8715.wen
8716
8717Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8718colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8719However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8720configurations.
8721
8722&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8723IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8724the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8725case the IP address is used on its own.
8726
8727
8728
8729.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8730.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8731.cindex "unknown host name"
8732.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8733There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8734remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8735complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8736address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8737above.)
8738
8739If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8740patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8741Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8742DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8743Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8744effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8745Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8746
8747Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8748against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8749
8750By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8751if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8752&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8753are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8754security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8755for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8756Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8757discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8758found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8759
8760There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8761found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8762
8763.cindex "host" "alias for"
8764.cindex "alias for host"
8765As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8766of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8767
8768.ilist
8769.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8770If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8771the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8772&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8773requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8774expression.
8775.next
8776.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8777.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8778If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8779matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8780expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8781case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8782syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8783example,
8784.code
8785^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8786.endd
8787is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8788&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8789that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8790string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8791part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8792.code
8793sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8794.endd
8795&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8796&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8797example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8798required.
8799.endlist
8800
8801
8802
8803
8804.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8805.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8806While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8807name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8808from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8809behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8810
8811&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8812apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8813
8814.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8815.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8816Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8817lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8818Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8819does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8820To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8821&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8822not recognized in an indirected file).
8823
8824.ilist
8825If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8826cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8827.code
8828host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8829.endd
8830rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8831any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8832
8833.next
8834If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8835be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8836example:
8837.code
8838accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8839 192.168.4.5
8840.endd
8841accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8842whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8843name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8844.endlist
8845
8846Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8847list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8848list.
8849
8850.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8851 "SECTmixwilhos"
8852.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8853
8854This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8855as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8856wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8857
8858.ilist
8859If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8860IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8861addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8862.code
8863accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8864.endd
8865The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8866left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8867without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8868a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8869pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8870&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8871if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8872
8873.next
8874If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8875address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8876.code
8877accept hosts = *.friend.example
8878accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8879.endd
8880If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8881&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8882&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8883this section.
8884.endlist
8885
8886
8887.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8888 "SECTtemdnserr"
8889.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8890.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8891.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8892A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8893&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8894host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8895&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8896section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8897host lists such as whitelists.
8898
8899
8900
8901.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8902 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8903.cindex "unknown host name"
8904.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8905If a pattern is of the form
8906.display
8907<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8908.endd
8909for example
8910.code
8911dbm;/host/accept/list
8912.endd
8913a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8914lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8915is not used.
8916
8917&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8918keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8919addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8920&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8921two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8922lookup, both using the same file.
8923
8924
8925
8926.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8927If a pattern is of the form
8928.display
8929<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8930.endd
8931the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8932data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8933&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8934.code
8935hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8936 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8937.endd
8938The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8939can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8940use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8941operator.
8942
8943If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8944looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8945&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8946
8947Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8948host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8949&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8950still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8951effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8952See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8953
8954
8955
8956
8957
8958.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8959.cindex "list" "address list"
8960.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8961.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8962Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8963is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8964always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8965list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8966using this option setting:
8967.code
8968senders = :
8969.endd
8970The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8971data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8972detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8973and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8974
8975Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8976example:
8977.code
8978senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8979.endd
8980A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8981character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8982semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8983subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8984with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8985the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8986wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8987.code
8988deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8989 *@+hostile_domains:\
8990 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8991 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8992.endd
8993.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8994.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8995If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8996specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8997treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8998
8999If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9000contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9001address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9002domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9003is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9004.code
9005deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9006.endd
9007
9008The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9009address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9010senders:
9011
9012.ilist
9013.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9014.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9015If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9016done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9017You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9018as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9019to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9020.code
9021deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9022 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9023.endd
9024The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9025start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9026
9027.next
9028.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9029Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9030lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9031example:
9032.code
9033deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9034 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9035 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9036.endd
9037Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9038lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9039not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9040always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9041
9042Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9043cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9044panic log.
9045.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9046However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9047&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9048default. For example, with this lookup:
9049.code
9050accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9051.endd
9052the file could contains lines like this:
9053.code
9054user1@domain1.example
9055*@domain2.example
9056.endd
9057and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9058that are tried is:
9059.code
9060nimrod@jaeger.example
9061*@jaeger.example
9062*
9063.endd
9064&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9065would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9066
9067&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9068.code
9069deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9070deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9071.endd
9072The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9073because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9074domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9075.endlist
9076
9077
9078The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9079If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9080always fails.
9081
9082
9083.ilist
9084.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9085.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9086.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9087If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9088(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9089split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9090it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9091from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9092of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9093
9094.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9095The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9096keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9097patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9098even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9099with
9100.code
9101deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9102.endd
9103the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9104.code
9105baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9106.endd
9107to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9108
9109.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9110If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9111has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9112may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9113but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9114surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9115.code
9116aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9117 spammer3 : spammer4
9118.endd
9119As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9120doubling.
9121
9122If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9123of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9124list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9125might have entries like
9126.code
9127aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9128xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9129*: ^\d{8}$
9130.endd
9131in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9132local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9133each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9134chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9135
9136.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9137It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9138them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9139
9140.next
9141The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9142lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9143can only return a single list of local parts.
9144.endlist
9145
9146&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9147in these two examples:
9148.code
9149senders = +my_list
9150senders = *@+my_list
9151.endd
9152In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9153example it is a named domain list.
9154
9155
9156
9157
9158.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9159.cindex "case of local parts"
9160.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9161.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9162Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9163case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9164Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9165Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9166blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9167lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9168default.
9169
9170The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9171address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9172comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9173the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9174that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9175keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9176works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9177case-independent.
9178
9179.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9180To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9181an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9182part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9183longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9184lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9185performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9186become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9187
9188
9189
9190.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9191.cindex "list" "local part list"
9192.cindex "local part" "list"
9193Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9194lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9195setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9196set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9197case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9198matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9199&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9200option is case-sensitive from the start.
9201
9202If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9203comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9204only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9205Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9206that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9207&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9208Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9209types.
9210.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9211
9212
9213
9214
9215. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9216. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9217
9218.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9219.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9220Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9221them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9222
9223When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9224.cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9225when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9226start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9227below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9228escape character, as described in the following section.
9229
9230Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9231dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9232options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9233the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9234conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9235reasons,
9236.new
9237.cindex "tainted data" expansion
9238.cindex expansion "tainted data"
9239and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9240is not permitted.
9241.wen
9242
9243
9244
9245.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9246.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9247An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9248backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9249character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9250If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9251required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9252the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9253
9254.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9255A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9256two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9257expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9258.code
9259deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9260.endd
9261On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9262without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9263string.
9264
9265
9266
9267.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9268.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9269A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9270expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9271carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9272octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9273backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9274encoding.
9275
9276These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9277in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9278and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9279
9280
9281.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9282.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9283.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9284.oindex "&%-be%&"
9285Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9286takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9287arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9288to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9289since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9290value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9291database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9292and &%nhash%&.
9293
9294Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9295instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9296using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9297
9298.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9299If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9300from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9301option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9302read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9303.code
9304exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9305.endd
9306The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9307Exim message identifier. For example:
9308.code
9309exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9310.endd
9311This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9312is therefore restricted to admin users.
9313
9314
9315.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9316.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9317A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9318alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9319(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9320used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9321instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9322the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9323that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9324its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9325from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9326taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9327being expanded.
9328
9329
9330
9331
9332.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9333The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9334between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9335outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9336white space is significant.
9337
9338.vlist
9339.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9340.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9341Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9342.code
9343$local_part
9344${domain}
9345.endd
9346The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9347characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9348&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9349section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9350given, the expansion fails.
9351
9352.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9353.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9354The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9355<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9356.code
9357${lc:$local_part}
9358.endd
9359The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9360leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9361below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9362one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9363string easier to understand.
9364
9365.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9366This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9367expansion item below.
9368
9369
9370.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9371.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9372.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9373The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9374arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9375Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9376arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9377and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9378are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9379a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9380the result of the expansion.
9381If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9382the expansion result is an empty string.
9383If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9384
9385
9386.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9387.cindex authentication "results header"
9388.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9389.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9390This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9391&'Authentication-Results:'&
9392header line.
9393The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9394will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9395Methods that might be present in the result include:
9396.code
9397none
9398iprev
9399auth
9400spf
9401dkim
9402.endd
9403
9404Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9405.code
9406 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9407.endd
9408This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9409
9410
9411.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9412 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9413.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9414.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9415.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9416The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9417The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9418the certificate. Supported fields are:
9419.display
9420&`version `&
9421&`serial_number `&
9422&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9423&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9424&`notbefore `& time
9425&`notafter `& time
9426&`sig_algorithm `&
9427&`signature `&
9428&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9429&`ocsp_uri `& list
9430&`crl_uri `& list
9431.endd
9432If the field is found,
9433<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9434otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9435variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9436is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9437
9438If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9439key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9440extracted is used.
9441
9442Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9443
9444The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9445output a Distinguished Name string which is
9446not quite
9447parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9448(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9449RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9450a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9451result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9452The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9453a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9454Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9455
9456The field selectors marked as "time" above
9457take an optional modifier of "int"
9458for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9459Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9460in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9461
9462The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9463newline-separated by default,
9464(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9465The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9466a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9467
9468The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9469prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9470Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9471which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9472if so the element tags are omitted.
9473
9474If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9475
9476.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9477 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9478.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9479This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9480This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9481.code
9482EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9483.endd
9484set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9485object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9486(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9487
9488There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9489a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9490included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9491are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9492must have the following type:
9493.code
9494int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9495.endd
9496Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9497function should return one of the following values:
9498
9499&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9500into the expanded string that is being built.
9501
9502&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9503from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9504
9505&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9506taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9507
9508&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9509
9510When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9511you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9512configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9513
9514
9515.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9516.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9517.cindex "environment" "values from"
9518The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9519removed.
9520This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9521If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9522and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9523
9524Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9525appear, for example:
9526.code
9527${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9528.endd
9529This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9530{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9531
9532If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9533search failure.
9534If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9535search success.
9536
9537The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9538&%add_environment%& main section options.
9539
9540
9541.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9542 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9543.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9544.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9545The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9546white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9547must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9548The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9549.display
9550<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9551.endd
9552.vindex "&$value$&"
9553where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9554values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9555values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9556described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9557for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9558the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9559otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9560variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9561is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9562
9563If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9564key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9565extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9566yield &"2001"&:
9567.code
9568${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9569${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9570.endd
9571Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9572appear, for example:
9573.code
9574${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9575.endd
9576This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9577{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9578
9579.vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9580 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9581 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9582 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9583.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9584.cindex JSON expansions
9585The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9586white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9587must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9588The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9589.display
9590{ <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9591.endd
9592.vindex "&$value$&"
9593The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9594the spaces are optional.
9595Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9596For the &"json"& variant,
9597if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9598trailing quotes.
9599.new
9600For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9601leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9602.wen
9603. XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9604
9605The results of matching are handled as above.
9606
9607
9608.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9609 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9610.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9611.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9612The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9613apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9614This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9615behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9616extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9617argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9618<&'string3'&> as before.
9619
9620The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9621separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9622The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9623counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9624number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9625number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9626expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9627provided. For example:
9628.code
9629${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9630.endd
9631yields &"42"&, and
9632.code
9633${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9634.endd
9635yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9636empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9637
9638
9639.vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9640 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9641 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9642 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9643.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9644.cindex JSON expansions
9645The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9646apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9647
9648Field selection and result handling is as above;
9649there is no choice of field separator.
9650For the &"json"& variant,
9651if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9652trailing quotes.
9653.new
9654For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9655leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9656.wen
9657
9658
9659.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9660.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9661.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9662.vindex "&$item$&"
9663After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9664default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9665For each item
9666in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9667evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9668item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9669separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9670input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9671.code
9672${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9673.endd
9674yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9675to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9676
9677
9678.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9679.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9680.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9681This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9682early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9683(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9684
9685The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9686<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9687<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9688use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9689.code
9690${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9691.endd
9692The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9693or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9694Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9695function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9696first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9697.code
9698abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9699.endd
9700If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9701letters appear. For example:
9702.display
9703&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9704&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9705&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9706.endd
9707
9708.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9709 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9710 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9711 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9712 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9713 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9714 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9715 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9716.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9717.vindex "&$header_$&"
9718.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9719.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9720.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9721.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9722.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9723.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9724Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9725.code
9726$header_reply-to:
9727.endd
9728The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9729internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9730lines) may be present.
9731
9732The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9733the data in the header line is interpreted.
9734
9735.ilist
9736.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9737&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9738processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9739
9740.next
9741.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9742&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9743are multiple headers with a given name.
9744Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9745list-processing facilities can be used.
9746The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9747the content is &"raw"&.
9748
9749.next
9750.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9751&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9752or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9753character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9754&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9755.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9756produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9757what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9758
9759.next
9760&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9761standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9762be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9763returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9764&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9765a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9766.endlist ilist
9767
9768In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9769command of the following form:
9770.code
9771headers charset "UTF-8"
9772.endd
9773This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9774subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9775character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9776option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9777value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9778ISO-8859-1.
9779
9780Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9781any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9782&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9783if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9784
9785Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9786this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9787message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9788filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9789router or transport are not accessible.
9790
9791For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9792ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9793because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9794They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9795Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9796are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9797point they are added.
9798When any of the above ACLs ar
9799running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9800
9801Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9802following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9803this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9804white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9805expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9806expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9807section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9808header.)
9809
9810If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9811to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9812&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9813each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9814newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9815newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9816those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9817junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9818
9819
9820.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9821.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9822.cindex &%hmac%&
9823This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9824shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9825RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9826&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9827cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9828or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9829present. For example:
9830.code
9831${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9832.endd
9833For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9834produces:
9835.code
9836dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9837.endd
9838As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9839an Exim configuration:
9840.code
9841SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9842.endd
9843In a router or a transport you could then have:
9844.code
9845headers_add = \
9846 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9847 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9848 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9849.endd
9850Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9851&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9852this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9853host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9854using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9855&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9856
9857
9858.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9859.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9860.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9861If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9862item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9863in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9864.code
9865${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9866.endd
9867The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9868true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9869be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9870case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9871&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9872
9873If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9874is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9875cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9876.code
9877condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9878.endd
9879you can use
9880.code
9881condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9882.endd
9883
9884
9885
9886.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9887.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9888.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9889This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9890folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9891For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9892
9893
9894
9895.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9896.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9897.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9898The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9899strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9900you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9901change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9902some of the braces:
9903.code
9904${length_<n>:<string>}
9905.endd
9906The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9907of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9908&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9909All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9910
9911
9912.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9913 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9914.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9915.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9916.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9917The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9918apart from an optional leading minus,
9919and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9920
9921After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9922default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9923
9924The first field of the list is numbered one.
9925If the number is negative, the fields are
9926counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9927The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9928then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9929
9930If the modulus of the
9931number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9932the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9933
9934For example:
9935.code
9936${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9937.endd
9938yields &"42"&, and
9939.code
9940${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9941.endd
9942yields &"result: 42"&.
9943
9944If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9945If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9946extracted is used.
9947You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9948
9949
9950.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9951 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9952This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9953described in the next item.
9954
9955.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9956 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9957.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9958.cindex "file" "lookups"
9959.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9960The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9961discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9962lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9963<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9964
9965If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9966a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9967other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9968in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9969out by the system administrator.
9970
9971.vindex "&$value$&"
9972If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9973During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9974lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9975level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9976the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9977string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9978lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9979original lookup fails.
9980
9981If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9982data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9983expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9984the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9985appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9986to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9987{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9988successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9989
9990For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9991search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9992type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9993&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9994
9995.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9996If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9997and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9998They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9999
10000This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10001.code
10002${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10003.endd
10004This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10005the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10006.code
10007${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10008 {$value}fail}
10009.endd
10010
10011
10012.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10013.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10014.vindex "&$item$&"
10015After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10016default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10017For each item
10018in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10019expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10020for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10021setting is not included in the output. For example:
10022.code
10023${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10024.endd
10025expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10026value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10027and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10028
10029.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10030.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10031.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10032The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10033<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10034if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10035can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10036.code
10037${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10038.endd
10039The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10040the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10041processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10042slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10043example,
10044.code
10045${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10046.endd
10047returns the string &"6/33"&.
10048
10049
10050
10051.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10052.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10053.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10054This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10055interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10056expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10057additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10058name of the subroutine, is nine.
10059
10060The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10061the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10062way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10063Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10064return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10065not its contents.
10066
10067If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10068with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10069Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10070
10071The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10072out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10073
10074
10075.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10076.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10077The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10078keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10079it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10080to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10081as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10082and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10083
10084.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10085 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10086.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10087This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10088checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10089yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10090empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10091prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10092version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10093variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10094
10095These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10096retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10097against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10098which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10099
10100The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10101string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10102result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10103whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10104is the expansion of the third argument.
10105
10106All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10107However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10108For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10109
10110.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10111.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10112.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10113.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10114The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10115then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10116the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10117newlines are left in the string.
10118String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10119you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10120the string expansion fails.
10121
10122The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10123locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10124
10125
10126
10127.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10128 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10129.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10130.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10131.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10132This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10133string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10134examples:
10135.code
10136${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10137${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10138.endd
10139For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10140For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10141a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10142number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10143optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10144example:
10145.code
10146${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10147.endd
10148Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10149one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10150both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10151unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10152and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10153is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10154extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10155.code
10156${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10157.endd
10158
10159The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10160and must be present if the argument is given.
10161Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10162Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10163The first defines whether (the default)
10164or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10165Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10166.code
10167${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10168.endd
10169The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10170.code
10171${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10172.endd
10173The default is to not use TLS.
10174If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10175
10176A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10177that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10178turns them into spaces:
10179.code
10180${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10181.endd
10182As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10183happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10184addition, the following errors can occur:
10185
10186.ilist
10187Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10188.next
10189Failure to connect the socket;
10190.next
10191Failure to write the request string;
10192.next
10193Timeout on reading from the socket.
10194.endlist
10195
10196By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10197you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10198errors occurs. For example:
10199.code
10200${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10201 {socket failure}}
10202.endd
10203You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10204expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10205and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10206if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10207non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10208
10209The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10210locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10211
10212
10213.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10214.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10215.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10216.vindex "&$value$&"
10217.vindex "&$item$&"
10218This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10219<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10220separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10221Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10222assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10223list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10224them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10225iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10226added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10227number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10228.code
10229${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10230.endd
10231The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10232can be found:
10233.code
10234${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10235.endd
10236At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10237restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10238expansion items.
10239
10240.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10241This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10242expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10243
10244.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10245 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10246.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10247.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10248The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10249split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10250in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10251executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10252a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10253
10254Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10255which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10256simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10257script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10258variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10259quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10260in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10261around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10262variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10263character.
10264
10265The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10266and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10267.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10268.vindex "&$value$&"
10269If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10270and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10271from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10272<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10273expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10274&$value$&.
10275
10276If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10277can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10278command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10279of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10280
10281.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10282The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10283In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10284troubleshoot:
10285.code
10286warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10287 log_message = Output of id: $value
10288.endd
10289If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10290shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10291.code
10292${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10293.endd
10294
10295.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10296The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10297remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10298.code
10299if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10300 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10301 ...
10302endif
10303.endd
10304If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10305the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10306commands.
10307
10308&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10309option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10310testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10311by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10312
10313The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10314out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10315
10316
10317.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10318.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10319.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10320This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10321option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10322modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10323into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10324a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10325.code
10326${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10327.endd
10328yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10329if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10330substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10331.code
10332${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10333.endd
10334yields &"defabc"&, and
10335.code
10336${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10337.endd
10338yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10339the regular expression from string expansion.
10340
10341The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10342rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10343
10344
10345.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10346.cindex sorting "a list"
10347.cindex list sorting
10348.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10349After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10350default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10351The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10352of a two-argument expansion condition.
10353The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10354The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10355if the first value should sort before the second value.
10356The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10357the element being placed in &$item$&,
10358to give values for comparison.
10359
10360The item result is a sorted list,
10361with the original list separator,
10362of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10363
10364Examples:
10365.code
10366${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10367.endd
10368sorts a list of numbers, and
10369.code
10370${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10371.endd
10372will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10373
10374
10375.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10376.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10377.cindex "substring extraction"
10378.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10379The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10380<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10381if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10382can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10383.code
10384${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10385.endd
10386The second number is optional (in both notations).
10387If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10388omitted.
10389
10390The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10391&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10392length required. For example
10393.code
10394${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10395.endd
10396If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10397null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10398length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10399given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10400
10401The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10402from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10403the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10404.code
10405${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10406.endd
10407yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10408length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10409the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10410.code
10411${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10412.endd
10413yields an empty string, but
10414.code
10415${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10416.endd
10417yields &"1"&.
10418
10419When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10420is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10421string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10422no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10423.code
10424${substr_-1:abcde}
10425${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10426.endd
10427yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10428
10429All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10430
10431
10432
10433.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10434 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10435.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10436.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10437This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10438argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10439matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10440replacement list. For example
10441.code
10442${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10443.endd
10444yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10445last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10446last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10447place.
10448
10449All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10450
10451.endlist
10452
10453
10454
10455.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10456.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10457For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10458the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10459The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10460following operations can be performed:
10461
10462.vlist
10463.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10464.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10465.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10466The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10467header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10468not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10469
10470The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10471
10472
10473.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10474.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10475.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10476The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
104772822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10478operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10479result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10480doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10481Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10482
10483It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10484separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10485character. For example:
10486.code
10487${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10488.endd
10489expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10490first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10491separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10492separator explicitly:
10493.code
10494${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10495.endd
10496
10497Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10498expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10499address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10500processing lists.
10501
10502To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10503a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10504unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10505email address separator. For the example header line:
10506.code
10507From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10508.endd
10509The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10510properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10511It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10512example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10513de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10514The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10515quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10516.code
10517# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10518=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10519user@example.com
10520# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10521Last:user@example.com
10522# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10523user@example.com
10524# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10525フィリップ@example.jp
10526.endd
10527
10528.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10529.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10530.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10531The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10532base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10533Only lowercase letters are used.
10534
10535.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10536.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10537.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10538The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10539The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10540
10541.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10542.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10543.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10544The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10545base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10546the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10547its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10548filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10549to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10550
10551.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10552.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10553.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10554The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10555environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10556identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10557string.
10558
10559.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10560.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10561.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10562.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10563.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10564This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10565
10566If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10567returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10568
10569
10570.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10571.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10572.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10573.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10574This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10575
10576
10577.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10578.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10579.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10580The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10581from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10582
10583
10584.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10585.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10586.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10587If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10588escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10589significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10590is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10591
10592.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10593.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10594.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10595If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10596they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10597Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10598
10599
10600.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10601.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10602.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10603.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10604These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10605expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10606arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10607logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10608integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10609C programming language):
10610.table2 70pt 300pt
10611.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10612.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10613.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10614.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10615.irow "" "and (&&)"
10616.irow "" "xor (^)"
10617.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10618.endtable
10619Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10620space is permitted before or after operators.
10621
10622For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10623hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10624decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10625permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10626times, which often do have leading zeros.
10627
10628A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10629or 1024*1024*1024,
10630respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10631a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10632
10633.display
10634&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10635&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10636&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10637&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10638&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10639&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10640&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10641&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10642&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10643&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10644&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10645.endd
10646
10647As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10648.code
10649deny message = Too many bad recipients
10650 condition = \
10651 ${if and { \
10652 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10653 { \
10654 < \
10655 {$recipients_count} \
10656 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10657 } \
10658 }{yes}{no}}
10659.endd
10660The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10661fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10662
10663
10664.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10665.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10666The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10667example,
10668.code
10669${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10670.endd
10671first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10672and then re-expands what it has found.
10673
10674
10675.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10676.cindex "Unicode"
10677.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10678.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10679.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10680The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10681email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10682to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10683UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10684converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10685the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10686
10687Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10688ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10689For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10690way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10691characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10692single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10693translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10694
10695
10696.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10697.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10698.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10699The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10700be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10701change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10702.code
10703${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10704.endd
10705See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10706abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10707
10708
10709
10710.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10711.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10712.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10713.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10714This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10715be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10716
10717
10718
10719.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10720.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10721.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10722This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10723escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10724as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10725byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10726
10727
10728.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10729.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10730.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10731This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10732of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10733A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10734Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10735
10736.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10737.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10738.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10739.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10740This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10741Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10742set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10743A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10744Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10745
10746
10747.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10748.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10749.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10750.cindex "lower casing"
10751.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10752.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10753This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10754.code
10755${lc:$local_part}
10756.endd
10757Case is defined per the system C locale.
10758
10759.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10760.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10761.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10762The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10763can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10764changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10765.code
10766${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10767.endd
10768See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10769&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10770when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10771All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10772
10773
10774.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10775.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10776.cindex "list" "item count"
10777.cindex "list" "count of items"
10778.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10779The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10780
10781
10782.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10783.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10784.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10785The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10786expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10787If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10788and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10789Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10790matching list is returned.
10791
10792
10793.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10794.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10795.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10796The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10797extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10798empty.
10799The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10800
10801
10802.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10803.cindex "masked IP address"
10804.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10805.cindex "CIDR notation"
10806.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10807.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10808If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10809slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10810expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10811masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10812the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10813.code
10814${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10815.endd
10816returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10817be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10818address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10819terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10820.code
10821${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10822.endd
10823returns the string
10824.code
108253ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10826.endd
10827Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10828
10829
10830.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10831.cindex "MD5 hash"
10832.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10833.cindex certificate fingerprint
10834.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10835The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10836as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10837
10838If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10839returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10840
10841
10842.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10843.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10844.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10845The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10846that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10847strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10848.code
10849${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10850.endd
10851See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10852
10853
10854.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10855.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10856.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10857.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10858The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10859is an empty string or
10860contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10861Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10862Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10863respectively For example,
10864.code
10865${quote:ab"*"cd}
10866.endd
10867becomes
10868.code
10869"ab\"*\"cd"
10870.endd
10871The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10872variable or a message header.
10873
10874.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10875.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10876This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10877required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10878example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10879If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10880(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10881
10882This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10883will likely use the quoting form.
10884Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10885
10886
10887.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10888.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10889This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10890query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10891the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10892.code
10893${quote_ldap:two * two}
10894.endd
10895returns
10896.code
10897two%20%5C2A%20two
10898.endd
10899For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10900yields an unchanged string.
10901
10902
10903.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10904.cindex "random number"
10905This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10906supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10907on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10908If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10909If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10910for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10911Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10912srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10913random().
10914
10915
10916.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10917.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10918This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10919dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10920dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10921for DNS. For example,
10922.code
10923${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10924${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10925.endd
10926returns
10927.code
109284.2.0.192
10929f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10930.endd
10931
10932
10933.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10934.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10935.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10936.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10937This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10938encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10939assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10940&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10941contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10942characters
10943.code
10944? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10945.endd
10946it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10947string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10948characters.
10949
10950
10951.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10952.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10953.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10954.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10955This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10956bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10957character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10958not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10959
10960&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10961access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10962to use this operator as well.
10963
10964
10965
10966.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10967.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10968.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10969.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10970The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10971characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10972variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10973
10974
10975.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10976.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10977.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10978.cindex certificate fingerprint
10979.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10980The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10981it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10982
10983If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10984returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10985
10986
10987.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10988 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10989 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10990.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10991.cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10992.cindex certificate fingerprint
10993.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10994.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10995.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10996The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10997and returns
10998it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10999
11000If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11001returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11002
11003.new
11004The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11005(except for certificates, which are not supported).
11006Finally, if an underbar
11007and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11008member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11009Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11010.wen
11011
11012
11013.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11014 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11015.cindex "SHA3 hash"
11016.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11017.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11018The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11019and returns
11020it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11021
11022If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11023the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11024with 256 being the default.
11025
11026The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11027compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11028or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11029The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11030
11031
11032.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11033.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11034.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11035.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11036The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11037function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11038expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11039series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11040except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11041a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1104210-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11043&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11044can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11045
11046The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11047the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11048systems for files larger than 2GB.
11049
11050.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11051.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11052Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11053
11054
11055
11056.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11057.cindex "expansion" "string length"
11058.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11059.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11060The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11061decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11062All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11063
11064
11065.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11066.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11067.cindex "substring extraction"
11068.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11069The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11070can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11071that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11072.code
11073${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11074.endd
11075See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11076abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11077All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11078
11079.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11080.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11081.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11082This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11083seconds.
11084
11085.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11086.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11087.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11088The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11089represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11090number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11091&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11092
11093.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11094.cindex "case forcing in strings"
11095.cindex "string" "case forcing"
11096.cindex "upper casing"
11097.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11098.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11099This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11100Case is defined per the system C locale.
11101
11102.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11103.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11104.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11105.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11106.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11107.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11108This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11109In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11110final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11111If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11112the complexity will depend upon the task.
11113For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11114extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11115dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11116.code
11117condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11118.endd
11119(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11120literal question mark).
11121
11122.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11123 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11124 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11125 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11126.cindex expansion UTF-8
11127.cindex UTF-8 expansion
11128.cindex EAI
11129.cindex internationalisation
11130.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11131.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11132.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11133.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11134These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11135For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11136.endlist
11137
11138
11139
11140
11141
11142
11143.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11144.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11145The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11146while expanding strings:
11147
11148.vlist
11149.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11150.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11151.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11152Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11153condition.
11154
11155.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11156.cindex "numeric comparison"
11157.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11158There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11159are:
11160.display
11161&`= `& equal
11162&`== `& equal
11163&`> `& greater
11164&`>= `& greater or equal
11165&`< `& less
11166&`<= `& less or equal
11167.endd
11168For example:
11169.code
11170${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11171.endd
11172Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11173two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11174optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11175lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11176As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11177zero.
11178
11179In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11180<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1118110M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11182
11183
11184.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11185 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11186.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11187.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11188The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11189arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11190Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11191arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11192and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11193are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11194a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11195the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11196If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11197If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11198
11199.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11200.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11201.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11202This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11203a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11204(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11205false if zero.
11206An empty string is treated as false.
11207Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11208thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11209All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11210
11211When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11212make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11213For example:
11214.code
11215${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11216.endd
11217
11218
11219.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11220.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11221.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11222Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11223where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11224loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11225and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11226true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11227
11228Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11229
11230.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11231.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11232.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11233.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11234This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11235authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11236necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11237included in the binary.
11238
11239The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11240compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11241be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11242encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11243does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11244&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11245Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11246string in LDAP form is:
11247.code
11248{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11249.endd
11250If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11251be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11252.code
11253${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11254.endd
11255The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11256supported:
11257
11258.ilist
11259.cindex "MD5 hash"
11260.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11261&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11262printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11263length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11264(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11265hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11266comparison fails.
11267
11268.next
11269.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11270&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11271printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11272length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11273If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11274SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11275
11276.next
11277.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11278&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11279only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11280systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11281whatever its length.
11282
11283.next
11284.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11285&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11286use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11287modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11288.endlist
11289Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11290&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11291HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11292operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11293the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11294support &[crypt16()]&.
11295
11296Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11297it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11298turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11299&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11300algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11301
11302However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11303functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11304Exim is seen as very low priority.
11305
11306If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11307comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11308determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11309default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11310function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11311
11312.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11313.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11314.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11315The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11316variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11317variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11318.code
11319${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11320.endd
11321Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11322variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11323
11324.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11325 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11326.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11327This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11328exists in the message. For example,
11329.code
11330${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11331.endd
11332&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11333the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11334
11335.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11336 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11337.cindex "string" "comparison"
11338.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11339.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11340.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11341The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11342resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11343letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11344case is defined per the system C locale.
11345
11346.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11347.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11348.cindex "file" "existence test"
11349.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11350The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11351condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11352is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11353users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11354
11355.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11356.cindex "delivery" "first"
11357.cindex "first delivery"
11358.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11359.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11360This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11361attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11362
11363
11364.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11365 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11366.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11367.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11368.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11369.vindex "&$item$&"
11370These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11371the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11372the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11373The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11374be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11375condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11376.ilist
11377For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11378the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11379items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11380.next
11381For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11382and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11383all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11384.endlist
11385Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11386items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11387that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11388list separator is changed to a comma:
11389.code
11390${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11391.endd
11392The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11393being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11394
11395To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11396
11397.new
11398.vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11399 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11400 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11401 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11402.cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11403.cindex JSON expansions
11404.cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11405.cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11406.cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11407.cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11408As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11409be a JSON array.
11410The array separator is not changeable.
11411For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11412and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11413.wen
11414
11415
11416
11417.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11418 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11419.cindex "string" "comparison"
11420.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11421.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11422.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11423The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11424string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11425comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11426case-independent.
11427Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11428
11429.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11430 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11431.cindex "string" "comparison"
11432.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11433.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11434.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11435The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11436string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11437includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11438case-independent.
11439Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11440
11441.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11442 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11443.cindex "string" "comparison"
11444.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11445Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11446strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11447is true.
11448For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11449
11450These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11451Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11452.code
11453${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11454 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11455${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11456 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11457.endd
11458
11459.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11460 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11461 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11462.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11463.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11464.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11465.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11466.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11467The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11468an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11469&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11470
11471For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11472which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11473colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11474hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11475component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11476
11477&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11478values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11479check.
11480This is no longer the case.
11481
11482The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11483host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11484.code
11485${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11486.endd
11487to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11488
11489.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11490.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11491.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11492.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11493This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11494&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11495queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11496query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11497password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11498server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11499with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11500will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11501of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11502this can be used.
11503
11504
11505.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11506 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11507.cindex "string" "comparison"
11508.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11509.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11510.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11511The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11512string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11513comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11514case-independent.
11515Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11516
11517.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11518 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11519.cindex "string" "comparison"
11520.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11521.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11522.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11523The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11524string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11525includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11526case-independent.
11527Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11528
11529
11530.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11531.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11532.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11533.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11534The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11535expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11536regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11537escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11538(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11539premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11540&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11541For example,
11542.code
11543${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11544.endd
11545If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11546backslashes is also required.
11547
11548The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11549The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11550metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11551and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11552the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11553metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11554All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11555but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11556
11557.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11558At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11559substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11560succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11561will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11562of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11563combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11564variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11565
11566.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11567.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11568See &*match_local_part*&.
11569
11570.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11571.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11572See &*match_local_part*&.
11573
11574.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11575.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11576This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11577be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11578address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11579list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11580.code
11581${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11582.endd
11583The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11584
11585.ilist
11586An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11587.next
11588A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11589.next
11590An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11591useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11592in a single test such as
11593. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11594. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11595. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11596. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11597.code
11598 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11599.endd
11600where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11601.next
11602The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11603.next
11604Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11605even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11606address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11607&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11608masks. For example:
11609.code
11610 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11611.endd
11612It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11613do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11614address mask, for example:
11615.code
11616 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11617.endd
11618However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11619just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11620.code
11621 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11622.endd
11623.endlist ilist
11624
11625Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11626Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11627
11628Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11629
11630.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11631.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11632.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11633.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11634.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11635This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11636possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11637condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11638example is:
11639.code
11640${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11641.endd
11642In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11643list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11644is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11645Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11646.code
11647${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11648.endd
11649.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11650For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11651item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11652have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11653caselessly.
11654
11655Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11656Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11657
11658&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11659hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11660how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11661matched using &%match_ip%&.
11662
11663.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11664.cindex "PAM authentication"
11665.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11666.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11667.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11668.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11669&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11670(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11671available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11672distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11673the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11674.code
11675SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11676.endd
11677in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11678in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11679
11680The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11681colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11682The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11683taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11684The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11685from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11686request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11687
11688There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11689characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11690separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11691item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11692of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11693.code
11694server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11695.endd
11696For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11697.code
11698server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11699.endd
11700In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11701running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11702messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11703. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11704
11705
11706.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11707.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11708.cindex "Cyrus"
11709.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11710.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11711This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11712This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11713that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11714deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11715
11716The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11717the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11718building Exim. For example:
11719.code
11720CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11721.endd
11722You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11723the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11724from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11725access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11726
11727The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11728password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11729configuration, you might have this:
11730.code
11731server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11732.endd
11733Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11734.code
11735server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11736.endd
11737.vitem &*queue_running*&
11738.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11739.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11740.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11741This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11742initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11743
11744
11745.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11746.cindex "Radius"
11747.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11748.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11749Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11750set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11751the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11752support.
11753
11754With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11755library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11756this library, you need to set
11757.code
11758RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11759.endd
11760in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11761&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11762.code
11763RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11764.endd
11765in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11766You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11767Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11768
11769The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11770Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11771the authentication is successful. For example:
11772.code
11773server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11774.endd
11775
11776
11777.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11778 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11779.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11780.cindex "Cyrus"
11781.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11782.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11783This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11784daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11785Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11786by a process that is not running as root.
11787
11788The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11789the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11790building Exim. For example:
11791.code
11792CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11793.endd
11794You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11795the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11796from the Cyrus SASL library.
11797
11798Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11799two are mandatory. For example:
11800.code
11801server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11802.endd
11803The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11804in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11805realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11806.endlist vlist
11807
11808
11809
11810.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11811.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11812Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11813and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11814conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11815sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11816the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11817
11818
11819.vlist
11820.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11821.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11822.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11823The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11824any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11825For example,
11826.code
11827${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11828.endd
11829When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11830evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11831numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11832
11833.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11834.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11835.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11836The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11837all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11838sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11839the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11840parsed but not evaluated.
11841.endlist
11842.ecindex IIDexpcond
11843
11844
11845
11846
11847.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11848.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11849This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11850of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11851support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11852
11853.vlist
11854.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11855.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11856When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11857captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11858processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11859In the expansion condition case
11860they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11861values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11862variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11863precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11864Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11865matching condition.
11866
11867.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11868Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11869any arguments are copied to these variables,
11870any unused variables being made empty.
11871
11872.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11873Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11874can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11875long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11876example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11877variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11878used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11879same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11880with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11881during subsequent delivery.
11882
11883.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11884These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11885are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11886received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11887message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11888also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11889message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11890and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11891delivery.
11892
11893.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11894Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11895this variable has the number of arguments.
11896
11897.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11898.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11899After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11900message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11901be preserved by coding like this:
11902.code
11903warn !verify = sender
11904 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11905.endd
11906You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11907&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11908failure.
11909
11910.vitem &$address_data$&
11911.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11912This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11913value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11914and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11915the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11916for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11917user filter files.
11918
11919If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11920a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11921conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11922to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11923of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11924from the child's routing.
11925
11926If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11927sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11928&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11929address.
11930
11931In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11932after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11933these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11934
11935.vitem &$address_file$&
11936.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11937When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11938to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11939is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11940default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11941.code
11942/home/r2d2/savemail
11943.endd
11944then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11945contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11946.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11947For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11948then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11949to the relevant file.
11950
11951.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11952.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11953When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11954this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11955
11956.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11957.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11958These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11959&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11960
11961.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11962.cindex "authentication" "id"
11963.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11964When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11965preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11966&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11967user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11968in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11969&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11970
11971When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11972the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11973process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11974command line option.
11975This second case also sets up information used by the
11976&$authresults$& expansion item.
11977
11978.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11979.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11980.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11981When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11982will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11983id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11984available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11985A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11986authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11987the ACL's as well.
11988
11989
11990.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11991.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11992.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11993.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11994.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11995When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11996SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11997described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11998&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11999available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12000sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12001
12002.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12003When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12004value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12005name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12006can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12007
12008
12009.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12010.cindex "authentication" "failure"
12011.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12012This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12013command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12014possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12015(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12016&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12017is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12018negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12019an undefined mechanism.
12020
12021.vitem &$av_failed$&
12022.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12023This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12024extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12025problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12026the ACL malware condition.
12027
12028.vitem &$body_linecount$&
12029.cindex "message body" "line count"
12030.cindex "body of message" "line count"
12031.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12032When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12033number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12034
12035.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12036.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12037.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12038.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12039.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12040When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12041number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12042
12043.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12044.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12045This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12046it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12047chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12048
12049.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12050.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12051This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12052up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12053file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12054
12055.vitem &$caller_gid$&
12056.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12057.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12058The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12059not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12060&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12061incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12062
12063.vitem &$caller_uid$&
12064.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12065.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12066The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12067not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12068&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12069incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12070
12071.vitem &$callout_address$&
12072.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12073After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12074address that was connected to.
12075
12076.vitem &$compile_number$&
12077.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12078The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12079of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12080compilations of the same version of Exim.
12081
12082.vitem &$config_dir$&
12083.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12084The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12085&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12086contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12087&$config_dir$& is ".".
12088
12089.vitem &$config_file$&
12090.vindex "&$config_file$&"
12091The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12092
12093.new
12094.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12095 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12096 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12097 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12098Results of DMARC verification.
12099For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12100.wen
12101
12102.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12103Results of DKIM verification.
12104For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12105
12106.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12107 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12108 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12109 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12110 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12111 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12112 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12113 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12114 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12115 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12116 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12117 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12118 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12119 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12120 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12121 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12122 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12123 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12124 &$dkim_key_length$&
12125These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12126For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12127
12128.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12129.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12130When a message has been received this variable contains
12131a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12132For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12133
12134.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12135 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12136 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12137 &$dnslist_value$&
12138.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12139.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12140.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12141.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12142.cindex "black list (DNS)"
12143When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12144the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12145looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12146main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12147
12148.vitem &$domain$&
12149.vindex "&$domain$&"
12150When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12151contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12152case for &$domain$&.
12153
12154Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12155&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12156is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12157message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12158
12159When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12160RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12161have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12162at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12163the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12164which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12165
12166.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12167At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12168set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12169
12170The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12171
12172.ilist
12173When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12174the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12175&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12176normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12177is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12178&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12179the &(smtp)& transport.
12180
12181.next
12182When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12183&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12184it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12185rewrite domains by file lookup.
12186
12187.next
12188With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12189&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12190a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12191is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12192that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12193recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12194
12195.next
12196.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12197.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12198When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12199the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12200.endlist
12201
12202
12203.vitem &$domain_data$&
12204.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12205When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12206means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12207of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12208address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12209transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12210used.
12211
12212&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12213domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12214the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12215to nothing.
12216
12217.vitem &$exim_gid$&
12218.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12219This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12220
12221.vitem &$exim_path$&
12222.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12223This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12224
12225.vitem &$exim_uid$&
12226.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12227This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12228
12229.vitem &$exim_version$&
12230.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12231This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12232The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12233Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12234There may be other characters following the minor version.
12235This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12236
12237.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12238This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12239inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12240be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12241characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12242See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12243
12244.vitem &$headers_added$&
12245.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12246Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12247the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12248The headers are a newline-separated list.
12249
12250.vitem &$home$&
12251.vindex "&$home$&"
12252When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12253directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12254means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12255explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12256by a setting on the transport itself.
12257
12258When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12259of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12260&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12261
12262.vitem &$host$&
12263.vindex "&$host$&"
12264If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12265list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12266to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12267to local and remote transports.
12268
12269.cindex "transport" "filter"
12270.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12271For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12272&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12273particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12274using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12275&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12276is connected.
12277
12278When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12279&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12280client is connected.
12281
12282
12283.vitem &$host_address$&
12284.vindex "&$host_address$&"
12285This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12286for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12287when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12288
12289.vitem &$host_data$&
12290.vindex "&$host_data$&"
12291If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12292result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12293allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12294.code
12295deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12296message = $host_data
12297.endd
12298.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12299.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12300.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12301This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12302message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12303name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12304variables is set to &"1"&.
12305
12306.ilist
12307If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12308succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12309
12310.next
12311If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12312tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12313lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12314.endlist ilist
12315
12316Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12317single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12318names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12319is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12320&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12321IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12322sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12323lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12324the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12325&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12326
12327.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12328Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12329&%authresults%& expansion item.
12330
12331
12332.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12333.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12334See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12335
12336.vitem &$host_port$&
12337.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12338This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12339for an outbound connection.
12340
12341.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12342.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12343This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12344directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12345working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12346to &$spool_directory$& later.
12347
12348.vitem &$inode$&
12349.vindex "&$inode$&"
12350The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12351option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12352of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12353a unique name for the file.
12354
12355.vitem &$interface_address$&
12356.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12357This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12358
12359.vitem &$interface_port$&
12360.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12361This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12362
12363.vitem &$item$&
12364.vindex "&$item$&"
12365This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12366conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12367&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12368empty.
12369
12370.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12371.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12372This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12373contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12374lookup.
12375
12376.vitem &$load_average$&
12377.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12378This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12379is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12380variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12381
12382.vitem &$local_part$&
12383.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12384When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12385variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12386delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12387session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12388
12389Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12390&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12391&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12392because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12393once.
12394
12395.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12396.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12397.cindex affix variables
12398If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12399value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12400any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12401&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12402
12403When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12404result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12405the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12406&$address_pipe$&).
12407
12408When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12409local part of the recipient address.
12410
12411When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12412&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12413it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12414
12415In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12416the addresses
12417.code
12418"abc:xyz"@test.example
12419abc\:xyz@test.example
12420.endd
12421the value of &$local_part$& is
12422.code
12423abc:xyz
12424.endd
12425If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12426inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12427have:
12428.code
12429data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12430.endd
12431&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12432to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12433&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12434
12435.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12436.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12437When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12438lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12439router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12440to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12441handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12442
12443&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12444matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12445available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12446variable expands to nothing.
12447
12448.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12449.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12450.cindex affix variables
12451When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12452specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12453variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12454
12455.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12456.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12457When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12458specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12459variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12460
12461.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12462.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12463This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12464a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12465
12466.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12467.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12468See &$local_user_uid$&.
12469
12470.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12471.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12472This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12473&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12474are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12475and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12476router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12477are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12478
12479.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12480.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12481This contains the expanded value of the
12482&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12483been read.
12484
12485.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12486.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12487The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12488log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12489referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12490the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12491
12492.vitem &$log_space$&
12493.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12494The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12495partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12496whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12497ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12498the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12499
12500
12501.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12502.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12503This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12504a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12505.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12506It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12507&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12508and &"yes"& if it was.
12509Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12510the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12511as authenticated data.
12512
12513.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12514.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12515This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12516&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12517&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12518contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12519without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12520variable is empty.
12521
12522.vitem &$malware_name$&
12523.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12524This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12525content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12526when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12527
12528.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12529.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12530.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12531.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12532This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12533received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12534character(s).
12535It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12536
12537.vitem &$message_age$&
12538.cindex "message" "age of"
12539.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12540This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12541of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12542delivery attempt.
12543
12544.vitem &$message_body$&
12545.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12546.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12547.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12548.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12549.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12550This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12551being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12552number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12553&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12554
12555.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12556By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12557easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12558this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12559zeros are always converted into spaces.
12560
12561.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12562.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12563.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12564.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12565This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12566body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12567&$message_body$&.
12568
12569.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12570.cindex "body of message" "size"
12571.cindex "message body" "size"
12572.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12573When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12574in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12575separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12576also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12577
12578If the spool file is wireformat
12579(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12580the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12581
12582.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12583.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12584When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12585unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12586An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12587received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12588line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12589&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12590
12591.vitem &$message_headers$&
12592.vindex &$message_headers$&
12593This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12594is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12595lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12596same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12597
12598.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12599.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12600This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12601contents of header lines is done.
12602
12603.vitem &$message_id$&
12604This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12605
12606.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12607.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12608This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12609message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12610During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12611number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12612routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12613&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12614lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12615from the body is not counted.
12616
12617As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12618appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12619&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12620file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12621header and the body).
12622
12623Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12624.code
12625deny message = Too many lines in message header
12626 condition = \
12627 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12628.endd
12629In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12630message has not yet been received.
12631
12632This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12633
12634.vitem &$message_size$&
12635.cindex "size" "of message"
12636.cindex "message" "size"
12637.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12638When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12639most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12640message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12641deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12642expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12643doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12644precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12645&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12646
12647.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12648While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12649contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12650value may not, of course, be truthful.
12651
12652.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12653A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12654available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12655details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12656
12657.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12658These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12659of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12660
12661.vitem &$original_domain$&
12662.vindex "&$domain$&"
12663.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12664When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12665same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12666generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12667variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12668differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12669aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12670single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12671
12672If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12673filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12674part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12675
12676.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12677.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12678.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12679When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12680same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12681local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12682part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12683filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12684the original address.
12685
12686If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12687case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12688This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12689one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12690delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12691
12692If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12693filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12694part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12695
12696.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12697.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12698.cindex "sender" "gid"
12699.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12700.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12701This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12702message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12703gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12704normally the gid of the Exim user.
12705
12706.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12707.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12708.cindex "sender" "uid"
12709.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12710.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12711The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12712messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12713For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12714user.
12715
12716.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12717.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12718This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12719above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12720
12721.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12722.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12723This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12724(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12725
12726.vitem &$pid$&
12727.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12728.vindex "&$pid$&"
12729This variable contains the current process id.
12730
12731.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12732.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12733.cindex "transport" "filter"
12734.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12735This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12736&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12737&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12738(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12739It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12740variable"& error if encountered.
12741
12742.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12743.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12744This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12745configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12746a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12747&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12748qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12749
12750
12751.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12752 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12753 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12754 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12755 &$proxy_session$&
12756These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12757or SOCKS5 support.
12758For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12759
12760.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12761.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12762This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12763current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12764
12765.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12766This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12767which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12768&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12769
12770.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12771This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12772which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12773&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12774
12775.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12776This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12777which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12778&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12779
12780.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12781.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12782The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12783
12784.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12785.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12786The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12787or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12788
12789.vitem &$queue_name$&
12790.vindex &$queue_name$&
12791.cindex "named queues"
12792.cindex queues named
12793The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12794
12795.new
12796.vitem &$r_...$&
12797.vindex &$r_...$&
12798.cindex router variables
12799Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12800They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12801The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12802and the eventual transport.
12803.wen
12804
12805.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12806.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12807When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12808RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12809RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12810
12811.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12812.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12813.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12814When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12815RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12816temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12817
12818.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12819.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12820When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12821RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12822permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12823
12824.vitem &$received_count$&
12825.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12826This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12827including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12828is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12829delivering.
12830
12831.vitem &$received_for$&
12832.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12833If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12834variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12835built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12836the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12837
12838.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12839.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12840As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12841variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12842is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12843&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12844the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12845option.
12846
12847As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12848could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12849on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12850values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12851messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12852time.
12853For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12854
12855.vitem &$received_port$&
12856.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12857See &$received_ip_address$&.
12858
12859.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12860.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12861When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12862protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12863by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12864&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12865(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12866is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12867connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12868
12869Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12870automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12871&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12872encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12873where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12874STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12875
12876The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12877messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12878identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12879
12880.vitem &$received_time$&
12881.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12882This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12883as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12884
12885.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12886.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12887This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12888condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12889until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12890.display
12891&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12892&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12893.endd
12894&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12895method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12896The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12897expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12898
12899.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12900.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12901In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12902information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12903
12904.ilist
12905&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12906was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12907
12908.next
12909&"route"&: Routing failed.
12910
12911.next
12912&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12913or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12914MAIL).
12915
12916.next
12917&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12918.next
12919
12920&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12921.endlist
12922
12923The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12924rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12925
12926.vitem &$recipients$&
12927.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12928This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12929a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12930is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12931unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12932cases:
12933
12934.olist
12935In a system filter file.
12936.next
12937In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12938is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12939&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12940&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12941.next
12942From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12943.endlist
12944
12945
12946.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12947.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12948When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12949envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12950from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12951increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12952
12953
12954.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12955.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12956This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12957&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12958
12959.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12960.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12961When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12962these variables contain the
12963captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12964
12965
12966.vitem &$reply_address$&
12967.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12968When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12969&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12970contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12971white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12972decoding or character code translation takes place.
12973
12974.vitem &$return_path$&
12975.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12976When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12977the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12978in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12979same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12980mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12981for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12982address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12983that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12984the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12985envelope sender.
12986
12987.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12988.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12989This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12990
12991.vitem &$router_name$&
12992.cindex "router" "name"
12993.cindex "name" "of router"
12994.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12995During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12996
12997.vitem &$runrc$&
12998.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12999.vindex "&$runrc$&"
13000This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13001&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13002assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13003preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13004reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13005another.
13006
13007.vitem &$self_hostname$&
13008.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13009.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13010When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13011local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13012One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13013happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13014original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13015
13016.vitem &$sender_address$&
13017.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13018When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13019that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13020is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13021value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13022
13023.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13024.vindex "&$address_data$&"
13025.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13026If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13027sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13028distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13029after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13030longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13031
13032.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13033.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13034The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13035
13036.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13037.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13038The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13039
13040.vitem &$sender_data$&
13041.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13042This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13043in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13044value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13045this:
13046.display
13047&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13048&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13049.endd
13050&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13051method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13052The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13053expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13054
13055.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13056.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13057When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13058name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13059brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13060enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13061issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13062looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13063&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13064start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13065verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13066the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13067the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13068
13069.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13070.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13071This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13072.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13073done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13074
13075.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13076.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13077When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13078command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13079set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13080the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13081
13082.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13083.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13084When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13085this variable contains that
13086host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13087
13088.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13089.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13090This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13091driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13092received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13093&$authenticated_id$&.
13094
13095.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13096.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13097If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13098(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13099otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13100resolver library states that both
13101the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13102other times, this variable is false.
13103
13104.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13105It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13106library, by setting:
13107.code
13108dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13109.endd
13110
13111Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13112validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13113
13114If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13115mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13116
13117This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13118DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13119all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13120is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13121
13122
13123.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13124.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13125When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13126host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13127other means, this variable is empty.
13128
13129.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13130If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13131&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13132A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13133via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13134any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13135&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13136
13137.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13138However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13139DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13140&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13141
13142Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13143host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13144in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13145is set to &"1"&.
13146
13147Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13148maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13149these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13150following are true:
13151
13152.ilist
13153A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13154.next
13155The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13156configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13157to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13158.next
13159Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13160that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13161&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13162.next
13163The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13164In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13165EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13166.next
13167The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13168domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13169. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13170. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13171.code
13172 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13173.endd
13174which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13175IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13176.endlist
13177
13178
13179.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13180.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13181When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13182number that was used on the remote host.
13183
13184.vitem &$sender_ident$&
13185.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13186When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13187identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13188been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13189called Exim.
13190
13191.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13192A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13193&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13194&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13195
13196.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13197.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13198.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13199.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13200This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13201either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13202there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13203there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13204the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13205followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13206first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13207the parentheses.
13208
13209There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13210was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13211address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13212all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13213into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13214
13215.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13216.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13217In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13218about the failure. The details are the same as for
13219&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13220
13221.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13222.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13223This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13224been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13225used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13226on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13227connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13228
13229.vitem &$sending_port$&
13230.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13231This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13232been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13233connections, see &$received_port$&.
13234
13235.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13236.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13237During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13238host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13239&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13240value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13241
13242.vitem &$smtp_command$&
13243.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13244During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13245entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13246the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13247.code
13248MAIL FROM:<>
13249MAIL FROM: <>
13250.endd
13251For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13252command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13253rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13254the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13255
13256.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13257.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13258.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13259While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13260argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13261space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13262somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13263
13264.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13265.cindex SMTP "command history"
13266.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13267A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13268received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13269are remembered.
13270
13271.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13272.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13273This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13274daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13275in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13276connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13277the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13278never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13279there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13280single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13281daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13282
13283.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13284These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13285that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13286filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13287example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13288message is junk mail.
13289
13290.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13291A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13292is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13293&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13294
13295.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13296 &$spf_received$& &&&
13297 &$spf_result$& &&&
13298 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13299 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13300These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13301For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13302
13303.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13304.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13305The name of Exim's spool directory.
13306
13307.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13308.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13309The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13310being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13311If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13312is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13313
13314.vitem &$spool_space$&
13315.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13316The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13317Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13318variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13319find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13320value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13321megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13322.code
13323condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13324.endd
13325See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13326
13327
13328.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13329.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13330This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13331command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13332command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13333interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13334
13335.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13336.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13337Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13338on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13339this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13340If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13341The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13342when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13343
13344The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13345except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13346the outbound.
13347
13348.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13349.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13350Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13351on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13352this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13353If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13354
13355.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13356.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13357.cindex certificate variables
13358This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13359inbound connection when the message was received.
13360It is only useful as the argument of a
13361&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13362or a &%def%& condition.
13363
13364&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13365when a list of more than one
13366file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13367.new
13368The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13369.wen
13370
13371.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13372.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13373This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13374inbound connection when the message was received.
13375It is only useful as the argument of a
13376&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13377or a &%def%& condition.
13378If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13379which is not the leaf.
13380
13381.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13382.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13383This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13384outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13385&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13386or a &%def%& condition.
13387
13388.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13389.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13390This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13391outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13392&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13393or a &%def%& condition.
13394If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13395which is not the leaf.
13396
13397.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13398.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13399This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13400message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13401
13402The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13403except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13404the outbound.
13405
13406.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13407.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13408This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13409outbound SMTP connection was made,
13410and &"0"& otherwise.
13411
13412.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13413.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13414.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13415When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13416connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13417example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13418received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13419&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13420non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13421
13422The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13423but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13424becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13425
13426.new
13427.vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13428.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13429As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13430.wen
13431
13432.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13433.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13434This variable is
13435cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13436and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13437&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13438details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13439
13440,new
13441.vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13442.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13443As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13444.wen
13445
13446.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13447.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13448DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13449
13450.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13451.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13452When a message is received from a remote client connection
13453the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13454.code
134550 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
134561 No response to request
134572 Response not verified
134583 Verification failed
134594 Verification succeeded
13460.endd
13461
13462.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13463.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13464When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13465the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13466See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13467
13468.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13469.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13470.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13471.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13472When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13473connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13474the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13475&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13476If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13477which is not the leaf.
13478
13479The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13480except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13481the outbound.
13482
13483.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13484.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13485When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13486connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13487the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13488&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13489If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13490which is not the leaf.
13491
13492.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13493.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13494.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13495.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13496When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13497Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13498If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13499some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13500will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13501a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13502used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13503
13504The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13505except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13506the outbound.
13507
13508.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13509.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13510.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13511During outbound
13512SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13513the transport.
13514
13515.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13516.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13517Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13518
13519.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13520.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13521The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13522files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13523
13524.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13525.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13526The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13527
13528.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13529.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13530The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13531
13532.vitem &$tod_full$&
13533.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13534A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13535+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13536positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13537values for those that are behind (west).
13538
13539.vitem &$tod_log$&
13540.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13541The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
135421995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13543
13544.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13545.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13546This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13547is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13548flag.
13549
13550.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13551.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13552This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13553-0500.
13554
13555.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13556.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13557This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13558by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13559
13560.vitem &$transport_name$&
13561.cindex "transport" "name"
13562.cindex "name" "of transport"
13563.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13564During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13565
13566.vitem &$value$&
13567.vindex "&$value$&"
13568This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13569or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13570&*reduce*& expansion.
13571
13572.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13573.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13574While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13575contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13576Otherwise, empty.
13577
13578.vitem &$version_number$&
13579.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13580The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13581by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13582
13583.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13584.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13585This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13586delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13587
13588.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13589.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13590This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13591delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13592.endlist
13593.ecindex IIDstrexp
13594
13595
13596
13597. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13598. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13599
13600.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13601.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13602Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13603Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13604use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13605your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13606the line
13607.code
13608EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13609.endd
13610in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13611
13612
13613.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13614.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13615Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13616&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13617no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13618interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13619the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13620option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13621a newly created Perl interpreter.
13622
13623The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13624need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13625should usually be something like
13626.code
13627perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13628.endd
13629where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13630use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13631soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13632the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13633its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13634fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13635necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13636the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13637two ways:
13638
13639.ilist
13640.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13641Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13642a startup when Exim is entered.
13643.next
13644The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13645overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13646.endlist
13647
13648There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13649initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13650
13651.ilist
13652.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13653.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13654To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13655interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13656taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13657option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13658defaults to false.
13659
13660
13661.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13662When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13663of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13664by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13665forms:
13666.code
13667${perl{foo}}
13668${perl{foo}{argument}}
13669${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13670.endd
13671which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13672arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13673with an error message of the form
13674.code
13675Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13676.endd
13677The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13678it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13679return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13680an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13681by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13682that was passed to &%die%&.
13683
13684
13685.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13686Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13687is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13688the Perl code
13689.code
13690my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13691.endd
13692makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13693Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13694&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13695
13696If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13697&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13698expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13699an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13700
13701.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13702.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13703Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13704&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13705debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13706&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13707timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13708
13709
13710.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13711.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13712You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13713Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13714before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13715SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13716is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13717error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13718avoided, but the output is lost.
13719
13720.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13721The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13722Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13723you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13724output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13725change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13726For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13727.code
13728$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13729.endd
13730Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13731example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13732include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13733as the first subroutine argument.
13734.ecindex IIDperl
13735
13736
13737. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13738. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13739
13740.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13741 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13742 "Starting the daemon"
13743.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13744.cindex "interface" "listening"
13745.cindex "network interface"
13746.cindex "interface" "network"
13747.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13748.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13749.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13750.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13751A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13752hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13753or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13754works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13755In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13756IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13757knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13758
13759.olist
13760When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13761and ports to listen on.
13762.next
13763When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13764are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13765processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13766same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13767when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13768local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13769option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13770as an error situation.
13771.next
13772When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13773for the outgoing connection.
13774.endlist
13775
13776
13777Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13778of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13779addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13780standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13781rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13782
13783In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13784interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13785options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13786chapter describes how they operate.
13787
13788When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13789actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13790
13791
13792
13793.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13794When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13795option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13796following options:
13797
13798.ilist
13799&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13800or service names.
13801(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13802.next
13803&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13804listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13805.endlist
13806
13807The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13808described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13809it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13810colons. For example:
13811.code
13812local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13813 192.168.23.65 ; \
13814 ::1 ; \
13815 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13816.endd
13817There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13818in &%local_interfaces%&:
13819
13820.olist
13821The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13822on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13823.code
13824local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13825 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13826.endd
13827.next
13828The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13829with a colon separator, for example:
13830.code
13831local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13832 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13833.endd
13834.endlist
13835
13836When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13837default setting contains just one port:
13838.code
13839daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13840.endd
13841If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13842specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13843&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13844&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13845IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13846
13847
13848
13849.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13850The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13851as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13852case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13853instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13854default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13855.code
13856local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13857.endd
13858when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13859.code
13860local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13861.endd
13862Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13863
13864
13865
13866.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13867The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13868&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13869instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13870option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13871the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13872exim.
13873
13874The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13875changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13876If there are any items that do not
13877contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13878&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13879items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13880replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13881.code
13882-oX 1225
13883.endd
13884overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13885whereas
13886.code
13887-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13888.endd
13889overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13890(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13891value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13892
13893
13894
13895.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13896.cindex "submissions protocol"
13897.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13898.cindex "smtps protocol"
13899.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13900.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13901Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13902&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13903For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13904STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13905the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13906If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13907(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13908the 465 TCP ports.
13909
13910If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13911service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13912proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13913
13914The common use of this option is expected to be
13915.code
13916tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13917.endd
13918per RFC 8314.
13919There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13920to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13921
13922&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13923daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13924&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13925because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13926connections via the daemon.)
13927
13928
13929
13930
13931.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13932.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13933IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13934can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13935interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13936address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13937percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13938adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13939.code
13940fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13941.endd
13942To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13943allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13944to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13945percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13946address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13947&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13948.code
13949IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13950.endd
13951is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13952Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13953instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13954function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13955&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13956
13957.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13958.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13959Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13960run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13961using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13962connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13963.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13964&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13965activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13966that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13967etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13968to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13969
13970On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13971disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13972option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13973and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13974IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13975
13976
13977
13978.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13979The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13980.code
13981daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13982local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13983.endd
13984This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13985Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13986the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13987read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13988
13989To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13990.code
13991daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13992.endd
13993(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13994.code
13995local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13996 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13997.endd
13998To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13999IPv4 loopback address only:
14000.code
14001local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14002.endd
14003To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14004.code
14005local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14006.endd
14007&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14008
14009
14010
14011.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14012The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14013whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14014addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14015treated as local.
14016
14017For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14018the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14019available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14020(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14021
14022Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14023many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14024email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14025interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14026&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14027&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14028used for listening. Consider this example:
14029.code
14030local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14031 192.168.53.235 ; \
14032 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14033
14034extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14035.endd
14036The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14037address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14038Exim is routing.
14039
14040In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14041address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14042desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14043these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14044This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14045during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14046host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14047addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14048
14049
14050
14051.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14052Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14053allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14054there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14055&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14056description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14057details.
14058
14059
14060
14061
14062. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14063. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14064
14065.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14066.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14067.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14068The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14069
14070.ilist
14071Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14072&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14073.next
14074Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14075&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14076section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14077.next
14078Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14079(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14080&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14081only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14082settings.
14083.endlist
14084
14085This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14086types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14087in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14088are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14089an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14090listed in more than one group.
14091
14092.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14093.table2
14094.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14095.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14096.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14097.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14098.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14099.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14100.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14101.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14102.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14103.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14104.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14105.endtable
14106
14107
14108.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14109.table2
14110.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14111.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14112.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14113.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14114.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14115.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14116.endtable
14117
14118
14119
14120.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14121.table2
14122.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14123.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14124.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14125.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14126.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14127.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14128.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14129.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14130.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14131.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14132.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14133.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14134.endtable
14135
14136
14137
14138.section "Logging" "SECID99"
14139.table2
14140.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14141.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14142.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14143.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14144.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14145.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14146.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14147.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14148.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14149.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14150.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14151.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14152.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14153.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14154.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14155.endtable
14156
14157
14158
14159.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14160.table2
14161.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14162.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14163.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14164.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14165.endtable
14166
14167
14168
14169.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14170.table2
14171.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14172.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14173.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14174.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14175.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14176.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14177.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14178.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14179.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14180.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14181.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14182.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14183.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14184.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14185.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14186.endtable
14187
14188
14189
14190.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14191.table2
14192.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14193.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14194.endtable
14195
14196
14197
14198.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14199.table2
14200.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14201.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14202.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14203.endtable
14204
14205
14206
14207.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14208.table2
14209.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14210.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14211.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14212.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14213.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14214.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14215.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14216.endtable
14217
14218
14219
14220.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14221.table2
14222.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14223.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14224.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14225.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14226.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14227.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14228.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14229.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14230.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14231.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14232.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14233.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14234.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14235.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14236.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14237.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14238 connection"
14239.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14240.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14241.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14242.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14243.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14244.endtable
14245
14246
14247
14248.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14249.table2
14250.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14251.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14252.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14253.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14254.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14255.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14256.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14257.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14258.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14259.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14260.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14261.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14262.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14263.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14264.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14265.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14266.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14267.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14268.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14269.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14270.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14271.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14272 words""&"
14273.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14274.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14275.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14276.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14277.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14278.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14279.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14280.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14281.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14282.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14283.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14284.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14285.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14286.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14287.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14288.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14289.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14290.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14291.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14292.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14293.endtable
14294
14295
14296
14297.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14298.table2
14299.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14300 item"
14301.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14302 item"
14303.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14304.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14305.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14306.endtable
14307
14308
14309
14310.section "TLS" "SECID108"
14311.table2
14312.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14313.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14314.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14315.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14316.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14317.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14318.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14319.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14320.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14321.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14322.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14323.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14324.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14325.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14326.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14327.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14328.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14329.endtable
14330
14331
14332
14333.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14334.table2
14335.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14336.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14337.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14338.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14339.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14340.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14341.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14342.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14343.endtable
14344
14345
14346
14347.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14348.table2
14349.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14350.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14351.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14352.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14353.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14354.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14355.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14356.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14357.endtable
14358
14359
14360
14361
14362.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14363.table2
14364.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14365.endtable
14366
14367
14368
14369
14370
14371.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14372See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14373
14374.table2
14375.row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14376.row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14377.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14378.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14379.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14380.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14381.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14382.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14383.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14384.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14385.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14386.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14387.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14388.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14389.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14390.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14391.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14392 connection"
14393.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14394.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14395.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14396.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14397.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14398.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14399.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14400.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14401.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14402.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14403.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14404.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14405.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14406.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14407.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14408.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14409.endtable
14410
14411
14412
14413.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14414.table2
14415.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14416.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14417.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14418.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14419.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14420.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14421.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14422.row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14423.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14424.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14425.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14426.endtable
14427
14428
14429
14430.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14431.table2
14432.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14433.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14434.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14435.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14436 words""&"
14437.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14438.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14439.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14440.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14441.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14442.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14443.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14444.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14445.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14446.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14447.endtable
14448
14449
14450
14451.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14452.table2
14453.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14454.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14455 directory"
14456.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14457.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14458.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14459.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14460.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14461.endtable
14462
14463
14464
14465.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14466.table2
14467.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14468.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14469.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14470.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14471.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14472.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14473.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14474.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14475.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14476.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14477.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14478.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14479.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14480.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14481.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14482.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14483.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14484.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14485.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14486.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14487.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14488.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14489.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14490.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14491.endtable
14492
14493
14494
14495.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14496.table2
14497.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14498.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14499.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14500.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14501.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14502.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14503.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14504.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14505.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14506.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14507.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14508.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14509.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14510.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14511.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14512.endtable
14513
14514
14515
14516.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14517Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14518&dagger;.
14519
14520.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14521.cindex "8BITMIME"
14522.cindex "8-bit characters"
14523.cindex "log" "selectors"
14524.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14525This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14526EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14527However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14528takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14529
14530Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14531feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14532It now defaults to true.
14533A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14534.display
14535&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14536.endd
14537
14538To log received 8BITMIME status use
14539.code
14540log_selector = +8bitmime
14541.endd
14542
14543.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14544.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14545.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14546This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14547read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14548further details.
14549
14550.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14551This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14552messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14553SMTP messages.
14554
14555.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14556.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14557.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14558This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14559non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14560
14561.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14562.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14563.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14564This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14565received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14566
14567.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14568.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14569This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14570See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14571
14572.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14573.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14574This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14575processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14576acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14577
14578.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14579.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14580.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14581.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14582.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14583This option defines the ACL that,
14584if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14585is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14586processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14587acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14588
14589.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14590.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14591This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14592(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14593of a received message.
14594See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14595
14596.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14597.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14598This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14599received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14600
14601.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14602.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14603This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14604received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14605
14606.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14607.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14608.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14609This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14610command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14611
14612
14613.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14614.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14615This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14616received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14617
14618.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14619.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14620This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14621a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14622&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14623
14624.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14625.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14626This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14627extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14628section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14629
14630.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14631.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14632This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14633ends without a QUIT command being received.
14634See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14635
14636.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14637This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14638received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14639further details.
14640
14641.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14642.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14643This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14644received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14645
14646.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14647.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14648This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14649received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14650
14651.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14652.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14653This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14654received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14655
14656.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14657.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14658This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14659received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14660
14661.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14662.cindex "environment" "set values"
14663This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14664currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14665See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14666
14667.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14668.cindex "admin user"
14669This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14670current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14671colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14672programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14673admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14674not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14675To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14676
14677.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14678.cindex "domain literal"
14679If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14680email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14681format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14682has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14683
14684Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14685format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14686addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14687&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14688domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14689configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14690the local host's IP addresses.
14691
14692
14693.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14694.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14695It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14696and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14697MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14698that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14699practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14700&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14701recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14702
14703.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14704.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14705.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14706Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14707camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14708that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14709This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14710
14711If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14712UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14713letters, digits, and hyphens.
14714
14715.new
14716If Exim is built with internationalization support
14717and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14718this option can be left as default.
14719.wen
14720Without that,
14721if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14722adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14723suitable setting is:
14724.code
14725dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14726 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14727.endd
14728Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14729.code
14730dns_check_names_pattern =
14731.endd
14732That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14733
14734
14735.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14736.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14737.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14738If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14739response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14740Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14741Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14742advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14743authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14744&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14745authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14746
14747Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14748and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14749not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14750authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14751to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14752which Exim advertises AUTH.
14753
14754.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14755If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14756is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14757option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14758.code
14759auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14760.endd
14761.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14762If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14763the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14764expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14765
14766
14767.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14768.cindex "thawing messages"
14769.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14770If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14771new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14772this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14773being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14774saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14775
14776&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14777&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14778thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14779
14780
14781.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14782This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14783It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14784.code
14785sophie:/var/run/sophie
14786.endd
14787If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14788before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14789
14790
14791.option bi_command main string unset
14792.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14793This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14794the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14795just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14796required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14797
14798
14799.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14800.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14801.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14802This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14803for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14804chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14805
14806
14807.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14808When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14809message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14810delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14811
14812.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14813.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14814This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14815bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14816causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14817value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14818message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14819error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14820point at which the error was detected are returned.
14821.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14822
14823.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14824.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14825.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14826.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14827This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14828that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14829when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14830The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14831If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14832treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14833
14834The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14835during reception of a message.
14836In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14837
14838The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14839
14840
14841.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14842If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14843bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14844&%bounce_return_body%&.
14845
14846
14847.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14848.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14849.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14850.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14851This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14852senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14853limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14854any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14855that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14856
14857When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14858greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14859added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14860to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14861size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14862messages.
14863
14864.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14865.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14866.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14867.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14868This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14869bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14870connection. A typical setting might be:
14871.code
14872bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14873.endd
14874which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14875.code
14876MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14877.endd
14878The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14879address.
14880
14881.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14882.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14883.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14884This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14885domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14886section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14887
14888
14889.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14890This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14891domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14892section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14893
14894
14895.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14896This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14897address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14898section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14899
14900
14901.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14902This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14903address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14904section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14905
14906
14907.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14908This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14909callout verification. The default value is
14910.code
14911$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14912.endd
14913See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14914
14915
14916.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14917See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14918
14919
14920.option check_log_space main integer 10M
14921See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14922
14923.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14924.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14925.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14926RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14927system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14928word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14929multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14930exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14931of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14932set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14933
14934
14935.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14936See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14937
14938
14939.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14940.cindex "checking disk space"
14941.cindex "disk space, checking"
14942.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14943The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14944message is accepted.
14945
14946.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14947.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14948.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14949.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14950When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14951want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14952testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14953&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14954
14955
14956&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14957either value is greater than zero, for example:
14958.code
14959check_spool_space = 100M
14960check_spool_inodes = 100
14961.endd
14962The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14963SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14964transit.
14965
14966&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14967files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14968&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14969
14970If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14971incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14972error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14973SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14974&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14975&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14976
14977The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14978number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14979If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14980
14981For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14982failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14983it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14984
14985There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14986Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14987high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14988may wish to deliberately disable them.
14989
14990.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14991.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14992.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14993The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14994these hosts.
14995Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14996
14997.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14998.cindex "restricting access to features"
14999This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15000administrative user.
15001This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15002
15003.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15004.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15005.cindex memory debugging
15006This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15007management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15008it should normally be left as default.
15009
15010.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15011.cindex "port" "for daemon"
15012.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15013This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15014listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15015backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15016
15017.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15018.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15019This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15020the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15021(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15022defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15023&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15024
15025.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15026See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15027
15028.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15029.cindex "warning of delay"
15030.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15031.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15032When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15033intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15034after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15035string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15036message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15037between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15038with
15039.code
15040delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15041.endd
15042the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15043the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15044because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15045just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15046.code
15047delay_warning = 6h
15048.endd
15049messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15050a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15051.code
15052delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15053.endd
15054Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15055which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15056Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15057
15058.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15059.vindex "&$domain$&"
15060The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15061deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15062expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15063forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15064&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15065not sent. The default is:
15066.code
15067delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15068 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15069 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15070 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15071 } {no}{yes}}
15072.endd
15073This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15074&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15075&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15076&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15077
15078.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15079.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15080.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15081If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15082delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15083the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15084of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15085chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15086
15087.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15088.cindex "load average"
15089.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15090When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15091becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15092ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15093See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15094
15095
15096.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15097.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15098Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15099message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15100handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15101should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15102removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15103occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15104
15105.option disable_fsync main boolean false
15106.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15107This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15108ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15109a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15110build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15111really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15112distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15113
15114When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15115updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15116such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15117Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15118
15119
15120.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15121.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15122If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15123activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15124that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15125etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15126to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15127
15128
15129.new
15130.option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512 : sha1"
15131.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15132This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15133and an order of processing.
15134Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15135
15136Note that the presence of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15137Signatures using the rsa-sha1 are however (as of writing) still common.
15138The default inclusion of sha1 may be dropped in a future release.
15139
15140.option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15141This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15142and an order of processing.
15143Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15144
15145.option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15146If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15147first success.
15148.wen
15149
15150.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15151.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15152This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15153It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15154the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15155See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15156
15157
15158.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15159.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15160DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15161&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15162keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15163incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15164may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15165anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15166This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15167by a setting such as this:
15168.code
15169dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15170.endd
15171This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15172&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15173since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15174&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15175when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15176options are applied after this global option.
15177
15178.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15179.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15180When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15181names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15182the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15183contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15184a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15185done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15186value of this option. The default pattern is
15187.code
15188dns_check_names_pattern = \
15189 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15190.endd
15191which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15192they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15193permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15194accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15195&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15196empty string.
15197
15198.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15199This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15200DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15201
15202.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15203This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15204reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15205section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15206
15207.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15208.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15209This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15210not do it internally.
15211As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15212If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15213
15214The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15215thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15216given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15217
15218
15219.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15220.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15221.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15222If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15223DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15224default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15225
15226If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15227
15228
15229.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15230.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15231.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15232.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15233When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15234looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15235(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15236domain matches this list.
15237
15238This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15239not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15240servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15241.new
15242Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15243this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15244only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15245.wen
15246
15247
15248.option dns_retrans main time 0s
15249.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15250.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15251.cindex "DNS" timeout
15252The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15253retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15254defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15255time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15256totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15257take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15258parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15259but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15260to set in them.
15261See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15262
15263
15264.option dns_retry main integer 0
15265See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15266
15267
15268.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15269.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15270.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15271If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15272(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15273DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15274match with this expanded domain list.
15275
15276Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15277authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15278bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15279mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15280Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15281a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15282
15283Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15284to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15285zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15286
15287If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15288in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15289authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15290authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15291record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15292
15293.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15294.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15295.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15296.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15297.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15298If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15299DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15300the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15301on.
15302
15303If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15304
15305OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15306means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15307is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15308
15309
15310.option drop_cr main boolean false
15311This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15312handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15313described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15314
15315.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15316.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15317.cindex "DSN" "success"
15318.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15319DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15320and accepted from, these hosts.
15321Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15322and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15323A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15324A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15325are sent.
15326
15327.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15328.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15329.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15330This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15331bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15332Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15333.code
15334dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15335.endd
15336The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15337panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15338
15339.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15340.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15341Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15342message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15343handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15344message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15345be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15346the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15347delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15348
15349
15350.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15351.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15352.cindex "copy of bounce message"
15353Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15354generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15355coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15356items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15357a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15358must be enclosed in double quotes.
15359
15360Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15361(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15362the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15363items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15364are examined. For example:
15365.code
15366errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15367 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15368 postmaster@mydomain.example
15369.endd
15370.vindex "&$domain$&"
15371.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15372The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15373and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15374there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15375.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15376variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15377
15378
15379.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15380.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15381By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15382.display
15383&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15384.endd
15385.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15386where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15387A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15388&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15389overrides the default.
15390
15391Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15392&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15393and warning messages. For example:
15394.code
15395errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15396.endd
15397The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15398address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15399&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15400own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15401not used.
15402
15403
15404.option event_action main string&!! unset
15405.cindex events
15406This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15407For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15408
15409
15410.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15411.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15412.cindex "Exim group"
15413This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15414privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15415option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15416of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15417configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15418security issues.
15419
15420
15421.option exim_path main string "see below"
15422.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15423This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15424needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15425the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15426is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15427other place.
15428&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15429you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15430where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15431settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15432
15433
15434.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15435.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15436.cindex "Exim user"
15437This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15438privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15439time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15440options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15441
15442Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15443&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15444not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15445used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15446
15447
15448.option exim_version main string "current version"
15449.cindex "Exim version"
15450.cindex customizing "version number"
15451.cindex "version number of Exim" override
15452This option allows to override the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& Exim reports in
15453various places. Use with care, this may fool stupid security scanners.
15454
15455
15456.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15457This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15458routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15459&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15460
15461
15462. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15463. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15464
15465.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15466 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15467.oindex "&%-t%&"
15468.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15469.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15470According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15471are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15472envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15473line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15474behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15475command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15476&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15477argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15478addresses.
15479
15480
15481.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15482.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15483On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15484distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15485related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15486Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15487errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15488many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15489retries.
15490
15491.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15492You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15493a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15494search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15495
15496
15497
15498.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15499.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15500On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15501ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15502delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15503&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15504feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15505warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15506freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15507is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15508supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15509message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15510freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15511log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15512logging that you require.
15513
15514
15515.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15516.cindex "HP-UX"
15517.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15518Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15519password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15520looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15521headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15522of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15523it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15524upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15525
15526When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15527expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15528login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15529user's name.
15530
15531.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15532Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15533pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15534name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15535.code
15536gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15537gecos_name = $1
15538.endd
15539
15540.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15541See &%gecos_name%& above.
15542
15543
15544.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15545This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15546server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15547implementations of TLS.
15548
15549
15550.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15551This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15552the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15553
15554See
15555&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15556for documentation.
15557
15558
15559
15560.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15561This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15562&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15563default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15564ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15565insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15566
15567
15568
15569.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15570.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15571.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15572This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15573section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15574&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15575sections are rejected.
15576
15577
15578.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15579.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15580.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15581This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15582all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15583header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15584zero means &"no limit"&.
15585
15586
15587
15588
15589.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15590.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15591.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15592Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15593mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15594some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15595this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15596if you want to do semantic checking.
15597See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15598set.
15599
15600
15601.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15602.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15603.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15604.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15605This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15606all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15607hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15608.code
15609helo_allow_chars = _
15610.endd
15611Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15612
15613
15614.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15615.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15616.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15617If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15618list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15619default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15620its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15621do.
15622
15623
15624.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15625.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15626.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15627By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15628&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15629to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15630condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15631Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15632to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15633necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15634encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15635Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15636
15637When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15638&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15639EHLO command either:
15640
15641.ilist
15642is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15643.next
15644.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15645.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15646matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15647calling host address, or
15648.next
15649when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15650.endlist
15651
15652However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15653fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15654be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15655
15656If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15657.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15658&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15659
15660.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15661.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15662.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15663Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15664backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15665name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15666&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15667rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15668If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15669error.
15670
15671.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15672.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15673.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15674This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15675manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15676&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15677verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15678item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15679it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15680
15681This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15682delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15683configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15684domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15685&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15686
15687A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15688messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15689time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15690retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15691
15692
15693.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15694.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15695Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15696is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15697&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15698option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15699default configuration file contains
15700.code
15701host_lookup = *
15702.endd
15703which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15704is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15705
15706After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15707has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15708this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15709
15710.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15711.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15712After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15713unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15714&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15715&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15716
15717
15718.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15719This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15720to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15721first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15722if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15723if you want.
15724
15725&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15726multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15727&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15728case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15729
15730
15731
15732.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15733.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15734If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15735as soon as the connection is made.
15736This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15737nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15738connections immediately.
15739
15740The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15741ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15742sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15743incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15744chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15745
15746
15747.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15748.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15749This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15750happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15751you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15752127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15753the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15754list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15755local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15756.code
15757hosts_connection_nolog = :
15758.endd
15759If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15760
15761
15762
15763.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15764.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15765This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15766connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15767
15768
15769.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15770.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15771.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15772If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15773if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15774records
15775or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15776host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15777
15778This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15779&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15780section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15781&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15782that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15783chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15784interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15785
15786
15787.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15788.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15789This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15790to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15791The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15792
15793
15794
15795.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15796.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15797.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15798This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15799that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15800suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15801
15802After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15803because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15804message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15805the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15806again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15807bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15808for frozen messages. For example,
15809.code
15810ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15811.endd
15812retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15813failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15814failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15815value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15816dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15817&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15818
15819
15820.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15821.cindex "&""From""& line"
15822.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15823Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15824the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15825message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15826such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15827match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15828process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15829&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15830
15831
15832.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15833See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15834
15835.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15836.cindex "environment" "values from"
15837This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15838You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15839these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15840during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15841installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15842environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15843external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15844
15845Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15846(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15847
15848WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15849FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15850unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15851that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15852
15853Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15854&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15855current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15856anymore.
15857
15858See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15859environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15860transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15861details.
15862
15863
15864.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15865This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15866have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15867next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15868logged.
15869
15870
15871.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15872.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15873.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15874This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15875a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15876While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15877Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15878and constrained to be a directory.
15879
15880
15881.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15882.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15883.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15884This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15885a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15886While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15887Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15888and constrained to be a file.
15889
15890
15891.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15892.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15893.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15894This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15895Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15896Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15897
15898
15899.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15900.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15901.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15902This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15903to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15904Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15905identity to be proven.
15906
15907
15908.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15909.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15910This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15911the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15912cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15913
15914
15915.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15916.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15917This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15918LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15919details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15920with LDAP support.
15921
15922
15923.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15924.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15925This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15926A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15927See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15928Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15929to hard/demand.
15930
15931
15932.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15933.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15934If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15935connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15936"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15937of SSL-on-connect.
15938In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15939by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15940This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15941
15942
15943.option ldap_version main integer unset
15944.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15945This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15946LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15947-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15948the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15949has been built with LDAP support.
15950
15951
15952
15953.option local_from_check main boolean true
15954.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15955.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15956When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15957an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15958checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15959the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15960
15961&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15962locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15963&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15964
15965You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15966on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15967&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15968and the default qualify domain.
15969
15970If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15971and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15972&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15973&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15974
15975.cindex "envelope from"
15976.cindex "envelope sender"
15977These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15978is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15979&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15980
15981For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15982request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15983has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15984
15985
15986
15987
15988.option local_from_prefix main string unset
15989When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15990matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15991ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15992done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15993appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15994&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15995example, if
15996.code
15997local_from_prefix = *-
15998.endd
15999is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16000.code
16001From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16002.endd
16003will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16004matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16005qualify domain.
16006
16007
16008.option local_from_suffix main string unset
16009See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16010
16011
16012.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16013This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16014listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16015&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16016options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16017&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16018&%local_interfaces%& is
16019.code
16020local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16021.endd
16022when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16023.code
16024local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16025.endd
16026
16027.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16028.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16029.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16030This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16031&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16032the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16033message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16034non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16035
16036
16037
16038.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16039.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16040When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16041an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16042do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16043also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16044See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16045&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16046
16047
16048
16049
16050.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16051.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16052.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16053.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16054Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16055uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16056value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16057after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16058host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16059range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16060systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16061&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16062characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16063time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16064section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16065
16066
16067
16068.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16069.cindex "log" "file path for"
16070This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16071files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16072when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16073name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16074or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16075they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16076.new
16077A path must start with a slash.
16078To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16079.wen
16080Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16081section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16082used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16083variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16084configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16085&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16086early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16087
16088
16089.option log_selector main string unset
16090.cindex "log" "selectors"
16091This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16092writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16093minus characters. For example:
16094.code
16095log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16096.endd
16097A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16098logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16099
16100
16101.option log_timezone main boolean false
16102.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16103.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16104.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16105By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16106timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16107in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16108avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16109&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16110timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16111of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16112&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16113another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16114
16115
16116.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16117.cindex "too many open files"
16118.cindex "open files, too many"
16119.cindex "file" "too many open"
16120.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16121.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16122This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16123lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16124Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16125file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16126recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16127actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16128as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16129open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16130&%lookup_open_max%&.
16131
16132
16133.option max_username_length main integer 0
16134.cindex "length of login name"
16135.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16136.cindex "limit" "user name length"
16137Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16138&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16139this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16140an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16141
16142
16143.option message_body_newlines main bool false
16144.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16145.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16146.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16147.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16148By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16149the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16150option is set true, this no longer happens.
16151
16152
16153.option message_body_visible main integer 500
16154.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16155.cindex "message body" "visible size"
16156.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16157.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16158This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16159&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16160
16161
16162.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16163.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16164If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16165(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16166locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16167means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16168Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16169Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16170replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16171empty string, the option is ignored.
16172
16173
16174.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16175If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16176the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16177message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16178take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16179the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16180it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16181yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16182before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16183that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16184means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16185colons will become hyphens.
16186
16187
16188.option message_logs main boolean true
16189.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16190.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16191If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16192&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16193Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16194minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16195per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16196which is not affected by this option.
16197
16198
16199.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16200.cindex "message" "size limit"
16201.cindex "limit" "message size"
16202.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16203This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16204value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16205to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16206TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16207optionally followed by K or M.
16208
16209&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16210other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16211the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16212error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16213&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16214
16215Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16216exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16217failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16218an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16219the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16220message that an individual transport can process.
16221
16222If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16223maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16224failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16225virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16226probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16227default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16228some problems may result.
16229
16230A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16231SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16232SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16233
16234
16235.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16236.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16237This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16238.code
16239SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16240.endd
16241in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16242moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16243and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16244standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16245lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16246
16247
16248.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16249Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16250it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16251contains a full description of this facility.
16252
16253
16254
16255.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16256.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16257This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16258be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16259option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16260
16261
16262.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16263This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16264message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16265recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16266It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16267safety precaution.
16268
16269When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16270list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16271the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16272contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16273can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16274
16275If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16276&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16277example is
16278.code
16279never_users = root:daemon:bin
16280.endd
16281Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16282harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16283transport driver.
16284
16285
16286.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16287.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16288This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16289by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16290each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16291
16292This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16293available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16294The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16295the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16296list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16297&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16298names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16299
16300Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16301SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16302yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16303adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16304invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16305
16306The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16307
16308Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16309"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16310with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16311some now infamous attacks.
16312
16313Examples:
16314.code
16315# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16316openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16317 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16318
16319# Disable older protocol versions:
16320openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16321.endd
16322
16323Possible options may include:
16324.ilist
16325&`all`&
16326.next
16327&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16328.next
16329&`cipher_server_preference`&
16330.next
16331&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16332.next
16333&`ephemeral_rsa`&
16334.next
16335&`legacy_server_connect`&
16336.next
16337&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16338.next
16339&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16340.next
16341&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16342.next
16343&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16344.next
16345&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16346.next
16347&`no_compression`&
16348.next
16349&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16350.next
16351&`no_sslv2`&
16352.next
16353&`no_sslv3`&
16354.next
16355&`no_ticket`&
16356.next
16357&`no_tlsv1`&
16358.next
16359&`no_tlsv1_1`&
16360.next
16361&`no_tlsv1_2`&
16362.next
16363&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16364.next
16365&`single_dh_use`&
16366.next
16367&`single_ecdh_use`&
16368.next
16369&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16370.next
16371&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16372.next
16373&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16374.next
16375&`tls_d5_bug`&
16376.next
16377&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16378.endlist
16379
16380As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16381all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16382to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16383to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16384release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16385where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16386
16387
16388.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16389.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16390This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16391to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16392The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16393
16394
16395.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16396.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16397.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16398.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16399The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16400percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16401replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16402also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16403option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16404but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16405an ACL.
16406
16407&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16408trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16409if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16410implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16411routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16412a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16413local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16414
16415
16416.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16417.cindex "Perl"
16418This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16419interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16420
16421
16422.option perl_startup main string unset
16423.cindex "Perl"
16424This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16425interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16426
16427.option perl_startup main boolean false
16428.cindex "Perl"
16429This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16430
16431
16432.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16433.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16434This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16435data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16436&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16437PostgreSQL support.
16438
16439
16440.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16441.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16442.cindex "pid file, path for"
16443This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16444process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16445to the host name:
16446.code
16447pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16448.endd
16449If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16450spool directory.
16451The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16452option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16453of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16454
16455
16456.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16457.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16458This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16459PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16460control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16461&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16462for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16463that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16464not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16465
16466.new
16467.option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16468.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16469.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16470If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16471this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16472and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16473commands are acceptable.
16474When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16475
16476See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16477
16478Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16479.wen
16480
16481
16482.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16483.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16484This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16485to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16486If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16487If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16488an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16489is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16490
16491.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16492.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16493If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16494completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16495called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16496purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16497volume of mail. Use with care!
16498
16499
16500.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16501.cindex "name" "of local host"
16502.cindex "host" "name of local"
16503.cindex "local host" "name of"
16504.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16505This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16506HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16507option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16508The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16509server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16510
16511If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16512name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16513contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16514&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16515version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16516explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16517
16518
16519.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16520.cindex "printing characters"
16521.cindex "8-bit characters"
16522By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1652332&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16524when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16525sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16526is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16527characters.
16528
16529This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16530&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16531the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16532described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16533Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16534standards.
16535
16536
16537.option process_log_path main string unset
16538.cindex "process log path"
16539.cindex "log" "process log"
16540.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16541This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16542&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16543utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16544in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16545can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16546different spool directories.
16547
16548
16549.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16550.cindex "restricting access to features"
16551.oindex "&%-M%&"
16552.oindex "&%-R%&"
16553.oindex "&%-q%&"
16554The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16555admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16556&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16557
16558
16559.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16560.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16561.cindex "address" "qualification"
16562This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16563addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16564recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16565are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16566also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16567locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16568
16569Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16570unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16571&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16572addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16573necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16574addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16575&%primary_hostname%& value.
16576
16577
16578.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16579This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16580addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16581
16582
16583
16584.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16585.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16586.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16587.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16588This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16589A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16590domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16591next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16592
16593
16594.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16595.cindex "restricting access to features"
16596.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16597The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16598queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16599&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16600See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16601
16602
16603.option queue_only main boolean false
16604.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16605.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16606If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16607whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16608next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16609delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16610
16611The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16612and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16613&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16614&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16615
16616
16617.option queue_only_file main string unset
16618.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16619.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16620This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16621one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16622it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16623each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16624For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16625&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16626.code
16627queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16628.endd
16629causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16630&_/some/file_& exists.
16631
16632
16633.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16634.cindex "load average"
16635.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16636.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16637If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16638all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16639happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16640the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16641the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16642false.
16643
16644Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16645option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16646determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16647&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16648
16649
16650.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16651.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16652When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16653because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16654all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16655This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16656threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16657connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16658circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16659where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16660should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16661re-evaluated for each message.
16662
16663
16664.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16665.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16666When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16667setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16668&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16669to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16670
16671
16672.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16673.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16674If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16675in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16676must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16677single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16678and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16679single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16680the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16681avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16682&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16683when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16684large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16685
16686
16687
16688.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16689.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16690This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16691can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16692but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16693start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16694very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16695however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16696started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16697
16698Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16699the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16700run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16701the daemon's command line.
16702
16703.cindex queues named
16704.cindex "named queues"
16705To set limits for different named queues use
16706an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16707
16708.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16709.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16710.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16711When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16712received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16713However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16714&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16715message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16716has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16717when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16718over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16719SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16720&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16721&%queue_domains%&.
16722
16723
16724.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16725.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16726This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16727maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16728the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16729&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16730controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16731
16732.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16733.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16734.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16735This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16736added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16737on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16738used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16739added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16740&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16741header lines.
16742.new
16743The default setting is:
16744
16745.code
16746received_header_text = Received: \
16747 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16748 {${if def:sender_ident \
16749 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16750 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16751 by $primary_hostname \
16752 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16753 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16754 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16755 ${if def:sender_address \
16756 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16757 id $message_exim_id\
16758 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16759.endd
16760.wen
16761
16762The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16763support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16764locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16765header lines such as the following:
16766.code
16767Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16768by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16769(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16770id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16771for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16772Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16773id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16774.endd
16775Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16776the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16777checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16778message was accepted.
16779
16780
16781.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16782.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16783.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16784.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16785When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16786counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16787have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16788This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16789
16790
16791.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16792.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16793.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16794This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16795recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16796qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16797affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16798addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16799host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16800or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16801option was not set.
16802
16803
16804.option recipients_max main integer 0
16805.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16806.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16807If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16808original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16809by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16810all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16811Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16812done.
16813
16814.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16815&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16816RCPT commands in a single message.
16817
16818
16819.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16820If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16821recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16822error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16823error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16824initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16825for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16826
16827
16828.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16829.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16830This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16831hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16832does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16833message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16834have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16835deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16836deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16837each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16838same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16839&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16840with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16841tagged with its process id.
16842
16843This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16844message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16845manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16846deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16847is received.
16848
16849.cindex "number of deliveries"
16850.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16851If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16852need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16853are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16854daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16855fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16856runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16857delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16858then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16859&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16860
16861If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16862&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16863doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16864host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16865
16866
16867.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16868.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16869.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16870When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16871domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16872.code
16873remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16874.endd
16875would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16876then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16877
16878
16879.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16880.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16881This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16882database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16883host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16884past failures.
16885
16886
16887.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16888.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16889.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16890Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16891intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16892straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16893retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16894the default value.
16895
16896
16897.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16898.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16899RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16900&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16901The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16902MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16903in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16904&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16905received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16906the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16907
16908
16909.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16910This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16911
16912
16913.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16914.cindex "RFC 1413"
16915.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16916RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16917an item in the list.
16918The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16919for the system.
16920
16921.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16922.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16923.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16924This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16925no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16926
16927
16928.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16929.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16930.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16931This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16932sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16933&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16934not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16935it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16936&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16937using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16938
16939.option add_environment main "string list" empty
16940.cindex "environment"
16941This option allows to add individual environment variables that the
16942currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16943default list is empty.
16944
16945
16946.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16947.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16948.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16949This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16950If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16951and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16952Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16953
16954
16955
16956.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16957.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16958This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16959TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16960connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16961other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16962still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16963this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16964connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16965tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16966hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16967
16968
16969
16970.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16971.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16972.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16973.cindex "inetd"
16974This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16975that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16976control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16977value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16978non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16979set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16980
16981A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16982has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16983that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16984and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16985
16986
16987.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16988.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16989.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16990Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16991the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16992check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16993client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16994client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16995
16996When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16997allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16998but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16999or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17000starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17001counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17002following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17003MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17004
17005
17006.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17007You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17008check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17009changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17010live with.
17011
17012
17013. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17014. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17015. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17016. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17017. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17018. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17019. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17020. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17021. the option name to split.
17022
17023.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17024 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17025.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17026.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17027The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17028prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17029results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17030response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17031precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17032seen).
17033
17034
17035.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17036.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17037.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17038This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17039host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17040expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17041reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17042connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17043is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17044of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17045required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17046
17047&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17048constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17049happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17050without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17051could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17052doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17053
17054
17055
17056.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17057.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17058.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17059.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17060If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17061listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17062in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17063fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17064subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17065to all messages received in the same connection.
17066
17067A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17068if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17069also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17070various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17071
17072
17073. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17074
17075.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17076 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17077.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17078.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17079This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17080automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17081the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17082and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17083number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17084are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17085restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17086systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17087dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17088
17089
17090.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17091.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17092.cindex "host" "reserved"
17093When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17094number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17095that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17096&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17097restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17098of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17099of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17100the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17101individual host.
17102
17103For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17104set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17105connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17106provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17107
17108
17109.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17110.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17111.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17112.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17113This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17114several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17115is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17116responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17117incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17118
17119.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17120The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17121is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17122in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17123
17124If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17125expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17126used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17127panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17128value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17129For example:
17130.code
17131smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17132 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17133.endd
17134
17135Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17136messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17137verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17138&%helo_data%& value.
17139
17140.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17141.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17142.cindex "banner for SMTP"
17143.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17144.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17145This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17146positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17147.code
17148smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17149 $version_number $tod_full
17150.endd
17151Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17152multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17153appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17154in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17155multiline response).
17156
17157
17158.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17159.cindex "checking disk space"
17160.cindex "disk space, checking"
17161.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17162When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17163option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17164spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17165leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17166is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17167
17168
17169.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17170.cindex "connection backlog"
17171.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17172.cindex "backlog of connections"
17173This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17174this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17175of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17176attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17177say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17178out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17179value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17180attacks by SYN flooding.
17181
17182
17183.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17184.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17185.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17186The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17187the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17188synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17189fewer, but they still exist.
17190
17191Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17192for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17193client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17194SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17195for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17196input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17197does detect many instances.
17198
17199The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17200If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17201hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17202(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17203
17204
17205
17206.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17207.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17208.vindex "&$domain$&"
17209If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17210command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17211chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17212are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17213argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17214example:
17215.code
17216smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17217 $sender_host_address
17218.endd
17219A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17220complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17221run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17222a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17223receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17224the command.
17225
17226
17227.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17228.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17229When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17230one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17231section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17232
17233
17234.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17235.cindex "load average"
17236If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17237accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17238If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17239the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17240systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17241&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17242
17243
17244
17245.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17246.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17247.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17248Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17249particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17250.code
17251RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17252.endd
17253causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17254(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17255example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17256too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17257dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17258
17259.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17260When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17261&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17262Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17263&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17264not count towards the limit.
17265
17266
17267
17268.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17269.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17270.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17271If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17272Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17273that subvert web
17274clients
17275into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17276non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17277
17278
17279
17280.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17281.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17282.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17283.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17284Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17285can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17286recipients.
17287
17288Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17289facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17290&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17291&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17292
17293When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17294&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17295rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17296respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17297values:
17298
17299.ilist
17300A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17301.next
17302An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17303fractional parts are allowed here.
17304.next
17305A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17306.next
17307A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17308because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17309.endlist
17310
17311For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17312first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17313.code
17314smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17315smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17316.endd
17317The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17318two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17319seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17320delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17321
17322
17323.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17324See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17325
17326
17327.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17328See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17329
17330
17331.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17332.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17333.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17334This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17335input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17336data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17337the message is abandoned.
17338A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17339.code
17340SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17341SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17342.endd
17343The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17344means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17345
17346If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17347expanded before use and may depend on
17348&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17349
17350
17351.oindex "&%-os%&"
17352The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17353&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17354this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17355of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17356timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17357
17358
17359.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17360This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17361&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17362
17363
17364.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17365.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17366.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17367In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17368&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17369reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17370to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17371policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17372&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17373example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17374.code
17375550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17376550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17377.endd
17378
17379
17380.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17381.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17382When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17383the availability thereof is advertised in
17384response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17385chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17386
17387
17388.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17389This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17390extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17391See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17392
17393
17394
17395.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17396This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17397See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17398
17399
17400
17401.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17402.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17403.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17404.cindex "directories, multiple"
17405If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17406subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17407sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17408subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17409arrival of the message.
17410
17411Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17412where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17413directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17414directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17415are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17416
17417It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17418changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17419&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17420after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17421automatically deleted.
17422
17423When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17424changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17425trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17426sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17427sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17428spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17429particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17430if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17431entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17432
17433
17434.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17435.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17436This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17437it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17438configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17439string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17440&$primary_hostname$&.
17441
17442If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17443that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17444log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17445Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17446as failures in the configuration file.
17447
17448By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17449tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17450
17451.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17452.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17453If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17454for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17455Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17456Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17457option.
17458
17459The following variables will not have useful values:
17460.code
17461$max_received_linelength
17462$body_linecount
17463$body_zerocount
17464.endd
17465
17466Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17467and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17468(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17469will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17470
17471Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17472(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17473The transmission benefit is maintained.
17474
17475.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17476.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17477This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17478access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17479
17480.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17481.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17482This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17483variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17484is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17485&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17486
17487.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17488.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17489If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17490items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17491treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17492passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17493option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17494
17495
17496.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17497.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17498.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17499If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17500ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17501MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17502domain causes a syntax error.
17503However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17504syntax checking.
17505
17506
17507.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17508.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17509When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17510separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17511be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17512separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17513nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17514particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17515both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17516containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17517Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17518the LOG_ALERT priority.
17519
17520
17521.option syslog_facility main string unset
17522.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17523This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17524syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17525&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17526If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17527details of Exim's logging.
17528
17529
17530.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17531.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17532If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17533omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17534the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17535to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17536into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17537
17538
17539
17540.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17541.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17542This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17543syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17544&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17545
17546
17547
17548.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17549.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17550If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17551omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17552details of Exim's logging.
17553
17554
17555.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17556.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17557.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17558.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17559This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17560the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17561must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17562generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17563appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17564which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17565&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17566A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17567
17568
17569.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17570.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17571This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17572&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17573implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17574During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17575
17576
17577.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17578.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17579This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17580command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17581the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17582
17583.option system_filter_group main string unset
17584.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17585This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17586gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17587with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17588
17589.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17590.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17591.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17592This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17593is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17594contains the pipe command.
17595
17596
17597.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17598.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17599This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17600is used in a system filter.
17601
17602
17603.option system_filter_user main string unset
17604.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17605If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17606delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17607process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17608Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17609is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17610configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17611specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17612&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17613
17614If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17615under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17616transport option overrides.
17617
17618
17619.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17620.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17621.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17622.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17623If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17624TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17625turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17626performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17627should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17628However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17629this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17630daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17631TCP_NODELAY.
17632
17633
17634.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17635.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17636.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17637If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17638message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17639is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17640bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17641sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17642If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17643frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17644
17645&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17646frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17647messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17648
17649
17650.option timezone main string unset
17651.cindex "timezone, setting"
17652.cindex "environment" "values from"
17653The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17654running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17655created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17656to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17657.code
17658timezone = UTC
17659.endd
17660The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17661or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17662is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17663time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17664runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17665unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17666
17667
17668.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17669.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17670.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17671.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17672When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17673of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17674response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17675chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17676Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17677using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17678is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17679
17680
17681.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17682.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17683.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17684The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17685files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17686Commonly only one file is needed.
17687The server's private key is also
17688assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17689&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17690
17691&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17692receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17693use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17694option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17695
17696&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17697separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17698
17699&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17700when a list of more than one
17701file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17702.new
17703The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17704.wen
17705
17706If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17707if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17708Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17709&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17710
17711If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17712generated for every connection.
17713
17714.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17715.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17716.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17717This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17718be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17719
17720Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17721
17722&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17723for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17724For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17725
17726See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17727
17728
17729.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17730.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17731The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17732the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17733interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17734suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17735
17736The value must be at least 1024.
17737
17738The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17739hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17740by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17741
17742If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17743number.
17744
17745Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17746little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17747larger prime than requested.
17748
17749
17750.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17751.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17752The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17753to be used by Exim.
17754
17755.new
17756This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
17757The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
17758.wen
17759
17760&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
17761for other TLS library versions,
17762using a filename with site-generated
17763local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17764other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17765"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17766
17767If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17768then it names a file from which DH
17769parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17770PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17771OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17772fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17773loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17774and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17775
17776If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17777loaded by Exim.
17778
17779If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17780Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17781does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17782See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17783
17784If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17785a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17786
17787In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
177882.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17789in IKE is assigned number 23.
17790
17791Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17792of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17793sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17794the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17795&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17796
17797The available standard primes are:
17798&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17799&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17800&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17801&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17802
17803The available additional primes are:
17804&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17805
17806Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17807Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17808The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17809of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17810(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17811
17812At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17813they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17814candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17815
17816The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17817to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17818whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17819tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17820need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17821userbase.
17822
17823Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17824is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17825applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17826used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17827mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17828prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17829acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17830
17831
17832.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17833.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17834This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17835It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17836
17837After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17838&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17839for valid selections.
17840
17841For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17842&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17843&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17844
17845If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17846
17847
17848.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17849.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17850.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17851This option
17852must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17853status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17854Certificate Authority.
17855
17856Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17857.new
17858The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
17859.wen
17860
17861.new
17862For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
17863.wen
17864for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17865of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17866The ordering of the two lists must match.
17867.new
17868The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
17869.wen
17870
17871.new
17872The file(s) should be in DER format,
17873except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
17874or for OpenSSL,
17875when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
17876The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
17877a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
17878files in the list; the initial format is DER.
17879If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
17880(this only works under TLS1.3)
17881they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
17882
17883Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
17884PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
17885TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
17886although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
17887.wen
17888
17889.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17890.cindex SSMTP
17891.cindex SMTPS
17892This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17893operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17894set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17895further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17896
17897
17898
17899.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17900.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17901The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17902files which contains the server's private keys.
17903If this option is unset, or if
17904the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17905key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17906&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17907
17908See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17909
17910
17911.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17912.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17913.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17914If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17915&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17916support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17917TLS session.
17918
17919
17920.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17921.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17922.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17923This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17924The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17925connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17926different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17927permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17928in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17929preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17930&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17931
17932
17933.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17934.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17935.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17936See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17937
17938
17939.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17940.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17941.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17942The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17943word "system"
17944or the absolute path to
17945a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17946match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17947
17948The "system" value for the option will use a
17949system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17950This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17951and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17952must be specified.
17953
17954The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17955preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17956
17957With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17958explicitly
17959either by file or directory
17960are added to those given by the system default location.
17961
17962These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17963than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17964the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17965connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17966Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17967use the explicit directory version.
17968
17969See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17970
17971A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17972being unset.
17973
17974
17975.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17976.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17977.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17978This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17979certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17980&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17981either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17982&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17983
17984Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17985&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17986present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17987aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17988the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17989connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17990ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17991
17992A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17993matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17994certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17995abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17996state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17997such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17998but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17999certificate"&.
18000
18001Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18002certificates.
18003
18004
18005.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18006.cindex "trusted groups"
18007.cindex "groups" "trusted"
18008This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18009option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18010which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18011specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18012details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18013&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18014are trusted.
18015
18016.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18017.cindex "trusted users"
18018.cindex "user" "trusted"
18019This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18020option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18021trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18022&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18023If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18024Exim user are trusted.
18025
18026.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18027.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18028.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18029This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18030the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18031gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18032used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18033can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18034is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18035&%-F%& option.
18036
18037.option unknown_username main string unset
18038See &%unknown_login%&.
18039
18040.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18041.cindex "trusted users"
18042.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18043.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18044.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18045.cindex "envelope from"
18046.cindex "envelope sender"
18047When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18048normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18049default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18050senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18051is used) is ignored.
18052
18053However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18054to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18055.code
18056exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18057.endd
18058.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18059The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18060other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18061users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18062patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18063identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18064users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18065followed by a hyphen
18066by a setting like this:
18067.code
18068untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18069.endd
18070If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18071restriction, you can use
18072.code
18073untrusted_set_sender = *
18074.endd
18075The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18076only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18077to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18078parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18079&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18080necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18081overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18082described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18083
18084The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18085&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18086&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18087envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18088sender address.
18089
18090
18091.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18092.cindex "&""From""& line"
18093.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18094Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18095an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18096particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18097of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18098matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18099&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18100default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18101.code
18102From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18103From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18104.endd
18105The pattern can be seen by running
18106.code
18107exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18108.endd
18109It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18110year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18111regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18112&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18113(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18114&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18115
18116
18117.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18118See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18119
18120
18121.option warn_message_file main string unset
18122.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18123.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18124This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18125for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18126been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18127&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18128&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18129
18130
18131.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18132.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18133If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18134See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18135.ecindex IIDconfima
18136.ecindex IIDmaiconf
18137
18138
18139
18140
18141. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18142. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18143
18144.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18145.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18146.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18147This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18148Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18149
18150For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18151&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18152which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18153provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18154&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18155
18156
18157
18158.option address_data routers string&!! unset
18159.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18160The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18161precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18162router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18163&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18164delivery of the address to be deferred.
18165
18166.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18167When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18168accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18169routers, and the eventual transport.
18170
18171&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18172that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18173in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18174either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18175put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18176
18177Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18178with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18179on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18180&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18181&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18182
18183The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18184for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18185you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18186.code
18187uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18188.endd
18189In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18190.code
18191file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18192.endd
18193This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18194lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18195
18196.new
18197See also the &%set%& option below.
18198.wen
18199
18200.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18201.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18202The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18203from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18204&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18205ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18206verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18207
18208
18209
18210.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18211.oindex "&%-bt%&"
18212.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18213If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18214by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18215your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18216having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18217routing.
18218
18219
18220
18221.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18222.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18223.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18224This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18225routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18226&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18227&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18228value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18229includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18230well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18231you could put:
18232.code
18233cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18234.endd
18235on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18236and
18237.code
18238cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18239.endd
18240on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18241this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18242explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18243logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18244
18245
18246.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18247.cindex "case of local parts"
18248.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18249By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18250manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18251If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18252this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18253part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18254turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18255more details.
18256
18257.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18258.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18259.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18260The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18261router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18262an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18263is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18264addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18265and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18266
18267This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18268recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18269modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18270(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18271
18272
18273
18274.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18275.cindex "local user, checking in router"
18276.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18277.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18278.vindex "&$home$&"
18279When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18280address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18281local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18282than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18283holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18284user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18285preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18286given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18287overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18288the router is skipped.
18289
18290If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18291or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18292setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18293two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18294setting to achieve this. For example:
18295.code
18296local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18297.endd
18298Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18299up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18300&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18301
18302
18303
18304.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18305.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18306This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18307router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18308evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18309result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18310&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18311router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18312
18313If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18314precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18315
18316This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18317All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18318
18319The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18320running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18321the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18322.code
18323condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18324.endd
18325Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18326.code
18327condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18328.endd
18329
18330A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18331.code
18332condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18333condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18334condition = foobar
18335.endd
18336
18337If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18338of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18339be specified using &%condition%&.
18340
18341Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18342are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18343they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18344parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18345ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18346Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18347Router rules processing behavior.
18348
18349This is best illustrated in an example:
18350.code
18351# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18352# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18353
18354$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18355true {yes} {no}}
18356
18357$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18358 {yes} {no}}
18359.endd
18360In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18361&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18362default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18363(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18364string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18365with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18366resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18367&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18368
18369In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18370&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18371mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18372conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18373string characters.
18374
18375Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18376true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18377match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18378contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18379expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18380
18381
18382.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18383.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18384If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18385option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18386the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18387If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18388output, and Exim carries on processing.
18389This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18390so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18391option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18392variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18393&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18394are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18395The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18396
18397
18398
18399.option disable_logging routers boolean false
18400If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18401or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18402unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18403transport option of the same name.
18404
18405.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18406.cindex "MX record" "security"
18407.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18408.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18409.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18410DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18411the dnssec request bit set.
18412This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18413
18414.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18415.cindex "MX record" "security"
18416.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18417.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18418.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18419DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18420the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18421(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18422This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18423
18424
18425.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18426.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18427.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18428If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18429the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18430lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18431expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18432a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18433
18434
18435
18436.option driver routers string unset
18437This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18438to be used.
18439
18440
18441.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18442.cindex "DSN" "success"
18443.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18444If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18445Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18446instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18447Not effective on redirect routers.
18448
18449
18450
18451.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18452.cindex "envelope from"
18453.cindex "envelope sender"
18454.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18455If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18456transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18457there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18458message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18459provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18460expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18461
18462The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18463subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18464settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18465setting.
18466
18467If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18468the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18469address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18470expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18471
18472If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18473SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18474any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18475sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18476settings:
18477.code
18478errors_to =
18479errors_to = ""
18480.endd
18481An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18482this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18483no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18484address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18485overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18486
18487.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18488If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18489MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18490path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18491setting &%return_path%&.
18492
18493The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18494manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18495implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18496
18497
18498
18499.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18500.cindex "address" "testing"
18501.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18502.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18503.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18504If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18505as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18506want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18507on for the system alias file.
18508See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18509are evaluated.
18510
18511The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18512&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18513an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18514
18515
18516
18517.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18518.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18519Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18520&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18521
18522
18523
18524.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18525If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18526verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18527
18528
18529
18530.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18531If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18532verifying a sender, verification fails.
18533
18534
18535
18536.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18537.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18538.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18539String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18540colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18541changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18542each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18543defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18544&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18545
18546If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18547associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18548list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18549randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18550transport for further details.
18551
18552
18553.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18554.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18555.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18556.cindex "transport" "local"
18557.cindex "router" "setting group"
18558When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18559specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18560process.
18561The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18562error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18563The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18564is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18565and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18566
18567
18568
18569.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18570.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18571.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18572This option specifies a list of text headers,
18573newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18574that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18575Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18576option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18577the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18578&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18579message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18580header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18581&"see"& the added header lines.
18582
18583The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18584&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18585an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18586failures are treated as configuration errors.
18587
18588Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18589for a router; all listed headers are added.
18590
18591&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18592router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18593
18594.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18595.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18596&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18597additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18598For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18599address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18600modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18601circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18602which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18603avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18604
18605
18606
18607.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18608.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18609.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18610This option specifies a list of text headers,
18611colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18612that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18613Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18614option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18615the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18616section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18617the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18618to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18619&"see"& the original header lines.
18620
18621The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18622&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18623the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18624errors.
18625
18626Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18627for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18628
18629&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18630router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18631
18632&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18633removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18634routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18635warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18636
18637&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18638items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18639To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18640
18641
18642
18643.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18644.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18645.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18646Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18647entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18648IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18649address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18650like
18651.code
18652remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18653.endd
18654by setting
18655.code
18656ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18657.endd
18658on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18659discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18660attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18661domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18662Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18663router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18664
18665You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18666means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18667.code
18668ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18669ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18670.endd
18671The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18672in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18673
18674This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18675addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18676is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18677domain that is being routed.
18678
18679.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18680During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18681checked.
18682
18683.option initgroups routers boolean false
18684.cindex "additional groups"
18685.cindex "groups" "additional"
18686.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18687.cindex "transport" "local"
18688If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18689the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18690&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18691any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18692and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18693
18694
18695
18696.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18697.cindex affix "router precondition"
18698.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18699.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18700If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18701one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18702section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18703evaluated.
18704
18705The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18706used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18707asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18708the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18709some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18710.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18711.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18712Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18713section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18714
18715.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18716.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18717During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18718running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18719expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18720the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18721a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18722command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18723This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18724the relevant transport.
18725
18726When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18727behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18728means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18729callout.
18730
18731The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18732&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18733&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18734to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18735immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18736.code
18737real_localuser:
18738 driver = accept
18739 local_part_prefix = real-
18740 check_local_user
18741 transport = local_delivery
18742.endd
18743For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18744router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18745.code
18746 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18747 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18748.endd
18749
18750If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18751both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18752are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18753separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18754
18755
18756.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18757See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18758
18759
18760
18761.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18762.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18763.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18764This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18765local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18766&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18767mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18768character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18769parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18770&%username-foo%&.
18771
18772
18773.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18774See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18775
18776
18777
18778.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18779.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18780.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18781The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18782See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18783are evaluated, and
18784section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18785string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18786example:
18787.code
18788local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18789.endd
18790.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18791If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18792for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18793expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18794example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18795send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18796each virtual domain:
18797.code
18798postmaster:
18799 driver = redirect
18800 local_parts = postmaster
18801 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18802.endd
18803
18804
18805.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18806.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18807.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18808Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18809deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18810recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18811this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18812router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18813router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18814redirect addresses.
18815
18816
18817
18818.option more routers boolean&!! true
18819The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18820that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18821result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18822fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18823delivery to be deferred.
18824
18825If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18826further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18827.oindex "&%self%&"
18828However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18829means of the setting
18830.code
18831self = pass
18832.endd
18833or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18834does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18835case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18836
18837Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18838expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18839controls what happens next.
18840
18841
18842.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18843.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18844.cindex "router" "timeout"
18845If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18846address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18847router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18848intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18849host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18850
18851There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18852lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18853applies to all of them.
18854
18855
18856
18857.option pass_router routers string unset
18858.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18859Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18860&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18861routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18862these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18863router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18864of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18865be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18866to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18867&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18868
18869
18870
18871.option redirect_router routers string unset
18872.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18873Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18874generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18875example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18876point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18877
18878The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18879It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18880instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18881which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18882
18883
18884
18885.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18886.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18887.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18888This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18889router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18890Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18891through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18892
18893Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18894be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18895(&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18896If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18897failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18898
18899If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18900below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18901&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18902existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18903preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18904
18905.cindex "NFS"
18906If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18907the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18908unavailable.
18909
18910This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18911options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18912look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18913full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18914these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18915to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18916that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18917transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18918
18919During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18920facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18921This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18922operates as follows:
18923
18924If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18925characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18926comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18927but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18928used. For example:
18929.code
18930require_files = mail:/some/file
18931require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18932.endd
18933If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18934&%require_files%& condition fails.
18935
18936Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18937checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18938directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18939access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18940
18941&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18942incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18943may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18944may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18945user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18946
18947&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18948&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18949without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18950is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18951check again in that process.
18952
18953The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18954be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18955existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18956circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18957not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18958for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18959as if the file did not exist. For example:
18960.code
18961require_files = +/some/file
18962.endd
18963If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18964handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18965option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18966
18967
18968
18969.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18970.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18971.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18972When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18973in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18974domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18975other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18976Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18977latter kind.
18978
18979This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18980hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18981.new
18982router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
18983&%check_local_user%&,
18984&%local_parts%&,
18985&%condition%&,
18986&%local_part_prefix%&,
18987&%local_part_suffix%&,
18988&%senders%& or
18989&%require_files%&
18990.wen
18991set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18992for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18993same name.
18994
18995Failing to set this option when it is needed
18996(because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
18997can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
18998
18999The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19000appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19001independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19002
19003
19004
19005.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19006.cindex "router" "home directory for"
19007.cindex "home directory" "for router"
19008.vindex "&$home$&"
19009This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19010&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19011transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19012sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19013forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19014cause the router to defer.
19015
19016Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19017&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19018place.
19019(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19020are evaluated.)
19021While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19022&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19023
19024When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19025the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19026delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19027of these values that is set:
19028
19029.ilist
19030The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19031.next
19032The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19033.next
19034The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19035.next
19036The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19037.endlist
19038
19039In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19040router, but not for the transport.
19041
19042
19043
19044.option self routers string freeze
19045.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19046.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19047This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19048list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19049and &(manualroute)& routers.
19050Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19051of remote hosts.
19052Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19053&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19054host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19055The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19056&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19057
19058Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19059example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19060error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19061reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19062freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19063cases:
19064
19065.vlist
19066.vitem &%defer%&
19067Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19068
19069.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19070The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19071be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19072behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19073
19074.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19075The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19076reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19077rewritten.
19078
19079.vitem &%pass%&
19080.oindex "&%more%&"
19081.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19082The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19083&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19084subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19085name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19086distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19087combination
19088.code
19089self = pass
19090no_more
19091.endd
19092ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19093Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19094be passed to the next router.
19095
19096.vitem &%fail%&
19097Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19098
19099.vitem &%send%&
19100.cindex "local host" "sending to"
19101The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19102setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19103makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19104is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19105different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19106.endlist
19107
19108
19109
19110.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19111.cindex "router" "checking senders"
19112If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19113address matches something on the list.
19114See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19115are evaluated.
19116
19117There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19118dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19119setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19120to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19121set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19122verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19123SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19124matters.
19125
19126
19127.new
19128.option set routers "string list" unset
19129.cindex router variables
19130This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19131because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19132The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19133usual way.
19134
19135Each list-element given must be of the form $"name = value"$
19136and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19137Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19138When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19139to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19140the address.
19141The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19142The variables can be used by the router options
19143(not including any preconditions)
19144and by the transport.
19145Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19146Varible use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19147
19148This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19149many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19150.wen
19151
19152
19153.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19154.cindex "IP address" "translating"
19155.cindex "packet radio"
19156.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19157There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19158it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19159mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19160routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19161is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19162code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19163SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19164
19165.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19166The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19167by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19168expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19169For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19170If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19171address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19172up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19173produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19174addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19175.code
19176translate_ip_address = \
19177 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19178 {$value}fail}}
19179.endd
19180The file would contain lines like
19181.code
1918210.2.3.128/26 some.host
1918310.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19184.endd
19185You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19186are doing.
19187
19188
19189
19190.option transport routers string&!! unset
19191This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19192and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19193only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19194after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19195and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19196delivery is deferred.
19197
19198The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19199have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19200(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19201
19202
19203
19204.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19205.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19206This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19207to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19208explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19209file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19210option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19211overridden by a setting on the transport.
19212If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19213logged, and delivery is deferred.
19214See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19215environment.
19216
19217
19218
19219
19220.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19221.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19222This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19223local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19224configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19225pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19226string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19227setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19228If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19229logged, and delivery is deferred.
19230
19231If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19232&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19233the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19234the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19235is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19236
19237See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19238environment.
19239
19240
19241
19242
19243.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19244.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19245The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19246that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19247result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19248fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19249delivery to be deferred.
19250
19251When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19252address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19253overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19254&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19255the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19256sometimes true and sometimes false).
19257
19258.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19259Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19260qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19261delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19262In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19263&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19264to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19265&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19266
19267&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19268this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19269only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19270no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19271a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19272duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19273duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19274&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19275so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19276&%redirect%& router may be of help.
19277
19278Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19279&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19280subsequent routers.
19281
19282
19283.option user routers string&!! "see below"
19284.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19285.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19286.cindex "transport" "local"
19287.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19288.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19289When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19290specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19291The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19292error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19293This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19294The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19295the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19296a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19297See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19298&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19299
19300
19301
19302.option verify routers&!? boolean true
19303Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19304&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19305
19306
19307.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19308.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19309.oindex "&%-bv%&"
19310.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19311If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19312delivering in cutthrough mode or
19313testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19314with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19315restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19316&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19317
19318&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19319SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19320accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19321user or group.
19322
19323
19324.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19325If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19326addresses,
19327delivering in cutthrough mode
19328or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19329See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19330are evaluated.
19331See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19332
19333
19334.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19335If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19336or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19337See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19338are evaluated.
19339See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19340.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19341.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19342
19343
19344
19345
19346
19347
19348. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19349. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19350
19351.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19352.cindex "&(accept)& router"
19353.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19354The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19355used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19356be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19357specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19358it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19359up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19360.code
19361localusers:
19362 driver = accept
19363 domains = mydomain.example
19364 check_local_user
19365 transport = local_delivery
19366.endd
19367The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19368&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19369When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19370address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19371
19372
19373
19374
19375
19376
19377. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19378. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19379
19380.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19381.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19382.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19383The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19384recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19385unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19386
19387If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19388SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19389MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19390However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19391records.
19392
19393MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19394looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19395When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19396except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19397IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19398generic option, the router declines.
19399
19400Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19401to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19402are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19403
19404.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19405.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19406.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19407If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19408address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19409happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19410
19411
19412.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19413There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19414Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19415SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19416MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19417problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19418
19419For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19420&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19421&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19422an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19423domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19424such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19425proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19426look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19427case routing fails.
19428
19429
19430.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19431.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19432There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19433an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19434domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19435
19436The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19437is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19438
19439Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19440.ilist
19441The domain does not exist in DNS
19442.next
19443The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19444convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19445for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19446.next
19447Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19448.next
19449MX record points to a non-existent host.
19450.next
19451MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19452&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19453.next
19454MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19455addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19456.next
19457The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19458&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19459.next
19460&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19461not be found in the MX records (see below)
19462.endlist
19463
19464
19465
19466
19467.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19468.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19469The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19470
19471.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19472.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19473If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19474(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19475process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19476differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19477the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19478
19479
19480.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19481.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19482The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19483addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19484enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19485required. For example,
19486.code
19487check_srv = smtp
19488.endd
19489looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19490expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19491to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19492submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19493option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19494normal way.
19495
19496When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19497the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19498host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19499this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19500SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19501according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19502
19503When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19504the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19505records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19506this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19507defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19508and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19509have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19510trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19511
19512See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19513when there is a DNS lookup error.
19514
19515
19516
19517
19518.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19519.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19520DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19521which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19522rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19523This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19524domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19525However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19526also being queued.
19527
19528
19529.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19530.cindex IPv6 disabling
19531.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19532The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19533or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19534(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19535only A records are used.
19536
19537.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19538.cindex IPv4 preference
19539.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19540The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19541or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19542(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19543A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19544
19545.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19546.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19547.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19548A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19549record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19550For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19551records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19552setting:
19553.code
19554mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19555.endd
19556This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19557has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19558the address record.
19559
19560
19561.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19562If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19563DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19564&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19565
19566
19567
19568
19569.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19570.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19571.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19572When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19573lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19574single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19575called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19576&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19577resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19578&'resolv.conf'&.
19579
19580
19581
19582.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19583.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19584.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19585If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19586qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19587an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19588expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19589occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19590&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19591any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19592header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19593
19594This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19595ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19596sense.
19597
19598When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19599servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19600making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19601some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19602name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19603header rewriting.
19604
19605
19606.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19607.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19608Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19609to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19610options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19611default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19612servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19613any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19614
19615If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19616domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19617local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19618lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19619routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19620message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19621without processing them independently,
19622provided the following conditions are met:
19623
19624.ilist
19625No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19626&%headers_remove%&.
19627.next
19628The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19629the domain.
19630.endlist
19631
19632
19633
19634
19635.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19636.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19637When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19638lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19639applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19640the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19641domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19642up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19643&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19644actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19645
19646Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19647record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19648local wildcard.
19649
19650
19651
19652.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19653If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19654DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19655&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19656
19657
19658
19659
19660.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19661.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19662If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19663added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19664if
19665.code
19666widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19667.endd
19668is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19669&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19670&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19671and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19672the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19673when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19674
19675
19676.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19677When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19678of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19679corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19680is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19681
19682These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19683for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19684such as that implied by
19685.code
19686domains = @mx_any
19687.endd
19688that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19689entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19690.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19691.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19692
19693
19694
19695
19696
19697
19698
19699
19700
19701. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19702. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19703
19704.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19705.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19706.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19707.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19708This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19709verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19710generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19711takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19712router handles the address
19713.code
19714root@[192.168.1.1]
19715.endd
19716by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19717consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19718are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19719.code
19720postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19721.endd
19722Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19723grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19724
19725.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19726If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19727declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19728&%self%& option determines what happens.
19729
19730The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19731controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19732also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19733Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19734
19735
19736
19737. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19738. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19739
19740.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19741.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19742.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19743The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19744Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19745not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19746must set
19747.code
19748ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19749.endd
19750in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19751
19752The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19753connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19754a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19755message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19756this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19757can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19758must not be specified for it.
19759
19760.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19761.option hosts iplookup string unset
19762This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19763names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19764(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19765and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19766happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19767
19768
19769.option optional iplookup boolean false
19770If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19771is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19772delivery to the address is deferred.
19773
19774
19775.option port iplookup integer 0
19776.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19777This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19778call.
19779
19780
19781.option protocol iplookup string udp
19782This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19783protocols is to be used.
19784
19785
19786.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19787This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19788default value is:
19789.code
19790$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19791.endd
19792The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19793query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19794
19795
19796.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19797If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19798returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19799string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19800in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19801&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19802whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19803up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19804
19805
19806.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19807This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19808returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19809router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19810response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19811check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19812address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19813the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19814following could be used:
19815.code
19816response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19817reroute = $local_part@$1
19818.endd
19819
19820.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19821This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19822machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19823call. It does not apply to UDP.
19824
19825
19826
19827
19828. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19829. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19830
19831.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19832.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19833.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19834.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19835The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19836routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19837route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19838normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19839route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19840messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19841
19842The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19843it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19844has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19845include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19846&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19847generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19848being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19849
19850.vindex "&$host$&"
19851In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19852router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19853an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19854transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19855with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19856passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19857host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19858text string.
19859
19860The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19861&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19862or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19863any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19864below, following the list of private options.
19865
19866
19867.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19868
19869.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19870The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19871
19872.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19873See &%host_find_failed%&.
19874
19875.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19876This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19877address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19878of the following values:
19879.code
19880decline
19881defer
19882fail
19883freeze
19884ignore
19885pass
19886.endd
19887The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19888error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19889forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19890&%pass_router%&),
19891.oindex "&%more%&"
19892overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19893router only if &%more%& is true.
19894
19895The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19896cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19897controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19898as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19899
19900The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19901state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19902generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19903
19904
19905.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19906.cindex "randomized host list"
19907.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19908If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19909is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19910overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19911crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19912same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19913(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19914deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19915
19916When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19917into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19918set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19919item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19920.code
19921route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19922.endd
19923The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19924randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19925If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19926randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19927&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19928
19929
19930.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19931If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19932Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19933example:
19934.code
19935route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19936.endd
19937If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19938router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19939deferred.
19940
19941
19942.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19943This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19944unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19945that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19946
19947
19948.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19949.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19950Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19951router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19952router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19953default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19954servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19955any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19956
19957If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19958domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19959local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19960lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19961&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19962addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19963same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19964if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19965
19966
19967
19968
19969.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19970The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19971rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19972entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19973described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19974Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19975.display
19976<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19977.endd
19978The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19979no options:
19980.code
19981route_list = \
19982 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19983 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19984.endd
19985The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19986list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19987usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19988single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19989pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19990&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19991except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19992That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19993lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19994in a &%route_list%&).
19995
19996The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19997matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19998then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19999&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20000
20001
20002
20003.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20004The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20005routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20006hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20007The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20008Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20009expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20010like this:
20011.code
20012dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20013thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20014.endd
20015This data can be accessed by setting
20016.code
20017route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20018.endd
20019Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20020decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20021requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20022possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20023be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20024
20025
20026
20027
20028.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20029A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20030always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20031declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20032and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20033If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20034The format of each item
20035in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20036as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20037
20038If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20039variables are set during its expansion:
20040
20041.ilist
20042.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20043If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20044&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20045.code
20046route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20047.endd
20048.next
20049&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20050.next
20051&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20052
20053.next
20054.vindex "&$value$&"
20055If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20056looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20057.code
20058route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20059.endd
20060.endlist
20061
20062Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20063semicolon is the default route list separator.
20064
20065
20066
20067.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20068Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20069optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20070is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20071specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20072by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20073
20074.ilist
20075Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20076the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20077be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20078.code
20079route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20080route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20081.endd
20082.next
20083When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20084colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20085enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20086number follows. For example:
20087.code
20088route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20089.endd
20090.endlist
20091
20092.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20093When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20094the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20095delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20096option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20097transport.
20098
20099Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20100hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20101interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20102records in the DNS. For example:
20103.code
20104route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20105.endd
20106If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20107example:
20108.code
20109route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20110.endd
20111If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20112randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20113that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20114be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20115Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20116happens is controlled by the
20117.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20118&%self%& option of the router.
20119
20120A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20121hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20122lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20123below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20124preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20125randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20126defined by MX preferences.
20127
20128If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20129not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20130preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20131
20132If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20133depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20134is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20135Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20136
20137If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20138most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20139router.
20140
20141DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20142failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20143&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20144
20145The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20146whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20147
20148
20149
20150.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20151The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20152One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20153&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20154other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20155per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20156routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20157
20158.ilist
20159&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20160setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20161.next
20162&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20163overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20164.next
20165&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20166find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20167also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20168.next
20169&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20170no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20171timeout), delivery is deferred.
20172.next
20173&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20174.next
20175&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20176.endlist
20177
20178For example:
20179.code
20180route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20181 domain2 host4:host5
20182.endd
20183If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20184DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20185result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20186or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20187call.
20188
20189&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20190called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20191instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20192lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20193function called.
20194
20195&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20196inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20197option specified.
20198
20199
20200
20201If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20202&%host_find_failed%& option.
20203
20204.vindex "&$host$&"
20205When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20206The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20207
20208
20209
20210.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20211In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20212transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20213
20214.ilist
20215.cindex "smart host" "example router"
20216The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20217&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20218named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20219.code
20220domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20221.endd
20222You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20223your first router something like this:
20224.code
20225smart_route:
20226 driver = manualroute
20227 domains = !+local_domains
20228 transport = remote_smtp
20229 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20230.endd
20231This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20232&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20233they are tried in order
20234(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20235Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20236.code
20237smart_route:
20238 driver = manualroute
20239 transport = remote_smtp
20240 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20241.endd
20242There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20243However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20244example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20245precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20246always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20247would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20248always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20249&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20250
20251.next
20252.cindex "mail hub example"
20253A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20254records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20255the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20256machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20257&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20258to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20259using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20260lookup is easier to manage.
20261
20262If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20263to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20264example:
20265.code
20266hub_route:
20267 driver = manualroute
20268 transport = remote_smtp
20269 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20270.endd
20271This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20272whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20273if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20274that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20275domain can be used to find the host:
20276.code
20277through_firewall:
20278 driver = manualroute
20279 transport = remote_smtp
20280 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20281.endd
20282The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20283hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20284data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20285next router.
20286
20287.next
20288.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20289.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20290You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20291SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20292storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20293can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20294.code
20295save_in_file:
20296 driver = manualroute
20297 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20298 route_list = saved.domain.example
20299.endd
20300though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20301several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20302different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20303.code
20304save_in_file:
20305 driver = manualroute
20306 route_list = \
20307 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20308 *.saved.domain2.example \
20309 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20310 batch_pipe
20311.endd
20312.vindex "&$domain$&"
20313.vindex "&$host$&"
20314The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20315doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20316file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20317the address if the lookup fails.
20318
20319.next
20320.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20321Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20322&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20323one way it can be done:
20324.code
20325# Transport
20326uucp:
20327 driver = pipe
20328 user = nobody
20329 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20330 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20331 return_fail_output = true
20332
20333# Router
20334uucphost:
20335 transport = uucp
20336 driver = manualroute
20337 route_data = \
20338 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20339.endd
20340The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20341.code
20342darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20343.endd
20344It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20345makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20346&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20347.endlist
20348.ecindex IIDmanrou1
20349.ecindex IIDmanrou2
20350
20351
20352
20353
20354
20355
20356
20357
20358. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20359. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20360
20361.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20362.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20363.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20364.cindex "routing" "by external program"
20365The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20366and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20367mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20368However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20369&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20370be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20371options:
20372.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20373
20374.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20375This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20376command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20377expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20378&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20379
20380
20381.option command_group queryprogram string unset
20382.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20383This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20384address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20385uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20386gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20387
20388
20389.option command_user queryprogram string unset
20390.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20391This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20392command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20393it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20394using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20395not set, a value for the gid also.
20396
20397&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20398root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20399However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20400usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20401is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20402the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20403gid.
20404
20405
20406.option current_directory queryprogram string /
20407This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20408before running the command.
20409
20410
20411.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20412If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20413is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20414timeout.
20415
20416
20417The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20418the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20419containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20420the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20421field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20422
20423.ilist
20424&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20425below).
20426.next
20427&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20428&%no_more%& is set.
20429.next
20430&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20431subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20432of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20433included in the SMTP response.
20434.next
20435&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20436subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20437included in any SMTP response.
20438.next
20439&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20440.next
20441&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20442&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20443.next
20444&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20445new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20446or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20447.endlist
20448
20449When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20450number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20451the page):
20452.code
20453ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20454LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20455.endd
20456The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20457is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20458used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20459an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20460
20461The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20462As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20463in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20464&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20465(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20466
20467If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20468find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20469anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20470goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20471result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20472
20473.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20474If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20475variable. For example, this return line
20476.code
20477accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20478.endd
20479routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20480the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20481.ecindex IIDquerou1
20482.ecindex IIDquerou2
20483
20484
20485
20486
20487. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20488. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20489
20490.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20491.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20492.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20493.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20494.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20495The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20496common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20497(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20498files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20499redirected in several different ways:
20500
20501.ilist
20502It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20503independently.
20504.next
20505It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20506.next
20507It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20508.next
20509It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20510.next
20511It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20512.next
20513It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20514.next
20515It can be discarded.
20516.endlist
20517
20518The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20519However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20520files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20521&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20522
20523If success DSNs have been requested
20524.cindex "DSN" "success"
20525.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20526redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20527
20528
20529
20530.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20531The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20532expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20533contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20534options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20535aliases, in a configuration like this:
20536.code
20537system_aliases:
20538 driver = redirect
20539 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20540.endd
20541If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20542expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20543expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20544cause delivery to be deferred.
20545
20546A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20547&_.forward_& files, like this:
20548.code
20549userforward:
20550 driver = redirect
20551 check_local_user
20552 file = $home/.forward
20553 no_verify
20554.endd
20555If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20556empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20557is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20558yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20559comments.
20560
20561
20562
20563.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20564.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20565It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20566&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20567
20568.ilist
20569When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20570running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20571the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20572practice the router may not be able to operate.
20573.next
20574However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20575is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20576local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20577saves some resources.
20578.endlist
20579
20580
20581
20582
20583
20584
20585.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20586.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20587.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20588The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20589can be interpreted in two different ways:
20590
20591.ilist
20592If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20593&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20594&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20595respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20596in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20597document is intended for use by end users.
20598.next
20599Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20600described in the next section.
20601.endlist
20602
20603When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20604in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20605generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20606configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20607for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20608
20609
20610
20611.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20612.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20613When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20614comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20615addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20616&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20617disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20618depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20619commas or newlines.
20620If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20621quotes.
20622
20623Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20624also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20625next newline character is ignored.
20626
20627If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20628double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20629(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20630&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20631removed.
20632
20633.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20634&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20635and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20636of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20637special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20638&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20639setting:
20640.code
20641data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20642.endd
20643
20644
20645.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20646.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20647.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20648.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20649A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20650consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20651automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20652is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20653Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20654as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20655complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20656
20657.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20658Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20659filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20660mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20661&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20662.code
20663cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20664.endd
20665.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20666.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20667For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20668preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20669it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20670synonymously.
20671
20672If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
206732822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20674domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20675addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20676force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20677
20678Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20679Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20680contains:
20681.code
20682Sam.Reman: spqr
20683.endd
20684Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20685messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20686this forward file:
20687.code
20688Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20689.endd
20690With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20691&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20692second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20693and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20694should really contain
20695.code
20696spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20697.endd
20698but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20699below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20700&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20701
20702
20703
20704.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20705In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20706lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20707
20708.ilist
20709.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20710.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20711An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20712as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20713command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20714Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20715which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20716
20717Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20718the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20719the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20720in double quotes, for example:
20721.code
20722"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20723.endd
20724since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20725quote just the command. An item such as
20726.code
20727|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20728.endd
20729is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20730
20731Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20732of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20733redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20734quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20735string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20736are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20737data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20738transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20739an &%accept%& router.
20740
20741.next
20742.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20743.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20744An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20745parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20746.code
20747/home/world/minbari
20748.endd
20749is treated as a filename, but
20750.code
20751/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20752.endd
20753is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20754the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20755forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20756filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20757
20758Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20759which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20760
20761.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20762However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20763bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20764instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20765
20766.next
20767.cindex "included address list"
20768.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20769If an item is of the form
20770.code
20771:include:<path name>
20772.endd
20773a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20774point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20775out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20776by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20777item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20778the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20779.code
20780list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20781.endd
20782It must be given as
20783.code
20784list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20785.endd
20786.next
20787.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20788.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20789.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20790.cindex "black hole"
20791.cindex "abandoning mail"
20792Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20793&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20794the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20795.code
20796:blackhole:
20797.endd
20798can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20799done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20800&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20801
20802&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20803delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20804are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20805database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20806&_/dev/null_&.
20807
20808.next
20809.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20810.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20811.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20812.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20813.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20814An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20815redirection items of the form
20816.code
20817:defer:
20818:fail:
20819.endd
20820respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20821to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20822text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20823associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20824.code
20825X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20826.endd
20827In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20828of a
20829.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20830VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20831default.
20832.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20833The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20834the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20835
20836.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20837By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20838&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20839space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20840followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20841code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20842incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20843suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20844&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20845ignored.
20846
20847.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20848In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20849default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20850therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20851
20852Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20853not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20854normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20855as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20856lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20857
20858During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20859containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20860whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20861subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20862deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20863rules still apply.
20864
20865.next
20866.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20867Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20868chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20869for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20870&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20871router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20872results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20873.endlist
20874
20875
20876.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20877.cindex "duplicate addresses"
20878.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20879.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20880Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20881to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20882routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20883aliasing scheme of the type
20884.code
20885pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20886localpart1: pipe
20887localpart2: pipe
20888.endd
20889does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20890when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20891discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20892such as
20893.code
20894localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20895localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20896.endd
20897does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20898the pipes are distinct.
20899
20900
20901
20902.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20903.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20904.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20905When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20906leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20907afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20908delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20909members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20910can be used to avoid this.
20911
20912
20913.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20914.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20915If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20916error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20917for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20918detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20919deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20920
20921
20922
20923.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20924
20925.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20926The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20927
20928
20929.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20930Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20931data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20932
20933
20934.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20935.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20936If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20937and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20938
20939
20940.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20941.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20942.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20943Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20944&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20945are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20946lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20947
20948It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20949the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20950
20951
20952The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20953&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20954&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20955files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20956true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20957
20958
20959
20960.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20961.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20962Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20963This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20964default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20965let ordinary users do.
20966
20967
20968
20969.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20970This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20971as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20972Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20973configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20974for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20975
20976When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20977is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20978the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20979and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20980domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20981&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20982.code
20983\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20984.endd
20985Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20986&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20987originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20988(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20989&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20990&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20991file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20992original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20993
20994
20995.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20996When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20997when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20998&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20999&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21000deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21001is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21002&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21003
21004
21005
21006.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21007When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21008this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21009permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21010option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21011&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21012
21013
21014.option data redirect string&!! unset
21015This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21016set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21017list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21018expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21019has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21020
21021When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21022filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21023terminated with newline characters. For example:
21024.code
21025data = #Exim filter\n\
21026 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21027.endd
21028If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21029you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21030choice into a newline.
21031
21032
21033.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21034A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21035ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21036specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21037configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21038
21039
21040.option file redirect string&!! unset
21041This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21042is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21043use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21044failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21045must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21046data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21047entirely of comments), the router declines.
21048
21049.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21050If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21051runs a check on the containing directory,
21052unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21053If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21054happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21055is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21056not, the router declines.
21057
21058
21059.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21060.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21061A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21062ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21063specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21064configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21065it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21066
21067
21068.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21069When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21070relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21071relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21072relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21073
21074
21075.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21076.cindex "restricting access to features"
21077.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21078If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21079redirection list.
21080
21081
21082.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21083.cindex "restricting access to features"
21084.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21085If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21086&%allow_filter%& is true.
21087
21088
21089
21090
21091.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21092.cindex "restricting access to features"
21093.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21094.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21095.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21096.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21097If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21098specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21099conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21100set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21101locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21102
21103
21104.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21105.cindex "restricting access to features"
21106.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21107If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21108make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21109functions.
21110
21111.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21112.cindex "restricting access to features"
21113.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21114.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21115If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21116make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21117
21118.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21119.cindex "restricting access to features"
21120.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21121If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21122permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21123under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21124&_.forward_& files).
21125
21126
21127.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21128.cindex "restricting access to features"
21129.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21130If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21131to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21132
21133
21134.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21135.cindex "restricting access to features"
21136.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21137This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21138it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21139of the embedded Perl support.
21140
21141
21142.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21143.cindex "restricting access to features"
21144.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21145If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21146to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21147
21148
21149.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21150.cindex "restricting access to features"
21151.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21152If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21153to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21154
21155
21156.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21157.cindex "restricting access to features"
21158.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21159If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21160message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21161files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21162&%one_time%& is set.
21163
21164
21165.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21166.cindex "restricting access to features"
21167.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21168If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21169to make use of &%run%& items.
21170
21171
21172.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21173.cindex "restricting access to features"
21174.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21175If this option is true, items of the form
21176.code
21177:include:<path name>
21178.endd
21179are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21180
21181
21182.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21183.cindex "restricting access to features"
21184.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21185.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21186If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21187specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21188forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21189
21190
21191.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21192.cindex "restricting access to features"
21193.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21194If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21195&%allow_filter%& is true.
21196
21197
21198.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21199.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21200If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21201of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21202the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21203
21204
21205
21206
21207.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21208.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21209If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21210generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21211generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21212bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21213bounce may well quote the generated address.
21214
21215
21216.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21217.cindex "EACCES"
21218If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21219EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21220file did not exist.
21221
21222
21223.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21224.cindex "ENOTDIR"
21225If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21226ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21227router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21228
21229Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21230router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21231(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21232against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21233is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21234is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21235a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21236that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21237
21238
21239
21240.option include_directory redirect string unset
21241If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21242redirection list must start with this directory.
21243
21244
21245.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21246This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21247&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21248
21249
21250.option one_time redirect boolean false
21251.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21252.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21253.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21254.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21255.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21256Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21257files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21258of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21259is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21260but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21261message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21262lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21263before they subscribed.
21264
21265If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21266deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21267&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21268&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21269attempt.
21270
21271&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21272router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21273reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21274permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21275
21276&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21277to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21278and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21279
21280&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21281&%one_time%&.
21282
21283The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21284addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21285addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21286&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21287typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21288expansion.
21289
21290
21291.option owners redirect "string list" unset
21292.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21293.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21294.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21295.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21296This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21297This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21298See &%check_owner%& above.
21299
21300
21301.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21302This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21303The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21304&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21305
21306
21307.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21308.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21309A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21310starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21311transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21312name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21313When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21314
21315
21316.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21317.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21318If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21319generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21320in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21321expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21322to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21323&$qualify_recipient$&.
21324
21325This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21326but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21327not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21328addresses.
21329
21330.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21331.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21332.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21333.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21334If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21335set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21336without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21337address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21338&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21339this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21340
21341
21342.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21343If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21344any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21345the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21346only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21347&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21348
21349
21350.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21351A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21352&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21353by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21354transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21355are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21356
21357
21358.option rewrite redirect boolean true
21359.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21360If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21361subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21362and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21363
21364
21365.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21366The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21367:subaddress part of an address.
21368
21369.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21370The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21371of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21372(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21373
21374
21375.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21376.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21377To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21378&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21379(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21380&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21381needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21382
21383
21384
21385.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21386.cindex "forward file" "broken"
21387.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21388.cindex "alias file" "broken"
21389.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21390.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21391.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21392.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21393If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21394non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21395&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21396giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21397are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21398&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21399be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21400&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21401
21402If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21403errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21404the following routers.
21405
21406If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21407error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21408taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21409so it is passed to the following routers.
21410
21411.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21412Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21413action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21414&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21415
21416&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21417lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21418option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21419notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21420.code
21421userforward:
21422 driver = redirect
21423 allow_filter
21424 check_local_user
21425 file = $home/.forward
21426 file_transport = address_file
21427 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21428 reply_transport = address_reply
21429 no_verify
21430 skip_syntax_errors
21431 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21432 syntax_errors_text = \
21433 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21434 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21435 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21436 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21437 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21438 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21439 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21440 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21441 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21442 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21443.endd
21444You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21445&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21446put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21447.code
21448real_localuser:
21449 driver = accept
21450 check_local_user
21451 local_part_prefix = real-
21452 transport = local_delivery
21453.endd
21454For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21455router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21456.code
21457 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21458 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21459.endd
21460
21461
21462.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21463See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21464
21465
21466.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21467See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21468.ecindex IIDredrou1
21469.ecindex IIDredrou2
21470
21471
21472
21473
21474
21475
21476. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21477. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21478
21479.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21480 "Environment for local transports"
21481.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21482.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21483.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21484Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21485transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21486in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21487mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21488
21489Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21490some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21491transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21492&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21493
21494The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21495different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21496settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21497or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21498configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21499
21500
21501
21502.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21503.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21504.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21505If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21506simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21507the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21508rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21509time.
21510
21511However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21512locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21513.code
21514my_transport:
21515 driver = pipe
21516 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21517.endd
21518This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21519messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21520&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21521file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21522
21523
21524
21525
21526.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21527.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21528.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21529All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21530overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21531set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21532delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21533group (set by the transport). For example:
21534.code
21535# Routers ...
21536# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21537local_users:
21538 driver = accept
21539 check_local_user
21540 transport = group_delivery
21541
21542# Transports ...
21543# This transport overrides the group
21544group_delivery:
21545 driver = appendfile
21546 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21547 group = mail
21548.endd
21549If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21550address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21551gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21552set.
21553
21554.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21555When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21556function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21557&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21558by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21559for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21560
21561.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21562The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21563is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21564receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21565original gid is also used.
21566
21567This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21568following that is set is used:
21569
21570.ilist
21571A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21572.next
21573A &%group%& setting of the router;
21574.next
21575A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21576&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21577.next
21578The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21579.next
21580In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21581the uid is the creator's uid;
21582.next
21583The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21584.endlist
21585
21586If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21587no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21588This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21589The first of the following that is set is used:
21590
21591.ilist
21592A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21593.next
21594In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21595.next
21596A &%user%& setting of the router;
21597.next
21598A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21599.next
21600The Exim uid.
21601.endlist
21602
21603Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21604&%never_users%& list.
21605
21606
21607
21608
21609
21610.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21611.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21612.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21613.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21614.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21615Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21616the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21617However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21618are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21619for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21620
21621.ilist
21622The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21623.next
21624The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21625.next
21626The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21627.next
21628The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21629.endlist
21630
21631The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21632
21633.ilist
21634The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21635.next
21636The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21637.endlist
21638
21639
21640If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21641value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21642directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21643
21644
21645
21646.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21647.vindex "&$domain$&"
21648.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21649.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21650Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21651variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21652deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21653at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21654other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21655never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21656and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21657.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21658.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21659.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21660
21661
21662
21663
21664
21665
21666
21667. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21668. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21669
21670.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21671.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21672.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21673.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21674The following generic options apply to all transports:
21675
21676
21677.option body_only transports boolean false
21678.cindex "transport" "body only"
21679.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21680.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21681If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21682mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21683or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21684&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21685automatically suppress them.
21686
21687
21688.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21689.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21690This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21691transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21692If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21693logged, and delivery is deferred.
21694
21695
21696.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21697If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21698deliveries by the transport or for any
21699transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21700what you are doing.
21701
21702
21703.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21704.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21705If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21706option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21707transport is run.
21708If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21709output, and Exim carries on processing.
21710This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21711so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21712option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21713variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21714one.
21715The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21716transport and the router that called it.
21717
21718.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21719.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21720If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21721This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21722header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21723requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21724safely be resent to other recipients.
21725
21726
21727.option driver transports string unset
21728This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21729There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21730
21731
21732.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21733.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21734If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21735This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21736delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21737configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21738address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21739header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21740its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21741resent to other recipients.
21742
21743
21744.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21745.cindex events
21746This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21747For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21748
21749
21750.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21751.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21752This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21753value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21754&%user%& (see below).
21755
21756
21757.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21758.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21759.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21760This option specifies a list of text headers,
21761newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21762which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21763portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21764&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21765routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21766is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21767errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21768
21769Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21770for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21771
21772
21773.option headers_only transports boolean false
21774.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21775.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21776.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21777If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21778exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21779transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21780checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21781
21782
21783.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21784.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21785.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21786This option specifies a list of header names,
21787colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21788these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21789in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21790routers.
21791Each list item is separately expanded.
21792If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21793is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21794errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21795
21796Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21797for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21798
21799&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21800items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21801To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21802
21803
21804
21805.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21806.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21807.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21808This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21809that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21810option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21811the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21812message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21813example,
21814.code
21815headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21816 x@y w@z
21817.endd
21818changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21819&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21820header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21821only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21822the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21823filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21824affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21825envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21826change envelope recipients at this time.
21827
21828
21829.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21830.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21831.vindex "&$home$&"
21832This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21833overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21834placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21835used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21836&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21837&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21838for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21839deferred.
21840
21841
21842.option initgroups transports boolean false
21843.cindex "additional groups"
21844.cindex "groups" "additional"
21845.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21846If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21847transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21848to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21849
21850
21851.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21852.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21853.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21854.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21855.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21856If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21857it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21858The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21859
21860.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21861Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21862incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21863is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21864Obviously there is scope for
21865records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21866guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21867
21868If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21869relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21870start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21871may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21872are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21873
21874
21875.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21876.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21877.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21878.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21879This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21880expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21881digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21882including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21883delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21884message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21885the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21886ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21887&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21888delivered.
21889
21890
21891
21892.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21893.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21894.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21895.cindex "local part" "prefix"
21896.cindex "local part" "suffix"
21897When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21898affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21899form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21900that contains
21901.code
21902local_part_prefix = *-
21903.endd
21904routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21905is delivered with
21906.code
21907RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21908.endd
21909This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21910recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21911whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21912deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21913&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21914
21915
21916.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21917.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21918When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21919in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21920is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21921deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21922part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21923temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21924deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21925
21926However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21927as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21928(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21929this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21930
21931For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21932the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21933on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21934
21935
21936.option return_path transports string&!! unset
21937.cindex "envelope sender"
21938.cindex "envelope from"
21939.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21940.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21941If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21942the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21943that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21944designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21945SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21946only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21947header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21948
21949&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21950&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21951
21952.vindex "&$return_path$&"
21953The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21954either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21955&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21956replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21957option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21958section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21959
21960&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21961remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21962the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21963This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21964&%errors_to%& in a router.
21965
21966
21967
21968.option return_path_add transports boolean false
21969.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21970If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21971Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21972mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21973have easy access to it.
21974
21975RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21976the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21977header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21978option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21979incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21980recipients.
21981
21982
21983.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21984See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21985
21986
21987.option shadow_transport transports string unset
21988.cindex "shadow transport"
21989.cindex "transport" "shadow"
21990A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21991another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21992
21993Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21994&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21995string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21996passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21997expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21998cause a log line to be written.
21999
22000The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22001subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22002provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22003is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22004ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22005of the form
22006.code
22007ST=<shadow transport name>
22008.endd
22009If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22010parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22011purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22012provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22013headers that some sites insist on.
22014
22015
22016.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22017.cindex "transport" "filter"
22018.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22019This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22020at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22021individual users or via a system filter.
22022If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22023
22024When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22025&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22026the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22027input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22028command must be specified as an absolute path.
22029
22030The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22031terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22032SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22033lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22034settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22035&(pipe)& transports.
22036
22037The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22038standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22039destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22040filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22041are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22042
22043The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22044care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22045test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22046SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22047
22048.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22049A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22050at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22051message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22052a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22053not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22054
22055.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22056A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22057being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22058support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22059at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22060more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22061the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22062additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22063
22064.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22065The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22066the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22067parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22068Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22069section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22070to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22071of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22072an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22073&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22074
22075.vindex "&$host$&"
22076.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22077The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22078transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22079which the message is being sent. For example:
22080.code
22081transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22082 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22083.endd
22084
22085Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22086generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22087command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22088.ilist
22089If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22090part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22091expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22092example:
22093.code
22094transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22095.endd
22096This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22097&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22098stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22099the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22100&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22101Exim tried to expand the first one.
22102.next
22103Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22104expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22105arguments. Consider this example:
22106.code
22107transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22108 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22109.endd
22110The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22111if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22112.code
22113transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22114 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22115.endd
22116.endlist
22117
22118The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22119For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22120normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22121A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22122serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22123the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22124bounced from a transport filter.
22125
22126If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22127passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22128message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22129
22130
22131.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22132.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22133When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22134that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22135temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22136&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22137way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22138error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22139becomes a temporary error.
22140
22141
22142.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22143.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22144.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22145This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22146run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22147given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22148associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22149option is not set.
22150
22151For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22152specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22153&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22154
22155.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22156For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22157sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22158to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22159retry data.
22160.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22161.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22162.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22163
22164
22165
22166
22167
22168
22169. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22171
22172.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22173 "Address batching"
22174.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22175The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22176one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22177remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22178normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22179transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22180copy of the message is delivered each time.
22181
22182.cindex "batched local delivery"
22183.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22184.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22185In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22186local transport, for example:
22187
22188.ilist
22189In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22190delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22191recipients saves space.
22192.next
22193In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22194a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22195.next
22196In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22197to a scanner program or
22198to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22199acceptable.
22200.endlist
22201
22202These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22203(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22204repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22205
22206The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22207delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22208(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22209&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22210(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22211to certain conditions:
22212
22213.ilist
22214.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22215If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22216batching is possible.
22217.next
22218.vindex "&$domain$&"
22219If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22220addresses with the same domain are batched.
22221.next
22222.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22223If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22224addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22225customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22226including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22227from taking place.
22228.next
22229Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22230delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22231group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22232be the same.
22233.endlist
22234
22235In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22236both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22237is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22238course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22239option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22240&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22241&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22242.code
22243check_string = "."
22244escape_string = ".."
22245.endd
22246when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22247given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22248&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22249
22250.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22251If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22252&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22253that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22254transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22255addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22256
22257.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22258.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22259If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22260transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22261the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22262of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22263argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22264delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22265are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22266
22267
22268
22269
22270. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22271. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22272
22273.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22274.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22275.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22276.cindex "directory creation"
22277.cindex "creating directories"
22278The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22279file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22280files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22281format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22282University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22283being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22284to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22285delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22286supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22287directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22288
22289The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22290default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22291SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22292included.
22293
22294.cindex "quota" "system"
22295Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22296also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22297system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22298
22299If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22300partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22301modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22302creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22303
22304Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22305file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22306private options.
22307
22308The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22309users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22310putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22311&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22312option).
22313
22314
22315
22316.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22317The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22318the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22319the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22320normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22321
22322.vindex "&$address_file$&"
22323.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22324However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22325directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22326forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22327user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22328the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22329name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22330operation. There are two cases:
22331
22332.ilist
22333If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22334must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22335common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22336different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22337default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22338name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22339&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22340.next
22341If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22342used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22343contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22344.endlist
22345
22346
22347.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22348.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22349As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22350have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22351form:
22352.code
22353save folder23
22354.endd
22355or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22356.code
22357require "fileinto";
22358fileinto "folder23";
22359.endd
22360In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22361must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22362case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22363is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22364way of handling this requirement:
22365.code
22366file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22367 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22368 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22369 {$address_file} \
22370 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22371 }} \
22372 }
22373.endd
22374With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22375location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22376&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22377
22378&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22379&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22380the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22381you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22382&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22383path to the transport.
22384
22385&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22386the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22387
22388
22389
22390
22391.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22392.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22393
22394
22395
22396.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22397.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22398.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22399.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22400Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22401regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22402delivery is deferred.
22403
22404
22405.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22406.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22407.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22408By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22409that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22410are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22411what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22412are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22413
22414
22415.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22416See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22417However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22418happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22419file.
22420
22421
22422.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22423See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22424
22425
22426.option check_group appendfile boolean false
22427When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22428option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22429delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22430file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22431
22432
22433.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22434When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22435is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22436process is running.
22437
22438
22439.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22440.cindex "&""From""& line"
22441As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22442matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22443replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22444a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22445contains is significant.
22446
22447If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22448are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22449configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22450&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22451&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22452
22453The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22454suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22455&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22456if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22457.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22458.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22459.code
22460check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22461escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22462message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22463message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22464.endd
22465.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22466.cindex "directory creation"
22467When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22468directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22469is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22470
22471The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22472operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22473example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22474is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22475in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22476
22477
22478
22479.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22480This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22481by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22482directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22483delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22484beneath.
22485
22486The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22487&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22488set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22489given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22490are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22491by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22492&%file_must_exist%&.
22493
22494
22495.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22496This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22497or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22498redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22499
22500When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22501into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22502appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22503(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22504&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22505
22506
22507.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22508.cindex "base62"
22509.vindex "&$inode$&"
22510When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22511&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22512whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22513.code
22514q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22515.endd
22516This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22517inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22518option.
22519
22520
22521.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22522If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22523&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22524
22525
22526.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22527See &%check_string%& above.
22528
22529
22530.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22531This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22532&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22533of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22534specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22535&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22536&%file%&.
22537
22538.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22539.cindex "locking files"
22540.cindex "lock files"
22541If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22542mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22543
22544The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22545path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22546examples:
22547.code
22548file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22549file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22550file = $home/inbox
22551.endd
22552.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22553In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22554is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22555create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22556deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22557run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22558
22559
22560
22561.option file_format appendfile string unset
22562.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22563This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22564before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22565start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22566colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22567second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22568string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22569transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22570this added to it:
22571.code
22572file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22573 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22574.endd
22575Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22576a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22577to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22578to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22579is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22580match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22581delivery is deferred.
22582
22583
22584.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22585If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22586A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22587If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22588
22589
22590.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22591.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22592.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22593.cindex "locking files"
22594By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22595when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22596sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22597Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22598for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22599deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22600mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22601misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22602
22603On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22604not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22605is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22606and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22607
22608If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22609timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22610retries is
22611.code
22612(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22613.endd
22614rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22615which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22616&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22617
22618You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22619local deliveries because of errors of the form
22620.code
22621failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22622.endd
22623
22624.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22625This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22626&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22627&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22628
22629
22630.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22631This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22632for details of locking.
22633
22634
22635.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22636This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22637is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22638
22639
22640.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22641This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22642used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22643
22644
22645.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22646.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22647When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22648exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22649accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22650
22651
22652.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22653.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22654.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22655If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22656number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22657followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22658external source that maintains the data.
22659
22660
22661.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22662.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22663.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22664If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22665size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22666This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22667maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22668it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22669
22670
22671
22672.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22673.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22674If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22675file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22676transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22677&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22678&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22679directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22680SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22681&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22682
22683
22684.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22685.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22686.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22687This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22688a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22689directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22690calculation. The default value is:
22691.code
22692maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22693.endd
22694This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22695(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22696&_Trash_&
22697folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22698.code
22699maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22700.endd
22701This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22702directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22703calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22704directly into that directory.
22705
22706
22707.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22708This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22709&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22710
22711
22712.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22713This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22714section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22715
22716
22717.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22718.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22719The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22720If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22721creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22722quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22723value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22724&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22725
22726.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22727.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22728.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22729The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22730effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22731matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22732containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22733delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22734&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22735See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22736
22737
22738.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22739.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22740If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22741new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22742SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22743below for further details.
22744
22745
22746.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22747This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22748section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22749
22750
22751.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22752This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22753section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22754
22755
22756.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22757.cindex "locking files"
22758.cindex "file" "locking"
22759.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22760.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22761This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22762set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22763the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22764traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22765IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22766
22767&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22768automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22769empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22770combination:
22771.code
22772mbx_format = true
22773message_prefix =
22774message_suffix =
22775.endd
22776If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22777&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22778is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22779&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22780interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22781should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22782going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22783mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22784
22785If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22786the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22787(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22788append messages to it.
22789
22790
22791.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22792.cindex "&""From""& line"
22793The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22794The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22795in which case it is:
22796.code
22797message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22798 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22799.endd
22800&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22801&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22802
22803.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22804The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22805The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22806in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22807setting
22808.code
22809message_suffix =
22810.endd
22811&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22812&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22813
22814.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22815If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22816has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22817permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22818if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22819a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22820value, and this option is ignored.
22821
22822
22823.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22824This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22825mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22826true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22827continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22828
22829
22830.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22831If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22832successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22833on users about incoming mail.
22834
22835
22836.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22837.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22838This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22839or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22840is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22841all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22842individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22843&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22844have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22845
22846As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22847multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22848For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22849
22850A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22851may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22852If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22853become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22854Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22855the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22856
22857The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22858(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22859for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22860and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22861large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22862be handled.
22863
22864The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22865quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22866
22867&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22868
22869The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22870the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22871be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22872fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22873system quota failures.
22874
22875By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22876mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22877last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22878during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22879refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22880message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22881changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22882for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22883continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22884delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22885
22886
22887.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22888This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22889into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22890called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22891delivery directory.
22892
22893
22894.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22895This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22896number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22897can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22898failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22899&"no quota"&.
22900
22901The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22902quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22903
22904.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22905See &%quota%& above.
22906
22907
22908.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22909This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22910for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22911these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22912If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22913captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22914file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22915
22916This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22917&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22918facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22919the file length to the filename. For example:
22920.code
22921maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22922quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22923.endd
22924An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22925number of lines in the message.
22926
22927The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22928filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22929sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22930
22931Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22932
22933.new
22934This option should not be used when other message-handling software
22935may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
22936will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
22937disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
22938a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
22939as is used to adjust the effective size.
22940.wen
22941
22942
22943.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22944See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22945&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22946.code
22947quota_warn_message = "\
22948 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22949 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22950 This message is automatically created \
22951 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22952 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22953 a warning threshold that is\n\
22954 set by the system administrator.\n"
22955.endd
22956
22957
22958.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22959.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22960.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22961.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22962This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22963resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22964size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22965threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22966may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22967sign. For example:
22968.code
22969quota = 10M
22970quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22971.endd
22972If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22973percent sign is ignored.
22974
22975The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22976and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22977warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22978the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22979can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22980&'From:'& line, the default is:
22981.code
22982From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22983.endd
22984.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22985If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22986option.
22987
22988The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22989are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22990percentage.
22991
22992
22993.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22994.cindex "envelope from"
22995.cindex "envelope sender"
22996If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22997format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22998you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22999so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23000for details of batch SMTP.
23001
23002
23003.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23004.cindex "carriage return"
23005.cindex "linefeed"
23006This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23007(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23008of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23009of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23010
23011&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23012(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23013in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23014carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23015have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23016changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23017
23018
23019.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23020This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23021exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23022&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23023that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23024&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23025
23026
23027.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23028This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23029the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23030&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23031each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23032
23033This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23034&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23035where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23036both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23037
23038.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23039Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23040have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23041&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23042the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23043error.
23044
23045&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23046is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23047
23048
23049.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23050If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23051appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23052&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23053sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23054&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23055delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23056
23057.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23058In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23059necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23060achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23061file corruption.
23062
23063The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23064It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23065except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23066
23067
23068.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23069This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23070set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23071locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23072of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23073are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23074the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23075rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23076does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23077
23078You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23079&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23080MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23081without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23082
23083
23084
23085
23086.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23087.cindex "appending to a file"
23088.cindex "file" "appending"
23089Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23090
23091.ilist
23092If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23093return is given.
23094
23095.next
23096.cindex "directory creation"
23097If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23098&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23099&%directory_mode%& option.
23100
23101.next
23102If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23103indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23104transport.
23105
23106.next
23107.cindex "file" "locking"
23108.cindex "locking files"
23109.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23110If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23111reliably over NFS, as follows:
23112
23113.olist
23114Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23115current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23116as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23117.next
23118Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23119.next
23120If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23121Unlink the hitching post name.
23122.next
23123Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23124then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23125of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23126restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23127.next
23128If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23129up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23130mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23131lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23132existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23133it before trying again.
23134.endlist olist
23135
23136.next
23137A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23138so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23139than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23140
23141.next
23142.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23143.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23144If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23145&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23146checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23147is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23148ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23149directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23150idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23151checked.
23152
23153.next
23154If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23155and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23156different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23157delivery is deferred.
23158
23159.next
23160If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23161If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23162is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23163permissions.
23164
23165.next
23166The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23167If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23168hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23169
23170.next
23171If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23172changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23173have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23174
23175.next
23176If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23177option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23178directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23179open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23180except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23181set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23182the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23183that prevents link following.
23184
23185.next
23186.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23187If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23188existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23189being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23190after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23191
23192.next
23193If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23194
23195.next
23196.cindex "file" "locking"
23197.cindex "locking files"
23198Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23199are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23200&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23201However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23202file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23203.code
23204/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23205.endd
23206using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23207the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23208the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23209
23210If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23211depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23212&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23213
23214If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23215&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23216to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23217delivery is deferred.
23218
23219If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23220&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23221waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23222immediately. It retries up to
23223.code
23224(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23225.endd
23226times (rounded up).
23227.endlist
23228
23229At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23230and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23231
23232
23233.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23234.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23235.cindex "&""From""& line"
23236When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23237delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23238activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23239&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23240router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23241configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23242ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23243
23244No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23245locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23246separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23247of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23248newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23249&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23250any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23251
23252If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23253the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23254different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23255deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23256
23257
23258.cindex "maildir format"
23259.cindex "mailstore format"
23260There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23261done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23262&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23263formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23264SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23265
23266.cindex "directory creation"
23267In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23268sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23269option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23270constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23271the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23272&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23273deferred.
23274
23275
23276
23277.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23278.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23279If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23280it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23281directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23282directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23283&_new_& subdirectory.
23284
23285In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23286<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23287Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23288before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23289filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23290opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23291Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23292
23293Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23294called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23295do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23296path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23297&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23298contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23299&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23300&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23301
23302These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23303and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23304folders. Consider this example:
23305.code
23306maildir_format = true
23307directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23308 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23309 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23310maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23311.endd
23312If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23313delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23314the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23315not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23316&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23317&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23318
23319However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23320delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23321does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23322&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23323directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23324
23325&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23326not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23327&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23328
23329.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23330.cindex "maildir++"
23331If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23332&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23333the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23334Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23335down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23336the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23337amount of space used.
23338
23339One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23340computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23341checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23342needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23343use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23344of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23345
23346
23347
23348
23349.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23350If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23351When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23352tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23353name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23354the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23355
23356
23357.vindex "&$message_size$&"
23358Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23359&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23360happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23361variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23362forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23363be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23364Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23365empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23366colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23367maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23368backwards compatibility).
23369
23370For one common implementation, you might set:
23371.code
23372maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23373.endd
23374but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23375
23376It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23377as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23378&[stat()]& each message file.
23379
23380
23381.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23382.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23383.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23384If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23385storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23386within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23387creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23388the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23389to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23390
23391The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23392messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23393in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23394value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23395is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23396need to know the quota.
23397
23398If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23399file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23400
23401A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23402maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23403See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23404details.
23405
23406
23407.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23408.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23409If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23410files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23411message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23412this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23413contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23414itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23415
23416During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23417&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23418&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23419mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23420file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23421the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23422
23423The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23424option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23425the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23426There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23427greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23428appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23429
23430If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23431failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23432configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23433&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23434
23435
23436.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23437If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23438file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23439messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23440section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23441.code
23442directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23443.endd
23444might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23445then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23446expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23447.ecindex IIDapptra1
23448.ecindex IIDapptra2
23449
23450
23451
23452
23453
23454
23455. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23456. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23457
23458.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23459.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23460.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23461The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23462the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23463automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23464&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23465to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23466
23467If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23468&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23469delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23470that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23471another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23472
23473
23474The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23475&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23476directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23477message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23478empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23479
23480The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23481by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23482passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23483transport is run as a consequence of a
23484&%mail%&
23485or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23486supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23487that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23488case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23489is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23490&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23491
23492&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23493command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23494gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23495&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23496
23497There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23498that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23499&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23500address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23501separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23502the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23503message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23504
23505Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23506message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23507immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23508the transport defers.
23509Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23510controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23511
23512If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23513&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23514of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23515&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23516
23517.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23518If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23519the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23520as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23521is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23522problems. They are just discarded.
23523
23524
23525
23526.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23527.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23528
23529.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23530This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23531message when the message is specified by the transport.
23532
23533
23534.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23535This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23536when the message is specified by the transport.
23537
23538
23539.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23540The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23541is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23542string comes first.
23543
23544
23545.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23546If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23547subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23548
23549
23550.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23551If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23552option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23553
23554
23555.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23556This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23557specified by the transport.
23558
23559
23560.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23561This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23562when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23563&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23564
23565
23566.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23567This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23568the message is specified by the transport.
23569
23570
23571.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23572If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23573used.
23574
23575
23576.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23577If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23578item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23579discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23580generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23581
23582
23583
23584.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23585This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23586recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23587This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23588
23589If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23590By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23591is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23592However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23593message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23594this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23595prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23596infinity.
23597
23598If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23599and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23600greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23601Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23602regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23603
23604In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23605which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23606be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23607means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23608unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23609file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23610
23611
23612.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23613See &%once%& above.
23614
23615
23616.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23617See &%once%& above.
23618After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23619
23620
23621.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23622This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23623specified by the transport.
23624
23625
23626.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23627If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23628message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23629configuration option.
23630
23631
23632.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23633This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23634specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23635automatic responses. For example:
23636.code
23637subject = Re: $h_subject:
23638.endd
23639There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23640subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23641bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23642non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23643small.
23644
23645
23646
23647.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23648This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23649message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23650the text comes first.
23651
23652
23653.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23654This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23655when the message is specified by the transport.
23656.ecindex IIDauttra1
23657.ecindex IIDauttra2
23658
23659
23660
23661
23662. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23663. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23664
23665.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23666.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23667.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23668.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23669.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23670The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23671specified command
23672or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23673This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23674transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23675implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23676to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23677has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23678.code
23679TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23680.endd
23681.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23682is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23683included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23684as follows:
23685
23686.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23687See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23688
23689
23690.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23691This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23692Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23693good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23694batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23695
23696
23697.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23698This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23699is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23700arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23701number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23702is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23703LMTP protocol.
23704
23705.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23706.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23707If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23708commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23709in its response to the LHLO command.
23710
23711.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23712This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23713be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23714delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23715
23716
23717.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23718The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23719respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23720is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23721LMTP transport:
23722.code
23723lmtp:
23724 driver = lmtp
23725 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23726 batch_max = 20
23727 user = exim
23728.endd
23729This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23730necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23731
23732
23733
23734. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23735. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23736
23737.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23738.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23739.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23740The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23741running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23742pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23743(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23744their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23745following ways:
23746
23747.ilist
23748.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23749A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23750transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23751contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23752is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23753.next
23754.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23755If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23756transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23757more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23758(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23759(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23760that are routed to the transport.
23761.next
23762.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23763A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23764alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23765pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23766&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23767(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23768this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23769.endlist
23770
23771
23772The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23773deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23774implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23775
23776In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23777&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23778other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23779transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23780directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23781details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23782for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23783
23784
23785.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23786If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23787delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23788any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23789write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23790Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23791of "1" to enforce serialization.
23792
23793
23794
23795
23796.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23797.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23798If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23799have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23800the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23801in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23802later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23803logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23804&"local delivery failed"&.
23805
23806If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23807the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23808will be sent as normal.
23809
23810If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23811script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23812value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23813apply in this case.
23814
23815If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23816return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23817asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23818a non-existent command may be the problem.
23819
23820The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23821set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23822error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23823return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23824included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23825similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23826failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23827&%temp_errors%&.
23828
23829
23830
23831.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23832.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23833The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23834by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23835&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23836run.
23837
23838.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23839Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23840double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23841way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23842
23843String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23844traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23845expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23846For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23847quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23848.code
23849command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23850.endd
23851will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23852arguments. You have to write
23853.code
23854command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23855.endd
23856to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23857argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23858result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23859interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23860generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23861expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23862example:
23863.code
23864command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23865.endd
23866
23867.cindex "transport" "filter"
23868.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23869.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23870Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23871&`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23872This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23873place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23874transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23875inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23876avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23877&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23878
23879If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23880for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23881is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23882argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23883&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23884the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23885should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23886run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23887
23888After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23889in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23890message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23891standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23892read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23893may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23894control what is done with it.
23895
23896Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23897in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23898taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23899explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23900where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23901under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23902an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23903works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23904as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23905&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23906with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23907
23908
23909
23910.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23911.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23912.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23913The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23914This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23915the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23916environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23917to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23918.display
23919&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23920&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23921&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23922&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23923&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23924&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23925&`LOGNAME `& see below
23926&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23927&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23928&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23929&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23930&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23931&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23932&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23933&`USER `& see below
23934.endd
23935When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23936router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23937called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23938the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23939removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23940LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23941same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23942
23943.cindex "HOST"
23944HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23945associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23946pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23947the router.
23948
23949.cindex "HOME"
23950If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23951for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23952by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23953user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23954
23955
23956.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23957.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23958
23959
23960
23961.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23962.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23963The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23964permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23965permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23966paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23967&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23968in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23969the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23970&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23971otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23972example, if
23973.code
23974allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23975.endd
23976and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23977&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23978&%use_shell%& is set.
23979
23980
23981.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23982See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23983
23984
23985.option batch_max pipe integer 1
23986This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23987See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23988
23989
23990.option check_string pipe string unset
23991As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23992&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23993by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23994&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23995any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23996of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23997the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23998ignored.
23999
24000
24001.option command pipe string&!! unset
24002This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24003obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24004set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24005the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24006Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24007&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24008
24009
24010.option environment pipe string&!! unset
24011.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24012.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24013This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24014command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24015a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24016environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24017
24018
24019.option escape_string pipe string unset
24020See &%check_string%& above.
24021
24022
24023.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24024.cindex "exec failure"
24025.cindex "failure of exec"
24026.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24027Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24028any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24029is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24030frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24031
24032
24033.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24034.cindex "signal exit"
24035.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24036Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24037a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24038frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24039
24040
24041.option force_command pipe boolean false
24042.cindex "force command"
24043.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24044Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24045the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24046is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24047useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24048command. For example:
24049.code
24050command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24051force_command
24052.endd
24053
24054Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24055&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24056separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24057
24058
24059.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24060If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24061run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24062Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24063from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24064&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24065
24066&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24067See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24068
24069
24070.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24071.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24072If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24073one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24074and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24075written to the main log.
24076
24077
24078.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24079If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24080stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24081the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24082failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24083option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24084be set.
24085
24086
24087.option log_output pipe boolean false
24088If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24089stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24090the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24091exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24092
24093
24094.option max_output pipe integer 20K
24095This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24096standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24097process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24098catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24099the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24100&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24101exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24102
24103
24104.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24105The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24106The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24107.code
24108message_prefix = \
24109 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24110 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24111.endd
24112.cindex "Cyrus"
24113.cindex "&%tmail%&"
24114.cindex "&""From""& line"
24115This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24116However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24117or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24118setting
24119.code
24120message_prefix =
24121.endd
24122&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24123&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24124
24125
24126.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24127The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24128The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24129The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24130.code
24131message_suffix =
24132.endd
24133&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24134&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24135
24136
24137.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24138This option is expanded and
24139specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24140variable of the subprocess.
24141If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24142sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24143apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24144
24145
24146.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24147Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24148a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24149during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24150It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24151for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24152resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24153installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24154of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24155
24156
24157.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24158.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24159If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24160process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24161to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24162&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24163accept the message is used.
24164
24165
24166.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24167When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24168contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24169in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24170command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24171handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24172
24173
24174.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24175If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24176return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24177is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24178However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24179message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24180&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24181
24182
24183
24184.option return_output pipe boolean false
24185If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24186deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24187is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24188However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24189output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24190option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24191of them may be set.
24192
24193
24194
24195.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24196.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24197This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24198asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24199and &%return_output%& is not set,
24200and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24201temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24202numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24203codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24204defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24205compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24206and 73, respectively.
24207
24208
24209.option timeout pipe time 1h
24210If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24211causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24212specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24213command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24214and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24215if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24216
24217.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24218A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24219runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24220treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24221is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24222delivery to be deferred.
24223
24224.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24225This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24226
24227
24228.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24229.cindex "envelope sender"
24230If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24231SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24232commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24233you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24234&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24235
24236.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24237.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24238This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24239BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24240resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24241limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24242class database.
24243
24244
24245.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24246.cindex "carriage return"
24247.cindex "linefeed"
24248This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24249(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24250of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24251of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24252
24253The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24254written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24255are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24256&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24257values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24258
24259
24260.option use_shell pipe boolean false
24261.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24262If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24263instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24264&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24265where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24266modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24267&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24268command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24269its &%-c%& option.
24270
24271
24272
24273.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24274.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24275.cindex "&'procmail'&"
24276.cindex "external local delivery"
24277.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24278.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24279The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24280delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24281this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24282uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24283by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24284necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24285appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24286configuration for &%procmail%&:
24287.code
24288# transport
24289procmail_pipe:
24290 driver = pipe
24291 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24292 return_path_add
24293 delivery_date_add
24294 envelope_to_add
24295 check_string = "From "
24296 escape_string = ">From "
24297 umask = 077
24298 user = $local_part
24299 group = mail
24300
24301# router
24302procmail:
24303 driver = accept
24304 check_local_user
24305 transport = procmail_pipe
24306.endd
24307In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24308&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24309or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24310user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24311&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24312home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24313
24314&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24315.code
24316IFS=" "
24317.endd
24318as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24319use a shell to run pipe commands.
24320
24321.cindex "Cyrus"
24322The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24323deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24324.code
24325# transport
24326local_delivery_cyrus:
24327 driver = pipe
24328 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24329 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24330 user = cyrus
24331 group = mail
24332 return_output
24333 log_output
24334 message_prefix =
24335 message_suffix =
24336
24337# router
24338local_user_cyrus:
24339 driver = accept
24340 check_local_user
24341 local_part_suffix = .*
24342 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24343.endd
24344Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24345&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24346sender.
24347.ecindex IIDpiptra1
24348.ecindex IIDpiptra2
24349
24350
24351. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24352. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24353
24354.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24355.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24356.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24357The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24358or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24359that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24360explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24361&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24362
24363
24364.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24365The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24366two ways:
24367
24368.ilist
24369If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24370routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24371that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24372the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24373does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24374value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24375section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24376.next
24377.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24378When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24379looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24380connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24381for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24382process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24383process.
24384.endlist
24385
24386
24387For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24388incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24389no further messages are sent over that connection.
24390
24391
24392
24393.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24394.vindex "&$host$&"
24395.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24396At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24397&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24398passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24399specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24400&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24401that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24402&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24403
24404
24405.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24406.vindex &$tls_bits$&
24407.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24408.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24409.vindex &$tls_sni$&
24410At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24411&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24412are the values that were set when the message was received.
24413These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24414SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24415variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24416appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24417are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24418&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24419
24420These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24421and will be removed in a future release.
24422
24423
24424.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24425.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24426The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24427
24428
24429.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24430.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24431When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24432is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24433runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24434reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24435setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24436problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24437
24438.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24439.cindex "local host" "sending to"
24440.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24441When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24442to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24443deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24444the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24445configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24446configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24447
24448
24449.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24450.cindex "Cyrus"
24451When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24452is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24453overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24454forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24455to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24456ignored.
24457
24458The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24459started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24460&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24461particular connection.
24462
24463If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24464&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24465deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24466unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24467
24468This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24469deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24470&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24471.code
24472authenticated_sender = $local_part
24473.endd
24474This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24475allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24476
24477Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24478domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24479value.
24480
24481
24482.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24483If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24484is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24485authenticated as a client.
24486
24487
24488.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24489This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24490sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24491remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24492
24493
24494.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24495This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24496to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24497several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24498less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24499systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24500option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24501
24502
24503.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24504.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24505.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24506.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24507This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24508over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24509For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24510option.
24511
24512
24513.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24514.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24515.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24516.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24517This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24518where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24519If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24520Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24521configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24522been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24523TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24524counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24525If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24526be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24527
24528
24529.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24530This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24531the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24532of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24533
24534
24535.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24536DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24537.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24538DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24539.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24540DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24541.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24542DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24543.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24544DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24545.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24546DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24547.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24548DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24549.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24550DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24551.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24552DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24553
24554
24555.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24556.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24557.cindex retry "final cutoff"
24558This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24559domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24560cutoff times.
24561
24562In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24563them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24564Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24565retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24566a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24567unhappy at this prospect, so...
24568
24569If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24570addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24571IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24572none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24573delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24574addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24575continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24576&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24577to them.
24578
24579
24580.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24581If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24582and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24583the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24584in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24585
24586
24587.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24588If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24589&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24590See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24591details.
24592
24593
24594.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24595.cindex "MX record" "security"
24596.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24597.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24598.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24599DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24600the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24601transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24602router option.
24603
24604
24605
24606.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24607.cindex "MX record" "security"
24608.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24609.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24610.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24611DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24612the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24613useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24614&%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24615
24616
24617
24618.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24619.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24620This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24621of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24622The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24623Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24624&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24625
24626The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24627(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24628that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24629equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24630Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24631
24632
24633.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24634.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24635String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24636colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24637port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24638&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24639item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24640in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24641
24642Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24643addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24644&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24645not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24646&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24647However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24648
24649If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24650the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24651transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24652address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24653list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24654
24655Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24656re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24657addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24658copy of the message is sent.
24659
24660The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24661&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24662both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24663from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24664fails"& facility.
24665
24666
24667.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24668This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24669line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24670zero.
24671
24672.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24673If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24674being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24675(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24676instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24677it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24678
24679.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24680This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24681server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24682implementations of TLS.
24683
24684.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24685.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24686.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24687.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24688The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24689been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24690command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24691option is:
24692.code
24693$primary_hostname
24694.endd
24695During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24696the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24697&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24698used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24699servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24700that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24701interface address, you could use this:
24702.code
24703helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24704 {$primary_hostname}}
24705.endd
24706The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24707callouts.
24708
24709.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24710Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24711finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24712&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24713email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24714all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24715
24716The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24717processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24718&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24719&%hosts_override%& is set.
24720
24721The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24722list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24723separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24724&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24725item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24726in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24727of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24728
24729If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24730the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24731well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24732address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24733&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24734&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24735that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24736address are used.
24737
24738During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24739unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24740
24741
24742.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24743.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24744.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24745.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24746.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24747This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24748example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24749matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24750start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24751facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24752
24753
24754.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24755.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24756Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24757that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24758
24759.new
24760.option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24761.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24762.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24763If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24764this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24765and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24766
24767The retry hints database is used for the record,
24768and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24769When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24770It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24771so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24772
24773See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
24774
24775Note:
24776When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24777will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24778is filled in.
24779A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24780presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24781can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24782You have been warned.
24783.wen
24784
24785
24786.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24787.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24788Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24789matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24790
24791.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24792.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24793Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24794or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24795to any host that matches this list.
24796
24797
24798.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24799.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24800.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24801.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24802.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24803This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24804delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24805&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24806
24807
24808.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24809This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24810tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24811why it exists.
24812
24813
24814
24815.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24816.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24817.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24818.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24819For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24820been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24821message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24822explanation of when this might be needed.
24823
24824.new
24825.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24826.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24827.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24828.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24829For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24830been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24831message on the same session.
24832.wen
24833
24834The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24835process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24836sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24837instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24838the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24839The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24840logging.
24841
24842
24843
24844.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24845If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24846attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24847&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24848&%fallback_hosts%&.
24849
24850
24851.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24852.cindex "randomized host list"
24853.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24854.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24855If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24856&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24857were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24858router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24859is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24860list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24861
24862When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24863order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24864behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24865&`+`& in the host list. For example:
24866.code
24867hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24868.endd
24869The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24870randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24871If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24872
24873.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24874.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24875This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24876before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24877servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24878authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24879temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24880hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24881&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24882
24883
24884.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24885.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24886Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24887TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24888&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24889
24890.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24891.cindex DANE "transport options"
24892.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24893If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24894TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24895and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24896the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24897There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24898See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24899
24900.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24901.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24902Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24903TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24904&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24905
24906.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24907.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24908Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24909matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24910&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24911incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24912
24913.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24914.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24915This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24916authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24917connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24918unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24919&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24920
24921.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24922.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24923.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24924.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24925This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24926CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24927BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24928
24929.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24930.cindex DANE "transport options"
24931.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24932If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24933TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24934and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24935the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24936There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24937See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24938
24939.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24940.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24941.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24942.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24943This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24944the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24945perform a TCP Fast Open.
24946No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24947supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24948the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24949
24950The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24951as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24952
24953On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24954in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24955There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24956it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24957such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24958
24959.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24960.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24961This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24962PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24963for multi-recipient messages.
24964The option can usually be left as default.
24965
24966.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24967.cindex "bind IP address"
24968.cindex "IP address" "binding"
24969.vindex "&$host$&"
24970.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24971This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24972call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24973&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24974message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24975&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24976outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24977interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24978unknown.
24979
24980During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24981&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24982during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24983string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24984string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24985separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24986For example:
24987.code
24988interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24989.endd
24990The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24991connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24992&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24993interface to use if the host has more than one.
24994
24995
24996.option keepalive smtp boolean true
24997.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24998This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24999connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25000periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25001of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25002or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25003that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25004that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25005TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25006unreachable hosts.
25007
25008
25009.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25010.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25011If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25012string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25013has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25014
25015.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25016.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25017This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25018SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25019so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25020permits this.
25021
25022
25023.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25024.vindex "&$domain$&"
25025When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25026addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25027to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25028handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25029&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25030is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25031
25032It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25033&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25034&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25035
25036.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25037.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25038.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25039This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25040&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25041received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25042The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25043variable that contains an outgoing port.
25044
25045If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25046otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25047normally &"smtp"&,
25048but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25049and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25050If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25051is deferred.
25052
25053Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25054to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25055
25056
25057
25058.option protocol smtp string smtp
25059.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25060.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25061.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25062.vindex "&$port$&"
25063If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25064the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25065protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25066deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25067over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25068
25069If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25070changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25071connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25072The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25073but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25074(as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25075
25076
25077.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25078Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25079constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25080means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25081tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25082addresses is not affected.
25083
25084However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25085each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25086the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25087Exim to use only the host name.
25088Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25089
25090
25091.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25092.cindex "serializing connections"
25093.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25094Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25095host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25096the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25097slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25098Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25099&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25100
25101.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25102Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25103written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25104is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25105records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25106guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25107
25108If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25109relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25110start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25111may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25112are used for ETRN serialization.
25113
25114See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25115
25116
25117.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25118.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25119.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25120.cindex "size" "of message"
25121.cindex "transport" "filter"
25122.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25123If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25124MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25125an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25126sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25127configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25128this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25129
25130Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25131the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25132
25133
25134.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25135.cindex proxy SOCKS
25136This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25137transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25138
25139
25140.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25141.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25142.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25143.vindex "&$host$&"
25144.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25145The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25146client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25147connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25148address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25149details of TLS.
25150
25151&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25152certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25153name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25154assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25155client.
25156
25157
25158.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25159.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25160.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25161This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25162be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25163
25164
25165.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25166.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25167When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25168key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25169for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25170If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25171will fail.
25172
25173Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25174
25175
25176.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25177.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25178.vindex "&$host$&"
25179.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25180The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25181client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25182connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25183&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25184expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25185result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25186the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25187
25188
25189.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25190.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25191.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25192.vindex "&$host$&"
25193.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25194The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25195when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25196the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25197&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25198expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25199is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25200&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25201ciphers is a preference order.
25202
25203
25204
25205.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25206.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25207.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25208If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25209TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25210the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25211certificate and private key for the session.
25212
25213See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25214
25215Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25216TLS extensions.
25217
25218
25219
25220
25221.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25222.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25223When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25224setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25225to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25226current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25227option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25228response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25229TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25230unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25231in clear.
25232
25233
25234.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25235.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25236.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25237This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25238certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25239The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25240Note that unless the host is in this list
25241TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25242when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25243The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25244certificate verification succeeds.
25245
25246
25247.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25248.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25249.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25250This option give a list of hosts for which,
25251while verifying the server certificate,
25252checks will be included on the host name
25253(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25254versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25255limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25256
25257There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25258
25259
25260.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25261.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25262.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25263.vindex "&$host$&"
25264.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25265The value of this option must be either the
25266word "system"
25267or the absolute path to
25268a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25269for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25270
25271The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25272This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25273is taken as empty and an explicit location
25274must be specified.
25275
25276The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25277preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25278
25279With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25280explicitly
25281either by file or directory
25282are added to those given by the system default location.
25283
25284The values of &$host$& and
25285&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25286expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25287
25288For back-compatibility,
25289if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25290(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25291and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25292
25293
25294.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25295.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25296.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25297This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25298certificate verification must succeed.
25299The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25300If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25301operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25302
25303.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25304.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25305.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25306If built with internationalization support,
25307this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25308to a-label form.
25309For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25310
25311
25312
25313
25314.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25315 "SECTvalhosmax"
25316.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25317.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25318There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25319tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25320&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25321
25322
25323The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25324for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25325option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25326multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25327retrying.
25328
25329Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25330multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25331created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25332
25333Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25334several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25335problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25336&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25337delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25338
25339Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25340arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25341limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25342some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25343&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25344that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25345see below for an exception).
25346
25347Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25348list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25349If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25350but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25351that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25352
25353Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25354higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25355hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25356which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25357tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25358reached their retry times.
25359
25360However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25361large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25362Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25363of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25364time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25365without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25366all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25367there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25368the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25369every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25370reached.
25371
25372The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25373particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25374out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25375reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25376been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25377take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25378
25379The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25380Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25381and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25382possible IP addresses have been tried.
25383.ecindex IIDsmttra1
25384.ecindex IIDsmttra2
25385
25386
25387
25388
25389
25390. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25391. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25392
25393.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25394.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25395There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25396addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25397(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25398abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25399
25400Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25401messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25402&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25403appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25404locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25405unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25406lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25407
25408One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25409when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25410such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25411do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25412
25413
25414.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25415This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25416main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25417&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25418
25419Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25420Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25421facility; you do not have to use it.
25422
25423The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25424configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25425addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25426address to which it applies.
25427
25428Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25429the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25430rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25431those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25432by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25433are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25434rules.
25435
25436Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25437applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25438well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25439headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25440
25441
25442In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25443legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25444in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25445used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25446Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25447discouraged.
25448
25449There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25450illustrated by these examples:
25451
25452.ilist
25453The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25454exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25455gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25456&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25457.next
25458A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25459&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25460.endlist
25461
25462
25463
25464.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25465.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25466.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25467Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25468message's processing.
25469
25470.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25471At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25472by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25473ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25474is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25475rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25476rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25477RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25478rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25479
25480.vindex "&$domain$&"
25481.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25482Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25483may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25484rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25485from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25486for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25487value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25488as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25489SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25490
25491As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25492recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25493the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25494any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25495.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25496before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25497
25498When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25499rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25500redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25501
25502.cindex "envelope from"
25503.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25504.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25505.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25506At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25507specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25508This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25509section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25510header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25511applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25512
25513The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25514transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25515transport time.
25516
25517
25518
25519
25520.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25521.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25522.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25523Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25524configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25525&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
255262822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25527transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25528appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25529envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25530.code
25531exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25532.endd
25533might produce the output
25534.code
25535sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25536from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25537to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25538cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25539bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25540reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25541env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25542env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25543.endd
25544which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25545the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25546present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25547set for a particular transport.
25548
25549
25550.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25551.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25552The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25553rules in the form
25554.display
25555<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25556.endd
25557Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25558transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25559takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25560any colons must be doubled, of course).
25561
25562The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25563Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25564case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25565characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25566ignored.
25567
25568For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25569order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25570replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25571
25572The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25573releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25574received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25575lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25576address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25577(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25578that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25579
25580.vindex "&$domain$&"
25581.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25582The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25583string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25584rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25585.code
25586*@* ${lookup ...
25587.endd
25588where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25589refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25590
25591
25592.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25593.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25594.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25595The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25596address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25597single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25598against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25599you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25600facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25601
25602Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25603case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25604can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25605
25606.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25607After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25608depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25609replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25610refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25611numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25612of pattern they are set as follows:
25613
25614.ilist
25615If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25616refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25617the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25618pattern
25619.code
25620*queen@*.fict.example
25621.endd
25622is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25623.code
25624$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25625$1 = hearts-
25626$2 = wonderland
25627.endd
25628Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25629does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25630
25631.next
25632If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25633of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25634for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25635rewriting rule of the form
25636.display
25637&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25638.endd
25639and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25640.code
25641$1 = foo
25642$2 = bar
25643$3 = baz.example
25644.endd
25645If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25646wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25647&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25648partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25649whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25650.endlist
25651
25652
25653.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25654.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25655If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25656match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25657rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25658.code
25659hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25660.endd
25661specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25662&'From:'& headers.
25663
25664.vindex "&$domain$&"
25665.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25666If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25667yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25668&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25669Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25670cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25671matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25672the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25673current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25674expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25675entry written to the panic log.
25676
25677
25678
25679.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25680There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25681
25682.ilist
25683Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25684c, f, h, r, s, t.
25685.next
25686A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25687.next
25688Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25689.endlist
25690
25691For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25692E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25693
25694
25695
25696.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25697 "SECID154"
25698.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25699If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25700&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25701and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25702transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25703rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25704.display
25705&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25706&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25707&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25708&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25709&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25710&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25711&`h`& rewrite all headers
25712&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25713&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25714&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25715.endd
25716"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25717individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25718other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25719
25720You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25721restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25722
25723
25724.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25725.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25726.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25727.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25728The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25729SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25730before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25731required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25732data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25733
25734.vindex "&$domain$&"
25735.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25736This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25737compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25738input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25739the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25740expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25741original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25742
25743
25744.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25745There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25746take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25747correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25748
25749.ilist
25750If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25751unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25752absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25753.next
25754If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25755even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25756expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25757(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25758.next
25759The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25760address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25761rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25762.next
25763.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25764When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25765to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25766left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25767.code
25768From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25769.endd
25770into
25771.code
25772From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25773.endd
25774.cindex "RFC 2047"
25775Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25776done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25777causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25778replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
257792822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25780brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25781(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25782is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25783
25784When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25785rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25786.endlist
25787
25788
25789.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25790Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25791.code
25792*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25793*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25794 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25795.endd
25796Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25797the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25798has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25799consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25800present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25801explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25802at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25803error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25804
25805The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25806domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25807.code
25808root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25809.endd
25810were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25811local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25812
25813Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25814&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25815messages that originate outside the local host:
25816.code
25817*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25818 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25819.endd
25820The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25821space.
25822
25823.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25824.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25825Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25826an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25827the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25828remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25829sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25830components. For example, the rule
25831.code
25832\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25833.endd
25834rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25835&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25836a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25837method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25838to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25839use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25840can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25841.ecindex IIDaddrew
25842
25843
25844
25845
25846
25847. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25848. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25849
25850.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25851.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25852.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25853The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25854retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25855be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25856empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25857errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25858general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25859line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25860address, domain and error.
25861
25862The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25863host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25864Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25865address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25866been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25867tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25868log selector is set, the message
25869.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25870&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25871skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25872the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25873
25874Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25875in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25876actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25877failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25878the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25879added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25880same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25881domain are maintained independently.
25882
25883When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25884receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25885always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25886behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25887quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25888suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25889subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25890the local address is reached.
25891
25892.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25893If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25894whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25895files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25896always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25897
25898The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25899rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25900record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25901timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25902and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25903messages that it should now be retaining.
25904
25905
25906
25907.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25908.cindex "retry" "rules"
25909Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25910separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25911addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25912enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25913in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25914present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25915message's sender, respectively.
25916
25917
25918The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25919&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25920which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25921has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25922list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25923which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25924example,
25925.code
25926lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25927.endd
25928provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25929whereas
25930.code
25931alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25932.endd
25933applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25934In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25935part.
25936
25937.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25938&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25939must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25940expressions work in address lists.
25941.display
25942&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25943&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25944.endd
25945
25946
25947.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25948When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25949example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25950against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25951router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25952regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25953A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25954&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25955&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25956
25957Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25958failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25959configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25960&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25961local transports).
25962
25963.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25964However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25965suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25966whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25967rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25968failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25969recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25970reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25971&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25972lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25973commands.
25974
25975
25976
25977.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25978 "SECID160"
25979For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25980example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25981twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25982&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25983the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25984suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25985.code
25986a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25987 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25988 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25989.endd
25990and the retry rules are
25991.code
25992p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25993a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25994.endd
25995and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25996first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25997rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25998to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25999tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26000first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26001
26002In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26003first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26004&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26005routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26006
26007&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26008However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26009host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26010.code
26011route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26012.endd
26013then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26014textual form of the IP address.
26015
26016.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26017.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26018The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26019asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26020
26021.vlist
26022.vitem &%auth_failed%&
26023Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26024&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26025
26026.vitem &%data_4xx%&
26027A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26028after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26029
26030.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26031A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26032
26033.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26034A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26035.endlist
26036
26037For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26038as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26039recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26040and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26041retry rule of this form:
26042.code
26043the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26044.endd
26045These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26046LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26047
26048.vlist
26049.vitem &%lost_connection%&
26050A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26051legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26052for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26053
26054.vitem &%lookup%&
26055A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26056Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26057its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26058Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26059its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26060
26061.vitem &%refused_MX%&
26062A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26063
26064.vitem &%refused_A%&
26065A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26066
26067.vitem &%refused%&
26068A connection was refused.
26069
26070.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26071A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26072
26073.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26074A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26075
26076.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26077A connection attempt timed out.
26078
26079.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26080There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26081obtained from an MX record.
26082
26083.vitem &%timeout_A%&
26084There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26085obtained from an MX record.
26086
26087.vitem &%timeout%&
26088There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26089
26090.vitem &%tls_required%&
26091The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26092&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26093to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26094
26095.vitem &%quota%&
26096A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26097transport.
26098
26099.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26100.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26101.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26102A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26103transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26104&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26105for four days.
26106.endlist
26107
26108.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26109The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26110timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26111it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26112However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26113heuristic rules:
26114
26115.ilist
26116If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26117used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26118quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26119.next
26120.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26121For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26122subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26123the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26124change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26125MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26126time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26127.next
26128For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26129obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26130.endlist
26131
26132The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26133mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26134when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26135error).
26136
26137
26138
26139.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26140.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26141You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26142specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26143apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26144form:
26145.display
26146&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26147.endd
26148The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26149.code
26150* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26151.endd
26152matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26153host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26154For example:
26155.code
26156a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26157.endd
26158&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26159(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26160only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26161its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26162all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26163
26164When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26165&%-f%& command line option, like this:
26166.code
26167exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26168.endd
26169If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26170list is never matched.
26171
26172
26173
26174
26175
26176.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26177.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26178The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26179sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26180.display
26181<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26182.endd
26183The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26184time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26185arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26186time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26187relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26188
26189.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26190.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26191.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26192.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26193The available algorithms are:
26194
26195.ilist
26196&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26197the interval.
26198.next
26199&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26200specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26201is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26202.next
26203&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26204retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26205maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26206the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26207rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26208members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26209queue processing times.
26210.endlist
26211
26212When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26213order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26214used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26215case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26216current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26217computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26218interval is found. The main configuration variable
26219.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26220.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26221.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26222&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26223cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26224
26225A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26226host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26227basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26228for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26229generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26230time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26231time.
26232
26233.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26234Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26235run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26236starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26237new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26238If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26239occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26240messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26241processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26242your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26243number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26244sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26245
26246The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26247&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26248&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26249&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26250are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26251deliveries that have been deferred.
26252
26253
26254.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26255Here are some example retry rules:
26256.code
26257alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26258wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26259wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26260lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26261* refused_A F,2h,20m;
26262* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26263.endd
26264The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26265&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26266mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26267hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26268parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26269effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26270fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26271days.
26272
26273The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26274happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26275intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26276first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26277so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26278
26279The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26280They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26281all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26282were not obtained from an MX record.
26283
26284The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26285first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26286not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26287hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
262881.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26289
26290
26291
26292.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26293.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26294.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26295.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26296.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26297Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26298consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26299set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26300been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26301arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26302failing for the first time.
26303
26304This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26305backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26306Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26307down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26308
26309If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26310every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26311message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26312
26313
26314
26315
26316.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26317.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26318.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26319Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26320that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26321default retry rule:
26322.code
26323* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26324.endd
26325the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26326long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26327failure for the recipient address that counts.
26328
26329When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26330addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26331causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26332In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26333time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26334
26335For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26336messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26337post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26338
26339.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26340.cindex retry "final cutoff"
26341If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26342.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26343&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26344default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26345as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26346reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26347attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26348those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26349the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26350
26351In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26352for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26353times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26354behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26355to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26356notice.
26357
26358If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26359addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26360addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26361no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26362words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26363addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26364If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26365&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26366deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26367true.
26368
26369.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26370.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26371Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26372intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26373its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26374because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26375host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26376failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26377reached.
26378
26379Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26380applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26381Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26382examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26383commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26384time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26385is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26386time out the address.
26387
26388The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26389the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26390given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26391time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26392not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26393considered immediately.
26394.ecindex IIDretconf1
26395.ecindex IIDregconf2
26396
26397
26398
26399
26400
26401
26402. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26403. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26404
26405.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26406.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26407.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26408The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26409with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26410described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26411to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26412permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26413transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26414other.
26415
26416.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26417Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26418
26419.ilist
26420The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26421the client's EHLO command.
26422.next
26423The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26424may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26425.next
26426The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26427appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26428just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26429any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26430with the AUTH command.
26431.next
26432The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26433.next
26434If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26435option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26436mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26437connection.
26438.next
26439If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26440authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26441unauthenticated connection.
26442.endlist
26443
26444If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26445mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26446SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26447includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26448.display
26449&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26450&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26451&`Connected to server.example.`&
26452&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26453&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26454&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26455&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26456&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26457&`250-PIPELINING`&
26458&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26459&`250 HELP`&
26460.endd
26461The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26462authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26463mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26464routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26465controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26466included by setting
26467.code
26468AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26469AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26470AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26471AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26472AUTH_GSASL=yes
26473AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26474AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26475AUTH_SPA=yes
26476AUTH_TLS=yes
26477.endd
26478in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26479authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26480the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26481The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26482work via a socket interface.
26483.new
26484The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26485as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26486.wen
26487The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26488provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26489The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26490supporting setting a server keytab.
26491The seventh can be configured to support
26492the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26493not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26494The eighth authenticator
26495supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26496The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26497instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26498
26499The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26500section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26501authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26502authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26503is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26504messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26505options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26506
26507To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26508&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26509either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26510functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26511to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26512both sets of options, is required. For example:
26513.code
26514cram:
26515 driver = cram_md5
26516 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26517 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26518 client_name = ph10
26519 client_secret = secret2
26520.endd
26521The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26522&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26523
26524Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26525The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26526authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26527in Exim.
26528
26529&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26530per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26531account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26532authenticating data.
26533
26534Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26535&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26536and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26537Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26538used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26539second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26540user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26541configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26542&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26543as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26544choose to honour.
26545
26546A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26547to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26548mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26549typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26550
26551
26552
26553.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26554.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26555.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26556
26557.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26558When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26559&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26560used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26561encrypted by a setting such as:
26562.code
26563client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26564.endd
26565
26566
26567.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26568When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26569result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26570Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26571
26572
26573.option driver authenticators string unset
26574This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26575authenticators is to be used.
26576
26577
26578.option public_name authenticators string unset
26579This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26580implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26581contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26582but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26583defaults to the driver's instance name.
26584
26585
26586.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26587When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26588is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26589mechanism is not advertised.
26590If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26591forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26592See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26593
26594
26595.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26596This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26597is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26598for details.
26599
26600For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26601mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26602
26603For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26604authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26605authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26606authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26607to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26608error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26609string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26610expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26611other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26612the error text.
26613
26614
26615.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26616If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26617command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26618output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26619out the values of variables.
26620If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26621output, and Exim carries on processing.
26622
26623
26624.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26625.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26626.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26627When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26628expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26629messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26630lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26631configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26632refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26633On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26634the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26635If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26636
26637
26638.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26639This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26640as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26641driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26642as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26643remembered for later use.
26644How it is used is described in the following section.
26645
26646
26647
26648
26649
26650.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26651.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26652.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26653When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26654the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26655message:
26656
26657.ilist
26658If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26659than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26660.next
26661If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26662.next
26663.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26664If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26665running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26666from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26667&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26668return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26669given for the MAIL command.
26670.next
26671If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26672is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26673authenticated.
26674.next
26675If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26676the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26677&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26678valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26679fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26680&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26681the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26682message.
26683.endlist
26684
26685
26686When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26687hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26688&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26689process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26690
26691.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26692Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26693MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26694therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26695value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26696ACL is run.
26697
26698
26699
26700.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26701.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26702When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26703authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26704conditions:
26705
26706.ilist
26707The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26708.next
26709It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26710yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26711.endlist
26712
26713The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26714the mechanisms are advertised.
26715
26716Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26717provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26718even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26719set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26720You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26721For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26722that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26723.code
26724auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26725.endd
26726so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26727
26728The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26729authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26730advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26731such as:
26732.code
26733server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26734.endd
26735.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26736If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26737yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26738
26739When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26740immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26741command. This is the case if
26742
26743.ilist
26744The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26745.next
26746No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26747.next
26748Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26749server authenticators.
26750.endlist
26751
26752
26753Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26754to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26755AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26756
26757If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26758server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26759that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26760the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26761fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26762rejected with a 504 error.
26763
26764.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26765.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26766When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26767&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26768or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26769public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26770client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26771no successful authentication.
26772
26773.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26774Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26775&%authresults%& expansion item.
26776
26777
26778
26779
26780.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26781.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26782.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26783.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26784Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26785configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26786encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26787script:
26788.code
26789use MIME::Base64;
26790printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26791.endd
26792.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26793This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26794interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26795some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26796command line to run this script on such data might be
26797.code
26798encode '\0user\0password'
26799.endd
26800Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26801backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26802whose code value is zero.
26803
26804&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26805digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26806you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26807interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26808
26809&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26810specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26811example, a command such as
26812.code
26813encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26814.endd
26815gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26816
26817If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26818base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26819.code
26820echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26821.endd
26822The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26823in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26824output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26825should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26826
26827
26828
26829.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26830.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26831The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26832&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26833announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26834of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26835
26836.ilist
26837For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26838they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26839mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26840of the authenticator.
26841.next
26842.vindex "&$host$&"
26843.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26844When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26845variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26846that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26847any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26848Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26849delivery to be deferred.
26850.next
26851If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26852Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26853try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26854usual way.
26855.next
26856If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26857carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26858possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26859no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26860what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26861&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26862delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26863turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26864deliver the message unauthenticated.
26865.endlist
26866
26867Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26868confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26869upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26870router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26871the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26872running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26873check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26874No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26875
26876For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26877
26878.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26879When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26880parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26881the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26882is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26883incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26884allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26885to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26886&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26887&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26888the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26889.ecindex IIDauthconf1
26890.ecindex IIDauthconf2
26891
26892
26893
26894
26895
26896
26897. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26898. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26899
26900.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26901.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26902.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26903The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26904LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26905plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26906security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26907(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26908use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26909connections as you do for login accounts.
26910
26911.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26912.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26913When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26914
26915.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26916This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26917configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26918
26919.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26920The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26921prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26922given.
26923
26924.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26925.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26926.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26927.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26928 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26929.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26930.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26931
26932When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26933expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26934response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26935values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26936a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26937are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26938(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26939
26940For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26941the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26942variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26943string expansions that also use them for other things.
26944
26945If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26946supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26947data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26948
26949.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26950Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26951&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26952authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26953to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26954&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26955expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26956generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26957For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26958string as the error text.
26959
26960&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26961password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26962There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26963
26964
26965
26966.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26967.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26968.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26969.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26970The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26971sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26972separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26973subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26974
26975The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26976Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26977configured as follows:
26978.code
26979fixed_plain:
26980 driver = plaintext
26981 public_name = PLAIN
26982 server_prompts = :
26983 server_condition = \
26984 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26985 server_set_id = $auth2
26986.endd
26987Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26988are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26989password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26990or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26991
26992The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26993the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26994AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26995authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26996.code
26997250-AUTH PLAIN
26998.endd
26999and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27000.code
27001AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27002.endd
27003As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27004data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27005.code
27006AUTH PLAIN
27007.endd
27008to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27009prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27010
27011The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27012when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27013represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27014is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27015second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27016
27017Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27018realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27019authenticating clients it could make sense.
27020
27021A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27022&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27023comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27024this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27025This is an incorrect example:
27026.code
27027server_condition = \
27028 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27029.endd
27030The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27031which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27032incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27033non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27034strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27035the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27036name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27037.code
27038server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27039 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27040.endd
27041In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27042fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27043used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27044always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27045writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27046
27047
27048.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27049.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27050.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
27051The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27052in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27053user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27054plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27055.code
27056fixed_login:
27057 driver = plaintext
27058 public_name = LOGIN
27059 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27060 server_condition = \
27061 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27062 server_set_id = $auth1
27063.endd
27064Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27065with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27066if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27067strings are used to obtain two data items.
27068
27069Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27070example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27071&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27072strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27073name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27074.code
27075login:
27076 driver = plaintext
27077 public_name = LOGIN
27078 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27079 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27080 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27081 ldapauth{\
27082 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27083 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27084 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27085 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27086.endd
27087We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27088does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27089operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27090&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27091correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27092the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27093uninterpreted string.
27094
27095
27096.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27097A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27098interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27099traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27100Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27101&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27102
27103
27104
27105
27106.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27107.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27108The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27109
27110.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27111If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27112authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27113the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27114usual.
27115
27116.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27117The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27118string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27119string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27120to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27121most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27122with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27123way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27124(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27125so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27126&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27127&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27128
27129&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27130splitting takes priority and happens first.
27131
27132Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27133the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27134there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27135NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27136the string.
27137
27138This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27139authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27140.code
27141fixed_plain:
27142 driver = plaintext
27143 public_name = PLAIN
27144 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27145.endd
27146The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27147command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27148that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27149.code
27150fixed_login:
27151 driver = plaintext
27152 public_name = LOGIN
27153 client_send = : username : mysecret
27154.endd
27155The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27156the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27157prompts.
27158.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27159.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27160
27161
27162
27163
27164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27165. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27166
27167.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27168.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27169.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27170.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27171.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27172The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27173sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27174name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27175string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27176is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27177secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27178available in plain text at either end.
27179
27180
27181.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27182.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27183This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27184authenticator as a server:
27185
27186.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27187.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27188When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27189the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27190obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27191that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27192string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27193fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27194returned to the client.
27195
27196For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27197in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27198deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27199numeric variables for other things.
27200
27201For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27202client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27203user name, authentication fails.
27204.code
27205fixed_cram:
27206 driver = cram_md5
27207 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27208 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27209 server_set_id = $auth1
27210.endd
27211.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27212If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27213name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27214secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27215.code
27216lookup_cram:
27217 driver = cram_md5
27218 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27219 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27220 {$value}fail}
27221 server_set_id = $auth1
27222.endd
27223Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27224because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27225
27226As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27227using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27228lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27229realm, with:
27230.code
27231cyrusless_crammd5:
27232 driver = cram_md5
27233 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27234 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27235 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27236 server_set_id = $auth1
27237.endd
27238
27239.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27240.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27241When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27242
27243
27244
27245.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27246This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27247computing the response to the server's challenge.
27248
27249
27250.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27251This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27252expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27253
27254
27255.vindex "&$host$&"
27256.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27257Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27258to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27259expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27260prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27261authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27262send the message to the current server.
27263
27264A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27265strings, is:
27266.code
27267fixed_cram:
27268 driver = cram_md5
27269 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27270 client_name = ph10
27271 client_secret = secret
27272.endd
27273.ecindex IIDcramauth1
27274.ecindex IIDcramauth2
27275
27276
27277
27278. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27279. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27280
27281.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27282.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27283.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27284.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27285.cindex "Kerberos"
27286The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27287at A L Digital Ltd.
27288
27289The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27290library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27291Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27292including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27293directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27294
27295The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27296the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27297then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27298name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27299
27300Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27301or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27302user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27303by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27304depending on the driver you are using.
27305
27306The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27307be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27308Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27309changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27310layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27311implementation.
27312
27313For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27314may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27315variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27316Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27317With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27318environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27319is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27320the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27321
27322
27323.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27324The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27325(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27326previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27327use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27328confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27329things.
27330
27331
27332.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27333This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27334library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27335SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27336
27337
27338.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27339This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27340default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27341you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27342example:
27343.code
27344sasl:
27345 driver = cyrus_sasl
27346 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27347 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27348 server_set_id = $auth1
27349.endd
27350
27351.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27352This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27353
27354
27355.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27356This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27357
27358
27359For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27360private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27361the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27362PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27363.code
27364sasl_cram_md5:
27365 driver = cyrus_sasl
27366 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27367 server_set_id = $auth1
27368
27369sasl_plain:
27370 driver = cyrus_sasl
27371 public_name = PLAIN
27372 server_set_id = $auth2
27373.endd
27374Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27375not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27376but it is present in many binary distributions.
27377.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27378.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27379
27380
27381
27382
27383. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27384. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27385.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27386.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27387.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27388This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27389Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27390Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27391If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27392to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27393authenticator only. There is only one option:
27394
27395.option server_socket dovecot string unset
27396
27397This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27398authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27399mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27400authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27401.code
27402dovecot_plain:
27403 driver = dovecot
27404 public_name = PLAIN
27405 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27406 server_set_id = $auth1
27407
27408dovecot_ntlm:
27409 driver = dovecot
27410 public_name = NTLM
27411 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27412 server_set_id = $auth1
27413.endd
27414If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27415&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27416option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27417connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27418option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27419who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27420.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27421.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27422
27423
27424. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27425. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27426.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27427.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27428.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27429.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27430.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27431.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27432.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27433.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27434.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27435.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27436.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27437.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27438The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27439library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27440and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27441scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27442made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27443without code changes in Exim.
27444
27445Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27446time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27447
27448
27449.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27450Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27451
27452Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27453of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27454authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27455ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27456context.
27457
27458This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27459non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27460server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27461
27462This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27463only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27464writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27465
27466This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27467this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27468of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27469
27470However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27471Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27472with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27473
27474
27475.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27476This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27477library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27478Some mechanisms will use this data.
27479
27480
27481.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27482This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27483default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27484you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27485example:
27486.code
27487sasl:
27488 driver = gsasl
27489 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27490 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27491 server_set_id = $auth1
27492.endd
27493
27494
27495.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27496Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27497that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27498the password itself.
27499
27500The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27501In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27502The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27503if available, else the empty string.
27504The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27505else the empty string.
27506
27507A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27508
27509If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27510option to be simply "true".
27511
27512
27513.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27514This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27515Some mechanisms will use this data.
27516
27517
27518.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27519This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27520&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27521(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27522
27523
27524.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27525This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27526&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27527(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27528
27529
27530.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27531This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27532Some mechanisms will use this data.
27533
27534
27535.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27536.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27537These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27538They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27539
27540Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27541meanings for these variables:
27542
27543.ilist
27544.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27545&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27546.next
27547.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27548&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27549.next
27550.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27551&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27552.endlist
27553
27554On a per-mechanism basis:
27555
27556.ilist
27557.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27558EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27559the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27560.next
27561.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27562ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27563the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27564.next
27565.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27566GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27567&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27568the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27569.endlist
27570
27571An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27572identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27573email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27574
27575
27576An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27577and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27578.code
27579gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27580 driver = gsasl
27581 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27582 server_realm = imap.example.org
27583 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27584 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27585 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27586 server_condition = yes
27587.endd
27588
27589
27590. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27591. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27592
27593.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27594.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27595.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27596.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27597.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27598The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27599Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27600reliably.
27601
27602.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27603This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27604for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27605identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27606
27607.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27608If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27609&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27610The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27611
27612.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27613This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27614&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27615from the keytab.
27616
27617
27618.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27619Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27620to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27621not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27622
27623The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27624Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27625Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27626role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27627
27628.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27629.ilist
27630.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27631&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27632.next
27633.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27634&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27635authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27636GSS Display Name.
27637.endlist
27638
27639
27640. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27641. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27642
27643.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27644.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27645.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27646.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27647.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27648.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27649.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27650The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27651Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27652which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27653this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27654taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27655server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27656follows:
27657
27658.ilist
27659After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27660authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27661.next
27662The server sends back a challenge.
27663.next
27664The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27665and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27666.endlist
27667
27668Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27669
27670
27671
27672.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27673.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27674The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27675
27676.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27677.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27678This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27679authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27680compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27681&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27682it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27683for other things. For example:
27684.code
27685spa:
27686 driver = spa
27687 public_name = NTLM
27688 server_password = \
27689 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27690.endd
27691If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27692failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27693
27694
27695
27696
27697
27698.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27699.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27700The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27701
27702
27703
27704.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27705This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27706
27707
27708.option client_password spa string&!! unset
27709This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27710
27711
27712.option client_username spa string&!! unset
27713This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27714configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27715&'msn.com'&:
27716.code
27717msn:
27718 driver = spa
27719 public_name = MSN
27720 client_username = msn/msn_username
27721 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27722 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27723.endd
27724.ecindex IIDspaauth1
27725.ecindex IIDspaauth2
27726
27727
27728
27729
27730
27731. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27732. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27733
27734.chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27735.scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27736.scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27737.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27738.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27739.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27740The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27741authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27742The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27743(&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27744It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27745the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27746by the server configuration.
27747
27748The client presents an identity in-clear.
27749It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27750and for clients to only attempt,
27751this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27752
27753One possible use, compatible with the
27754K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27755is for using X509 client certificates.
27756
27757It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27758(see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27759but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27760rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27761client certificates only.
27762
27763The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27764client-certificate authentication is being done.
27765
27766The client must present a certificate,
27767for which it must have been requested via the
27768&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27769(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27770For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27771verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27772
27773.section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27774.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27775The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27776
27777.option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27778.option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27779.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27780These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27781and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27782If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27783failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27784
27785They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27786
27787.section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27788.cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27789.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27790 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27791.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27792.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27793
27794When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27795expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27796response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27797values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27798an identity for authentication and
27799placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27800
27801For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27802the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27803variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27804string expansions that also use them for other things.
27805
27806.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27807Once an identity has been received,
27808&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27809authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27810to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27811&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27812expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27813generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27814For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27815string as the error text.
27816
27817Example:
27818.code
27819ext_ccert_san_mail:
27820 driver = external
27821 public_name = EXTERNAL
27822
27823 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27824 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27825 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27826 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27827 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27828 server_set_id = $auth1
27829.endd
27830This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27831of your configured trust-anchors
27832(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27833and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27834
27835Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27836The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27837TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27838in this way.
27839Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27840
27841
27842.section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27843.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27844The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27845
27846.option client_send external string&!! unset
27847This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27848identity being asserted.
27849
27850Example:
27851.code
27852ext_ccert:
27853 driver = external
27854 public_name = EXTERNAL
27855
27856 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27857 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27858.endd
27859
27860
27861.ecindex IIDexternauth1
27862.ecindex IIDexternauth2
27863
27864
27865
27866
27867
27868. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27869. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27870
27871.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27872.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27873.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27874.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27875.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27876.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27877The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27878authentication based on client certificates.
27879
27880It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27881advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27882It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27883the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27884by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27885the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27886
27887The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27888for which it must have been requested via the
27889&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27890(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27891
27892If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27893run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27894and can authenticate the connection.
27895If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27896
27897A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27898
27899
27900.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27901The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27902
27903.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27904.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27905This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27906the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27907If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27908failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27909
27910.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27911.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27912As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27913
27914&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27915
27916
27917Example:
27918.code
27919tls:
27920 driver = tls
27921 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27922 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27923 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27924 {forany {$auth1} \
27925 {!= {0} \
27926 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27927 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27928 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27929 } } } }}}
27930 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27931.endd
27932This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27933of your configured trust-anchors
27934(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27935and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27936
27937Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27938The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27939TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27940in this way.
27941Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27942
27943. An alternative might use
27944. .code
27945. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27946. .endd
27947. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27948. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27949. This would help for per-device use.
27950.
27951. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27952. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27953
27954.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27955.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27956
27957
27958Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27959the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27960a connect- or helo-ACL.
27961
27962
27963
27964. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27965. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27966
27967.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27968 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27969.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27970.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27971.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27972.cindex "OpenSSL"
27973.cindex "GnuTLS"
27974Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27975Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27976GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27977cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27978order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27979version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27980You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27981level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27982certificates are used.
27983
27984RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27985connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27986server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27987mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27988between them is encrypted.
27989
27990Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27991and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27992certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27993possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27994encryption state.
27995
27996&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27997disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27998in order to get TLS to work.
27999
28000
28001
28002.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28003 "SECID284"
28004.cindex "submissions protocol"
28005.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28006.cindex "smtps protocol"
28007.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28008.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28009.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28010The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28011contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28012allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28013instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28014by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28015
28016The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28017clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28018Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28019
28020This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28021standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28022reassigned for other use.
28023Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28024this port.
28025In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28026not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28027Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28028
28029Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28030global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28031the most common use is expected to be:
28032.code
28033tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28034.endd
28035The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28036via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28037the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28038the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28039an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28040defined elsewhere.
28041
28042There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28043&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28044
28045
28046
28047
28048
28049
28050.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28051.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28052The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
28053followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
28054to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28055.code
28056USE_GNUTLS=yes
28057.endd
28058in Local/Makefile
28059you must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28060include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28061
28062There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28063
28064.ilist
28065The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28066cannot be the path of a directory
28067for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28068(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28069.next
28070The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28071.next
28072.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28073.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28074Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28075separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28076affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28077.next
28078OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28079DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28080RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28081in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28082for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28083to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28084&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28085option).
28086.next
28087The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28088sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28089.next
28090The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28091When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28092(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28093let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28094.next
28095With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28096main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28097.next
28098Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28099This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28100explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28101implementation, then patches are welcome.
28102.endlist
28103
28104
28105.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28106This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28107an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28108but not the chosen filename.
28109By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28110See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28111
28112GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28113to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28114Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28115&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28116of bits requested.
28117The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28118its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28119parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28120that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28121renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28122this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28123place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28124
28125For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28126recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28127If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28128are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28129not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28130
28131Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28132values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28133parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28134If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28135until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28136a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28137
28138The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28139in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28140generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28141
28142To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28143and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28144&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28145renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28146.code
28147# ls
28148[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28149# rm -f new-params
28150# touch new-params
28151# chown exim:exim new-params
28152# chmod 0600 new-params
28153# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28154# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28155[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28156 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28157 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28158# chmod 0400 new-params
28159# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28160.endd
28161If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28162stalling is removed.
28163
28164The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28165Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28166the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28167a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28168and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28169failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28170of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28171which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28172GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28173to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28174limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28175
28176The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28177value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28178&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
281792432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28180
28181In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28182increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28183bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28184procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28185the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28186
28187
28188.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28189.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28190.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28191There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28192suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28193are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28194The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28195DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28196directly to this function call.
28197Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28198&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28199The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28200documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28201
28202.ilist
28203It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28204.next
28205It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28206or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28207ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28208SSL v3 algorithms.
28209.next
28210Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28211the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28212SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28213algorithms.
28214.endlist
28215
28216Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28217&`-`& or &`+`&.
28218.ilist
28219If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28220ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28221stated.
28222.next
28223If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28224of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28225.next
28226If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28227option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28228.endlist
28229
28230If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28231a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28232includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28233not be moved to the end of the list.
28234.endlist
28235
28236The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28237string:
28238.code
28239# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28240$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28241.endd
28242
28243This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28244there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28245submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28246choice of clients used:
28247.code
28248# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28249tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28250 {DEFAULT}\
28251 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28252.endd
28253
28254This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28255.code
28256tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28257.endd
28258
28259For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28260and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28261The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28262TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28263
28264As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28265.code
28266TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28267.endd
28268
28269
28270.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28271 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28272.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28273.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28274.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28275.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28276.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28277.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28278.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28279The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28280as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28281ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28282
28283The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28284and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28285
28286The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28287controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28288&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28289the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28290the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28291aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28292
28293Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28294"Priority strings". This is online as
28295&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28296but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28297installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28298then the example code
28299&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28300on that site can be used to test a given string.
28301
28302For example:
28303.code
28304# Disable older versions of protocols
28305tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28306.endd
28307
28308Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28309additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28310"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28311
28312This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28313there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28314by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28315where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28316used:
28317.code
28318# GnuTLS variant
28319tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28320 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28321 {SECURE128}}
28322.endd
28323
28324
28325.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28326.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28327When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28328the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28329but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28330that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28331this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28332
28333If STARTTLS is to be used you
28334need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28335
28336If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28337problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28338persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28339with the error
28340.code
28341554 Security failure
28342.endd
28343If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28344rejected with a 554 error code.
28345
28346To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28347must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28348
28349If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28350meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28351You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28352from someone able to intercept the communication.
28353
28354Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28355
28356To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28357.code
28358tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28359tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28360.endd
28361These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28362the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28363contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28364that goes with it. These files need to be
28365PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28366always be given as full path names.
28367The key must not be password-protected.
28368They can be the same file if both the
28369certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28370set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28371is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28372certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28373the server's certificate.
28374
28375For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28376colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28377algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28378public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28379client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28380ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28381
28382If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28383source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28384few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28385
28386&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28387they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28388Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28389transport.
28390
28391With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28392require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28393this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28394.code
28395tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28396.endd
28397is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28398with the parameters contained in the file.
28399Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28400available:
28401.code
28402tls_dhparam = none
28403.endd
28404This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28405DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28406used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28407documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28408
28409See the command
28410.code
28411openssl dhparam
28412.endd
28413for a way of generating file data.
28414
28415The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28416host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28417for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28418in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28419forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28420
28421.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28422.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28423.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28424The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28425an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28426incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28427also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28428&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28429condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28430
28431Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28432can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28433cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28434example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28435contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28436documentation for more details.
28437
28438For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28439(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28440
28441
28442.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28443.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28444.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28445If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28446session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28447&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28448apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28449Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28450contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28451expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28452These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28453an explicit file or,
28454depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28455&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28456
28457A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28458directory is used
28459(OpenSSL only),
28460each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28461of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28462certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28463.code
28464openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28465.endd
28466where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28467
28468There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28469Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28470
28471The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28472what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28473does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28474&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28475attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28476dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28477session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28478fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28479example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28480relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28481
28482.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28483When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28484the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28485&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28486
28487.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28488Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28489&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28490&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28491&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28492certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28493
28494
28495.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28496.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28497.cindex "revocation list"
28498.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28499.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28500Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28501certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28502server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28503an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28504of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28505CRL in PEM format.
28506The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28507file from every certificate authority they know of.
28508
28509The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28510Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28511against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28512usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28513private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28514is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28515
28516The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28517comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28518connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28519re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28520
28521The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28522issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28523the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28524negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28525CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28526resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28527starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28528proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28529
28530Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28531or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28532support for OCSP stapling is included.
28533
28534There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28535The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28536an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28537option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28538contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28539
28540Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28541proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28542Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28543contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28544on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28545next connection.
28546
28547When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28548in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28549ignored.
28550
28551For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28552also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28553certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28554of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28555intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28556file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28557
28558Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28559not any of the chain from CA to it.
28560
28561There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28562
28563.code
28564 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28565 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28566 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28567
28568 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28569 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28570 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28571.endd
28572
28573
28574
28575
28576.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28577.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28578.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28579.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28580.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28581The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28582deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28583server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28584within the &(smtp)& transport.
28585
28586It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28587transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28588server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28589this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28590transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28591
28592If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28593to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28594&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28595those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28596set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28597usual way.
28598
28599When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28600the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28601a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28602session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28603&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28604delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28605it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28606STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28607negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28608unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28609unencrypted.
28610
28611The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28612transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28613if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28614&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28615
28616.new
28617Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28618for client use (they are usable for server use).
28619As TLS has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28620in failed connections.
28621.wen
28622
28623If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28624specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28625These may be
28626the system default set (depending on library version),
28627a file,
28628or (depending on library version) a directory.
28629The client verifies the server's certificate
28630against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28631in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28632Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28633&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28634
28635The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28636certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28637or need not succeed respectively.
28638
28639The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28640checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28641is valid for the certificate.
28642The option defaults to always checking.
28643
28644The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28645&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28646is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28647value is empty.
28648&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28649a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28650value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28651otherwise.
28652
28653The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28654&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28655for OCSP to be relevant.
28656
28657If
28658&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28659list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28660the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28661alternative hosts, if any.
28662
28663 &*Note*&:
28664These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28665is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28666by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28667client.
28668
28669.vindex "&$host$&"
28670.vindex "&$host_address$&"
28671All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28672&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28673which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28674behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28675
28676.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28677.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28678.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28679.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28680Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28681&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28682variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28683that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28684successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28685outgoing connection.
28686
28687
28688
28689.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28690.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28691.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28692.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28693With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28694information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28695extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28696&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28697client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28698within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28699for this session.
28700
28701This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28702which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28703address.
28704
28705With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28706against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28707provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28708be of limited use in that environment.
28709
28710With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28711connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28712choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28713wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28714different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28715
28716The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28717if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28718nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28719only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28720for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28721
28722Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28723received from a client.
28724It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28725
28726If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28727option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28728during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28729
28730.ilist
28731&%tls_certificate%&
28732.next
28733&%tls_crl%&
28734.next
28735&%tls_privatekey%&
28736.next
28737&%tls_verify_certificates%&
28738.next
28739&%tls_ocsp_file%&
28740.endlist
28741
28742Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28743attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28744can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28745arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28746Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28747an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28748when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28749
28750The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28751are re-expanded.
28752
28753When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28754for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28755enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28756see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28757
28758When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
287590.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28760built, then you have SNI support).
28761
28762
28763
28764.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28765 "SECTmulmessam"
28766.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28767.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28768Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28769an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28770one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28771of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28772connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28773to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28774starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28775unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28776
28777An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28778&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28779this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28780shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28781before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28782try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28783if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28784
28785The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28786after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28787just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28788reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28789successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28790SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28791should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28792subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28793and delay other deliveries to that host.
28794
28795To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28796closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28797closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28798information is recorded.
28799
28800There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28801&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28802connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28803
28804
28805
28806
28807.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28808.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28809In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28810certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28811This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28812reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28813
28814The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28815documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28816document is currently at
28817.display
28818&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28819.endd
28820and their FAQ is at
28821.display
28822&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28823.endd
28824
28825Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
288260-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28827descriptions.
28828More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28829published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28830Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28831&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28832
28833
28834.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28835The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28836certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28837sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28838not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28839First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28840certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28841intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28842certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28843The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28844validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28845root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28846install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28847
28848Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28849even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28850server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28851diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28852
28853
28854
28855.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28856.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28857You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28858with OpenSSL, like this:
28859. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28860. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28861.code
28862openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28863 -days 9999 -nodes
28864.endd
28865&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28866delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28867specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28868important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28869that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28870prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28871this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28872
28873. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28874. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28875. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28876. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28877. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28878. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28879. ==== -pdp, 2012
28880NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28881epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28882the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28883the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28884of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28885writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28886progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28887be a sensible resolution).
28888
28889A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28890may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28891encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28892
28893However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28894user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28895certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28896must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28897authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28898signed with that self-signed certificate.
28899
28900For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28901user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28902Open-source PKI book, available online at
28903&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28904.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28905.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28906
28907
28908
28909.section DANE "SECDANE"
28910.cindex DANE
28911DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28912it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28913operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28914you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28915Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28916certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28917
28918What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28919that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28920by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28921
28922It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28923fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28924
28925DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28926for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28927client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28928
28929DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28930that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28931to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28932DNSSEC.
289332) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
289343) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28935
28936There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28937Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28938in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28939If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28940
28941A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
28942"Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
28943For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
28944&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
28945
28946The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28947These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28948The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28949(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28950this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28951DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28952well-known one.
28953A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28954attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28955does require careful arrangement.
28956With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28957the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28958DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28959all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28960DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28961
28962Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28963because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28964your certificate.
28965You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28966"MTA-STS", described below.
28967
28968When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28969outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28970connections to you.
28971If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28972technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28973In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28974operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28975Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28976because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28977
28978When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28979and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28980than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28981random serial numbers.
28982The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28983If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28984requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28985CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28986
28987The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
28988a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
28989
28990For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
28991
28992.code
28993 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28994 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28995 | openssl sha512 \
28996 | awk '{print $2}'
28997.endd
28998
28999are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29000
29001An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29002
29003.code
29004 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29005.endd
29006
29007At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29008is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29009
29010
29011For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29012
29013The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29014issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29015Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29016re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29017libraries.
29018This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29019interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29020
29021The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29022be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29023default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29024
29025.code
29026 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29027 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29028 {*}{}}
29029.endd
29030
29031The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29032The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29033found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29034string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29035control the OCSP request.
29036
29037This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29038those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29039
29040
29041For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29042and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29043The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29044DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29045the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29046
29047DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29048
29049A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29050If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29051will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29052be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29053
29054If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29055prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29056back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29057This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29058crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29059which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29060limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29061
29062If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29063.code
29064 hosts_require_tls
29065 tls_verify_hosts
29066 tls_try_verify_hosts
29067 tls_verify_certificates
29068 tls_crl
29069 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29070.endd
29071
29072If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29073verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29074
29075The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29076set to "never" and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29077
29078If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29079
29080There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29081verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29082in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29083and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29084
29085.cindex DANE reporting
29086An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29087to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29088required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29089&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29090The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29091Section 4.3 of that document.
29092
29093Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29094
29095DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29096selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29097to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29098instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29099time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29100Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29101can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29102MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29103information.
29104
29105The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29106which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29107That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29108
29109The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29110&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29111renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29112records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29113information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29114domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29115incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29116
29117
29118
29119. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29120. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29121
29122.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29123.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29124.cindex "control of incoming mail"
29125.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29126.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29127Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29128configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29129name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29130one very small ACL:
29131.code
29132begin acl
29133small_acl:
29134 accept hosts = one.host.only
29135.endd
29136You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29137which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29138
29139The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29140certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29141when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29142option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29143in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29144local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29145a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29146&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29147
29148
29149.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29150The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29151configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29152
29153
29154.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29155.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29156In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29157options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29158.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29159.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29160.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29161.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29162.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29163.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29164.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29165.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29166.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29167.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29168.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29169.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29170.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29171.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29172.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29173.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29174
29175.table2 140pt
29176.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29177.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29178.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29179.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29180.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29181.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29182.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29183.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29184.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29185.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29186.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29187.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29188.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29189.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29190.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29191.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29192.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29193.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29194.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29195.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29196.endtable
29197
29198For example, if you set
29199.code
29200acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29201.endd
29202the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29203in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29204done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29205sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29206command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29207trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29208testing as possible at RCPT time.
29209
29210
29211.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29212.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29213The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29214apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29215really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29216the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29217relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29218are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29219&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29220&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29221in any of these ACLs.
29222
29223The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29224non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29225analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29226batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29227result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29228really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29229on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29230controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29231.code
29232control = suppress_local_fixups
29233.endd
29234This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29235run, it is too late.
29236
29237The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29238content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29239
29240The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29241kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29242temporary error for these kinds of message.
29243
29244
29245.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29246.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29247.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29248The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29249session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29250an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29251accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29252the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29253&%smtp_banner%& option.
29254
29255
29256.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29257.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29258.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29259The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29260EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29261&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29262Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29263session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29264setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29265
29266Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29267mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29268&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29269
29270If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29271modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29272at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29273affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29274an EHLO response.
29275
29276
29277.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29278.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29279Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29280command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29281When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29282is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29283the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29284response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29285added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29286are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29287
29288You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29289in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29290tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29291received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29292the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29293associated with the DATA command.
29294
29295.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29296.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29297.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29298If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29299the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29300. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29301The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29302the data specified is received.
29303
29304For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29305error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29306MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29307before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29308and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29309your resources.
29310
29311The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29312the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29313the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29314and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29315
29316.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29317The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29318enabled (which is the default).
29319
29320The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29321received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29322otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29323
29324This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29325
29326For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29327
29328
29329.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29330The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29331content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29332
29333This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29334
29335
29336.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29337.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29338.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29339The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29340with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29341It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29342client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29343has been accepted.
29344
29345The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29346has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29347with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29348The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29349The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29350can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29351for some or all recipients.
29352
29353PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29354one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29355content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29356.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29357for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29358is &"yes"&.
29359Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29360ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29361will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29362
29363See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29364and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29365
29366This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29367If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29368the feature was not requested by the client.
29369
29370.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29371.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29372The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29373does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29374does not in fact control any access.
29375For this reason, it may only accept
29376or warn as its final result.
29377
29378This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29379session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29380messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29381more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29382
29383&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29384the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29385
29386You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29387&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29388response to QUIT.
29389
29390This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29391failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29392because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29393client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29394connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29395
29396
29397.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29398.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29399The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29400an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29401trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29402because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29403situation even worse.
29404
29405Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29406logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29407modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29408and &%warn%&.
29409
29410.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29411When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29412to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29413connection. The possible values are:
29414.table2
29415.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29416.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29417.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29418.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29419.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29420.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29421.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29422.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29423.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29424.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29425.endtable
29426In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29427Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29428With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29429overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29430&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29431used.
29432
29433
29434.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29435.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29436The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29437you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29438.code
29439acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29440 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29441.endd
29442In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29443providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29444an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29445expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29446more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29447
29448The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29449configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29450string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29451
29452.ilist
29453If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29454contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29455Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29456lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29457If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29458causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29459.code
29460acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29461 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29462 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29463.endd
29464This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29465back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29466file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29467can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29468.next
29469If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29470Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29471matches the string.
29472.next
29473If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29474the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29475want to have something like
29476.code
29477acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29478.endd
29479in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29480newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29481.endlist
29482
29483
29484
29485
29486.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29487.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29488Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29489section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29490&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29491database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29492return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29493&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29494This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29495
29496For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29497&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29498submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29499
29500
29501ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29502has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29503individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29504blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29505
29506If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29507ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29508RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29509recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29510run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29511remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29512&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29513
29514If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29515is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29516
29517
29518.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29519The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29520recipients; it may create new recipients.
29521
29522
29523
29524.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29525.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29526The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29527all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29528not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29529reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29530
29531For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29532these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29533used to accept or reject anything.
29534
29535For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29536&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29537&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29538when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29539
29540For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29541&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29542This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29543messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29544configuration file.
29545
29546
29547
29548
29549.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29550.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29551.vindex &$domain$&
29552.vindex &$local_part$&
29553.vindex &$sender_address$&
29554.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29555.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29556When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29557that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29558&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29559statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29560&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29561is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29562
29563When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29564contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29565set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29566how it is used.
29567
29568.vindex "&$message_size$&"
29569The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29570the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29571that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29572the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29573received).
29574
29575.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29576.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29577The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29578The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29579accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29580of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29581&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29582&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29583
29584
29585
29586
29587
29588.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29589.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29590.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29591.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29592When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29593the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29594and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29595These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29596here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29597encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29598does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29599unencrypted connections.
29600.code
29601acl_check_auth:
29602 accept encrypted = *
29603 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29604 {CRAM-MD5}}
29605 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29606.endd
29607(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29608that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29609encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29610option to do this.)
29611
29612
29613
29614.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29615.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29616.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29617An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29618with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29619Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29620set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29621
29622If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29623used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29624provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29625example:
29626.code
29627deny dnslists = list1.example
29628 dnslists = list2.example
29629.endd
29630If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29631the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29632happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29633all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29634test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29635
29636
29637.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29638The ACL verbs are as follows:
29639
29640.ilist
29641.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29642&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29643of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29644appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29645is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29646after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29647check a RCPT command:
29648.code
29649accept domains = +local_domains
29650 endpass
29651 verify = recipient
29652.endd
29653If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29654passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29655the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29656fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29657&%endpass%&.
29658
29659The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29660use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29661that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29662configuration.
29663
29664.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29665If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29666depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29667(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29668statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29669SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29670.display
29671&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29672&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29673.endd
29674You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29675response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29676same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29677
29678If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29679an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29680for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29681of &%endpass%&.
29682
29683
29684.next
29685.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29686&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29687an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29688&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29689temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29690&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29691be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29692
29693
29694.next
29695.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29696&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29697the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29698example,
29699.code
29700deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29701.endd
29702rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29703
29704
29705.next
29706.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29707&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29708&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29709that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29710the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29711recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29712recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29713message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29714do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29715
29716If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29717its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29718The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29719
29720
29721.next
29722.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29723&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29724forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29725.code
29726drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29727 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29728.endd
29729There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29730The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29731
29732.next
29733.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29734&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29735statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29736example, when checking a RCPT command,
29737.code
29738require message = Sender did not verify
29739 verify = sender
29740.endd
29741passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29742verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29743&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29744discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29745
29746.next
29747.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29748&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29749&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29750to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29751written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29752message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29753duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29754
29755If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29756and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29757&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29758first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29759&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29760
29761If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29762some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29763This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29764is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29765conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29766is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29767onwards.
29768
29769
29770.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29771When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29772text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29773want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29774.code
29775warn !verify = sender
29776 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29777.endd
29778.endlist
29779
29780At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29781
29782As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29783written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29784subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29785continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29786mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29787
29788
29789
29790.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29791.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29792There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29793can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29794of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29795transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29796variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29797an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29798alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29799the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29800.ilist
29801The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29802throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29803while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29804on the same SMTP connection.
29805.next
29806The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29807while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29808reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29809.endlist
29810
29811When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29812preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29813time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29814.code
29815accept hosts = whatever
29816 set acl_m4 = some value
29817accept authenticated = *
29818 set acl_c_auth = yes
29819.endd
29820&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29821be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29822&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29823
29824.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29825What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29826referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29827false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29828error is generated.
29829
29830Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29831their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29832
29833
29834.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29835.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29836.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29837An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29838.code
29839deny domains = *.dom.example
29840 !verify = recipient
29841.endd
29842causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29843&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29844negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29845two statements are equivalent:
29846.code
29847deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29848deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29849.endd
29850However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29851side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29852
29853The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29854of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29855condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29856.code
29857accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29858 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29859accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29860 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29861.endd
29862Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29863the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29864different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29865condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29866therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29867the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29868and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29869
29870ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29871specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29872others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29873warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29874message is handled.
29875
29876The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29877processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29878modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29879consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29880.code
29881require message = Can't verify sender
29882 verify = sender
29883 message = Can't verify recipient
29884 verify = recipient
29885 message = This message cannot be used
29886.endd
29887If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29888&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29889so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29890recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29891verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29892because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29893
29894For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29895modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29896happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29897the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29898.code
29899deny hosts = ...
29900 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29901 message = Invalid sender from client host
29902.endd
29903The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29904by which time Exim has set up the message.
29905
29906
29907
29908.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29909.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29910The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29911
29912.vlist
29913.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29914This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29915incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29916accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29917
29918.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29919.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29920.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29921This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29922continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29923the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29924update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29925write rather ugly lines like this:
29926.display
29927&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29928.endd
29929Instead, all you need is
29930.display
29931&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29932.endd
29933
29934.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29935.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29936This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29937incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29938lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29939lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29940controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29941even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29942
29943As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29944separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29945in several different ways. For example:
29946
29947. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29948. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29949. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29950. ==== way.
29951
29952.ilist
29953It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29954.code
29955 accept ...some conditions
29956 control = queue_only
29957.endd
29958In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29959other words, when the conditions are all true.
29960
29961.next
29962It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29963.code
29964 accept ...some conditions...
29965 control = queue_only
29966 ...some more conditions...
29967.endd
29968If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29969statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29970In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29971to be relevant.
29972
29973.next
29974It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29975decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29976example:
29977.code
29978 warn ...some conditions...
29979 control = freeze
29980 accept ...
29981.endd
29982This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29983&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29984log entry.
29985
29986.next
29987If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29988&%require%& verb. For example:
29989.code
29990 require control = no_multiline_responses
29991.endd
29992.endlist
29993
29994.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29995.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29996.oindex "&%-bh%&"
29997This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29998the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29999&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30000output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30001happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30002output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30003
30004Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30005example:
30006.code
30007deny ...some conditions...
30008 delay = 30s
30009.endd
30010The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30011&"deny"&. Compare this with:
30012.code
30013deny delay = 30s
30014 ...some conditions...
30015.endd
30016which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30017can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30018.code
30019warn ...some conditions...
30020 delay = 2m
30021 control = freeze
30022accept ...
30023.endd
30024
30025If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30026responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30027they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30028delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30029appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30030unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30031using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30032
30033
30034.vitem &*endpass*&
30035.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30036This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30037&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30038failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30039failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30040confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30041&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30042
30043
30044.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30045.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30046This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30047ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30048.code
30049require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30050 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30051.endd
30052&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30053example:
30054.display
30055&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30056&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30057.endd
30058When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30059that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30060recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30061message.
30062
30063The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30064the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30065denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30066available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30067variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30068&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30069ignored.
30070
30071.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30072If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30073verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30074error message.
30075
30076If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30077the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30078more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30079actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30080of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30081is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30082
30083If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30084example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30085the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30086logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30087both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30088logging rejections.
30089
30090
30091.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30092.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30093.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30094This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30095about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30096be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30097may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30098ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30099.display
30100&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30101&` log_reject_target =`&
30102.endd
30103This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30104permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30105current ACL.
30106
30107
30108.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30109.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30110.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30111This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30112processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30113&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30114access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30115ACLs. For example:
30116.display
30117&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30118&` control = freeze`&
30119&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30120.endd
30121By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30122with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30123another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30124example:
30125.code
30126logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30127logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30128.endd
30129
30130
30131.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30132.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30133This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30134message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30135or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30136there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30137&%accept%& for details.)
30138
30139The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30140to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30141generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30142&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30143the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30144.code
30145require message = Host not recognized
30146 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30147.endd
30148(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30149processed.)
30150
30151.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30152.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30153For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30154of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30155is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30156is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30157overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30158accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30159truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30160EHLO options.
30161
30162When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30163consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30164of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30165.code
30166deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30167 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30168.endd
30169The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30170by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30171access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
301722&'xx'&.
30173
30174Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30175the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30176
30177The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30178literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30179anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30180response.
30181
30182.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30183For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30184stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30185
30186If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30187specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30188However, the original message is available in the variable
30189&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30190wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30191routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30192use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30193
30194For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30195is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30196modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30197all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30198&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30199&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30200effect.
30201
30202
30203.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30204.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30205.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30206This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30207for the message.
30208It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30209the DATA ACL).
30210This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30211of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30212Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30213If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30214
30215
30216.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30217This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30218 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30219the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30220
30221
30222.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30223.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30224This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30225&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30226
30227
30228.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30229.cindex "UDP communications"
30230This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30231collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30232the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30233of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30234server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30235separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30236example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30237when:
30238.code
30239udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30240 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30241.endd
30242.endlist
30243
30244
30245
30246
30247.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30248.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30249The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30250
30251.vlist
30252.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30253This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30254has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30255apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30256HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30257really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30258not work without it. For example:
30259.code
30260warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30261 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30262.endd
30263Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30264the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30265matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30266mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30267by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30268
30269
30270.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30271 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30272.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30273.cindex "case of local parts"
30274.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30275These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30276(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30277are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30278any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30279for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30280is encountered.
30281
30282These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30283local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30284in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30285handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30286configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30287
30288This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30289containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30290spam score:
30291.code
30292warn control = caseful_local_part
30293 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30294 $acl_m4 + \
30295 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30296 }
30297 control = caselower_local_part
30298.endd
30299Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30300is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30301
30302
30303.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30304.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30305.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30306This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30307
30308The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30309If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30310and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30311is used for all recipients of the message,
30312then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30313and data is copied from one to the other.
30314
30315An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30316for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30317If a recipient-verify callout
30318(with use_sender)
30319connection is subsequently
30320requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30321any subsequent recipients and the data,
30322otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30323
30324Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30325and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30326Note also that headers cannot be
30327modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30328Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30329The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30330rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30331this will affect the timestamp.
30332
30333All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30334rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30335the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30336Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30337message body.
30338
30339Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30340of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30341before the entire message has been received from the source.
30342It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30343or CHUNKING
30344options in use.
30345
30346Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30347a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30348If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30349the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30350before the acceptance "<=" line.
30351
30352If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30353usual fashion.
30354This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30355to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30356&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30357and does not queue the message.
30358Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30359
30360Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30361(possibly faked)
30362sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30363
30364
30365.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30366.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30367.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30368This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30369with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30370by default called &'debuglog'&.
30371The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30372may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30373the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30374option.
30375Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30376with the &'kill'& option.
30377Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30378contexts):
30379.code
30380 control = debug
30381 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30382 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30383 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30384 control = debug/kill
30385.endd
30386
30387
30388.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30389.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30390.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30391This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30392the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30393
30394
30395.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30396.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30397.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30398This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30399connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30400strings or to numeric value.
30401The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30402Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30403&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30404
30405The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30406(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30407that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30408equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30409Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30410
30411
30412.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30413 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30414.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30415.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30416These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30417is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30418state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30419in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30420
30421The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30422connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30423messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30424&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30425before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30426synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30427work with.
30428
30429
30430.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30431.cindex "fake defer"
30432.cindex "defer, fake"
30433This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30434except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30435550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30436messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30437use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30438
30439.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30440.cindex "fake rejection"
30441.cindex "rejection, fake"
30442This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30443words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30444message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30445However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30446only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30447the same SMTP connection.
30448
30449The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30450message is supplied, the following is used:
30451.code
30452550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30453550-kept for evaluation.
30454550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30455550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30456.endd
30457This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30458
30459.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30460.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30461This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30462other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30463it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30464current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30465SMTP connection.
30466
30467This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30468&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30469is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30470are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30471
30472.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30473.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30474Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30475avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30476use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30477disables such output flushing.
30478
30479.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30480.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30481Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30482avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30483use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30484that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30485
30486.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30487This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30488extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30489of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30490or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30491needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30492only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30493the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30494to be useful in production.
30495
30496.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30497.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30498This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30499It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30500SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30501
30502If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30503suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30504one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30505(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30506responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30507sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30508
30509.ilist
30510Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30511sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30512verification failed"&) is sent.
30513.next
30514If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30515line is output.
30516.endlist
30517
30518The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30519calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30520
30521.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30522.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30523This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30524the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30525response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30526controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30527&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30528
30529.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30530.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30531.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30532This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30533other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30534it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30535runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30536effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30537to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30538same SMTP connection.
30539
30540.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30541.cindex "message" "submission"
30542.cindex "submission mode"
30543This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30544latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30545the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30546operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30547necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30548This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30549late (the message has already been created).
30550
30551Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30552messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30553submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30554The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30555that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30556
30557.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30558.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30559This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30560complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30561normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30562
30563.ilist
30564Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30565dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30566.next
30567No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30568.next
30569There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30570.endlist ilist
30571
30572This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30573passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30574used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30575and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30576data is read.
30577
30578&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30579that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30580
30581.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30582This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30583to a-label form.
30584For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30585.endlist vlist
30586
30587
30588.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30589All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30590
30591.ilist
30592Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30593.next
30594Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30595&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30596.next
30597Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30598.next
30599Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30600.endlist
30601
30602
30603
30604.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30605.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30606.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30607.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30608The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30609to an incoming message, as in this example:
30610.code
30611warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30612 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30613 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30614.endd
30615The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30616MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30617receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30618&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30619any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30620RCPT ACL).
30621
30622Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30623DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30624
30625Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30626the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30627contains one or more newlines that
30628are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30629lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30630front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30631
30632Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30633They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30634However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30635is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30636during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30637with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30638lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30639In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30640non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30641message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30642are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30643
30644.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30645Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30646of message headers
30647until they are added to the
30648message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30649ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30650header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30651ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30652passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30653this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30654&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30655
30656The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30657
30658The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30659processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30660.display
30661&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30662&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30663
30664&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30665&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30666.endd
30667In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30668condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30669condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30670ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30671honoured.
30672
30673.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30674For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30675&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30676effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30677them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30678usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30679are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30680specifications.
30681
30682By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30683header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30684be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30685after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30686that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30687
30688This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30689&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30690header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30691to be a header name first.) For example:
30692.code
30693warn add_header = \
30694 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30695.endd
30696If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30697each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30698you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30699up in reverse order.
30700
30701&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30702added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30703system filter or in a router or transport.
30704
30705
30706
30707.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30708.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30709.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30710.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30711The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30712from an incoming message, as in this example:
30713.code
30714warn message = Remove internal headers
30715 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30716.endd
30717The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30718MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30719receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30720&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30721with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30722any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30723
30724Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30725DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30726
30727More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30728list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30729not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30730create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30731are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30732.code
30733warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30734 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30735warn message = Remove internal headers
30736 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30737.endd
30738Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30739Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30740If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30741There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30742a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30743during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30744if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30745accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30746all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30747ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30748would have been removed.
30749
30750.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30751Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30752is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30753not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30754removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30755this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30756passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30757you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30758&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30759
30760The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30761processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30762.display
30763&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30764&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30765
30766&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30767&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30768.endd
30769In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30770condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30771condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30772same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30773are honoured.
30774
30775&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30776present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30777in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30778
30779
30780
30781
30782.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30783.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30784Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30785compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30786for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30787content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30788
30789Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30790senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30791result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30792done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30793can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30794same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30795The conditions are as follows:
30796
30797
30798.vlist
30799.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30800.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30801.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30802.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30803.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30804The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30805&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30806&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30807false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30808condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30809condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30810ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30811
30812If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30813can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30814and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30815Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30816The name and values are expanded separately.
30817Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30818will act as argument separators.
30819
30820If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30821the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30822&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30823conditions are tested.
30824
30825ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30826loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30827circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30828for different local users or different local domains.
30829
30830.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30831.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30832.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30833.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30834If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30835the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30836authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30837.code
30838authenticated = *
30839.endd
30840
30841.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30842.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30843.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30844.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30845.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30846This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30847expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30848&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30849number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30850any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30851&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30852ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30853negative.
30854
30855.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30856.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30857This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30858content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30859&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30860If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30861problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30862chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30863
30864.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30865.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30866.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30867.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30868.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30869This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30870&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30871use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30872different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30873&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30874
30875.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30876.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30877.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30878.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30879.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30880This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30881of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30882enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30883lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30884&%domains%& test.
30885
30886&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30887use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30888
30889
30890.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30891.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30892.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30893.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30894If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30895name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30896encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30897.code
30898encrypted = *
30899.endd
30900
30901
30902.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30903.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30904.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30905.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30906This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30907name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30908you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30909.code
30910accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30911.endd
30912The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30913the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30914and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30915
30916The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30917Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30918but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30919find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30920opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30921found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30922
30923If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30924address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30925.code
30926accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30927accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30928.endd
30929The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30930is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30931statement can then check the IP address.
30932
30933.vindex "&$host_data$&"
30934If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30935of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30936allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30937.code
30938deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30939message = $host_data
30940.endd
30941which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30942
30943.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30944.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30945.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30946.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30947.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30948This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30949part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30950enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30951result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30952the next &%local_parts%& test.
30953
30954.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30955.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30956.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30957.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30958This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30959content-scanning extension
30960and only after a DATA command.
30961It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30962viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30963
30964.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30965.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30966.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30967This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30968content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30969&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30970with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30971&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30972
30973.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30974.cindex "rate limiting"
30975This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30976messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30977
30978.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30979.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30980.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30981.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30982This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30983recipient address against a list of recipients.
30984
30985.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30986.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30987.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30988This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30989content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30990non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30991any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30992
30993.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30994.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30995.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30996.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30997.vindex "&$domain$&"
30998.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30999This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31000domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31001&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31002of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31003lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31004RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31005influence the sender checking.
31006
31007&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31008relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31009
31010.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31011.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31012.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31013.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31014This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31015for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31016.code
31017senders = :
31018.endd
31019&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31020relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31021
31022.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31023.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31024.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31025This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31026content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31027SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31028
31029.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31030.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31031.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31032.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31033.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31034.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31035This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31036certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31037server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31038or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31039
31040.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31041.cindex "CSA verification"
31042This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31043send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31044&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31045
31046.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31047.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31048.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31049.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31050.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31051This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31052received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31053&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31054there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31055allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31056
31057Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31058problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31059detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31060
31061.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31062.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31063.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31064.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31065.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31066.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31067This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31068received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31069&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31070of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31071is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31072However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31073that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31074to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31075might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31076
31077Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31078section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31079&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31080condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31081.code
31082deny senders = :
31083 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31084 !verify = header_sender
31085.endd
31086
31087.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31088.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31089.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31090.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31091.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31092This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31093received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31094&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31095lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31096and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31097Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31098permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31099&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31100appropriate.
31101
31102Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31103ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31104.code
31105To: @
31106.endd
31107and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31108common as they used to be.
31109
31110.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31111.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31112.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31113.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31114.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31115.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31116.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31117This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31118client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31119attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31120condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31121&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31122independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31123
31124For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31125option), this condition is always true.
31126
31127
31128.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31129.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31130.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31131This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31132Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31133&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31134case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31135&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31136used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31137
31138.new
31139There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31140local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31141.wen
31142
31143There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31144recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31145
31146
31147.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31148.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31149.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31150.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31151.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31152.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31153This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31154recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31155&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31156of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31157This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31158verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31159address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31160value for the child address.
31161
31162.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31163.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31164.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31165.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31166This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31167address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31168was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31169Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31170one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31171original IP address.
31172
31173There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31174DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31175
31176If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31177is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31178
31179.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31180.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31181.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31182.cindex "sender" "verifying"
31183.cindex "verifying" "sender"
31184This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31185message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31186the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31187condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31188
31189.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31190.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31191If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31192value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31193value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31194statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31195want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31196
31197Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31198&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31199to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31200
31201.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31202.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31203This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31204verified as a sender.
31205
31206Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31207(eg. is generated from the received message)
31208they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31209.code
31210verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31211.endd
31212.endlist
31213
31214
31215
31216.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31217.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31218.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31219.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31220In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31221is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31222address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31223domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31224special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31225address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31226.code
31227deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31228 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31229.endd
31230the following records are looked up:
31231.code
3123243.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3123343.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31234.endd
31235As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31236Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31237to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31238use two separate conditions:
31239.code
31240deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31241 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31242.endd
31243If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31244behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31245record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31246processed.
31247
31248This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31249(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31250blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31251following special items in the list:
31252.display
31253&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31254&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31255&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31256.endd
31257.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31258.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31259.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31260Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31261.code
31262deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31263.endd
31264Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31265warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31266.code
31267deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31268warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31269 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31270.endd
31271.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31272.cindex DNS TTL
31273DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31274(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31275so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31276connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31277Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31278connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31279
31280There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31281or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31282&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31283
31284
31285
31286.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31287.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31288By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31289of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31290after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31291.code
31292deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31293.endd
31294This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31295use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31296MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31297&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31298
31299
31300
31301
31302.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31303.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31304There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31305addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31306&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31307with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31308listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31309.code
31310deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31311 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31312.endd
31313This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31314RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31315example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31316up by this example is
31317.code
31318tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31319.endd
31320A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31321addresses. For example:
31322.code
31323deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31324 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31325.endd
31326The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31327name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31328
31329
31330
31331
31332.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31333.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31334The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31335names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31336name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31337As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31338this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31339either to double the separators like this:
31340.code
31341dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31342.endd
31343or to change the separator character, like this:
31344.code
31345dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31346.endd
31347If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31348blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31349occurs. Consider this condition:
31350.code
31351dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31352.endd
31353The DNS lookups that occur are:
31354.code
313552.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31356a.domain.black.list.tld
31357.endd
31358Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31359address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31360are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31361or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31362only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31363successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31364error for a previous item.
31365
31366The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31367syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31368.code
31369dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31370dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31371.endd
31372However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31373is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31374.code
31375deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31376 $sender_address_domain \
31377 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31378 see $dnslist_text.
31379 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31380 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31381 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31382.endd
31383Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31384multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31385and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31386of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31387.code
31388dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31389.endd
31390Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31391domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31392
31393The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31394&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31395
31396
31397
31398
31399.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31400.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31401DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31402just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31403RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31404The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31405.display
31406127.1.0.1 RBL
31407127.1.0.2 DUL
31408127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31409127.1.0.4 RSS
31410127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31411127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31412127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31413.endd
31414Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31415different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31416see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31417
31418
31419.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31420.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31421.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31422.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31423.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31424.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31425.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31426When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31427the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31428&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31429(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31430the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31431&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31432cases, for example:
31433.code
31434deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31435.endd
31436the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31437&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31438For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31439might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31440.code
31441deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31442.endd
31443If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31444&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31445
31446If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31447addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31448The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31449record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31450very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31451information.
31452
31453You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31454&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31455expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31456.code
31457deny hosts = !+local_networks
31458 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31459 at $dnslist_domain
31460 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31461.endd
31462
31463
31464
31465.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31466.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31467You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31468in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31469For example,
31470.code
31471deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31472.endd
31473rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31474any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31475that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31476describes how multiple records are handled.
31477
31478More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31479separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31480&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31481.code
31482deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31483.endd
31484If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31485addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31486first. For example:
31487.code
31488deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31489 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31490.endd
31491
31492If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31493listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31494In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31495true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31496tested. For example:
31497.code
31498dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31499.endd
31500matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31501want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31502being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31503.code
31504dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31505.endd
31506matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31507an odd number.
31508
31509
31510
31511.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31512You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31513condition. Whereas
31514.code
31515deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31516.endd
31517means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31518IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31519.code
31520deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31521.endd
31522means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31523IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31524words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31525the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31526
31527&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31528host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31529
31530If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31531previous example is precisely equivalent to
31532.code
31533deny dnslists = a.b.c
31534 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31535.endd
31536However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31537Consider this example:
31538.code
31539deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31540 list.dsbl.org : \
31541 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31542 relays.ordb.org
31543.endd
31544Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31545.code
31546deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31547 list.dsbl.org
31548deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31549 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31550deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31551.endd
31552which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31553
31554
31555
31556
31557.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31558A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31559thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31560is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31561the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31562the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31563.code
31564dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31565.endd
31566What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31567127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31568condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31569because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31570affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31571additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31572
31573.ilist
31574If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31575IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31576condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31577.next
31578If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31579looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31580changed to:
31581.code
31582dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31583.endd
31584and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31585false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31586.code
31587dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31588.endd
31589for the condition to be true.
31590.endlist
31591
31592When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31593the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31594.ilist
31595If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31596addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31597.code
31598dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31599.endd
31600If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31601false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31602.next
31603If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31604looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31605.code
31606dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31607.endd
31608If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31609true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31610.code
31611dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31612.endd
31613for the condition to be false.
31614.endlist
31615When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31616between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31617
31618
31619
31620
31621.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31622.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31623When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31624the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31625the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31626address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31627only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31628can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31629in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31630lists.
31631
31632A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31633two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31634do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31635If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31636restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31637a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31638domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31639.code
31640deny message = \
31641 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31642 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31643 dnslists = \
31644 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31645 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31646.endd
31647For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31648&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31649match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31650value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31651record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31652The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31653
31654If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31655given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31656the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31657.code
31658deny dnslists = \
31659 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31660 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31661 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31662 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31663.endd
31664In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31665values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31666done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31667
31668
31669
31670.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31671.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31672.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31673If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31674nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
316753ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31676.code
316771.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31678 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31679.endd
31680(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31681lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31682IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31683.code
31684*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31685.endd
31686is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31687Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31688
31689You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31690&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31691.code
31692deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31693 dnslists = some.list.example
31694.endd
31695
31696If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31697address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31698(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31699.code
31700 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31701.endd
31702
31703.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31704.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31705.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31706.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31707The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31708which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31709&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31710commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31711works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31712host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31713.display
31714&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31715.endd
31716If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31717period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31718
31719As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31720&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31721configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31722of &'p'&.
31723
31724The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31725time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31726means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31727parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31728send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31729in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31730constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31731changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31732both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31733
31734There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31735log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31736when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31737instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31738
31739The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31740sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31741retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31742which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31743By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31744of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31745user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31746&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31747example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31748authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31749
31750The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31751rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31752&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31753ACL.
31754
31755Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31756specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31757or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31758&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31759using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31760separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31761
31762Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31763any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31764stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31765remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31766remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31767behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31768the &%count=%& option.
31769
31770
31771.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31772.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31773The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31774normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31775&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31776
31777The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31778the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31779&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31780&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31781
31782The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31783the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31784in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31785used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31786in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31787follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31788in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31789
31790The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31791accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31792&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31793&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31794ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31795in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31796recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31797
31798The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31799number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31800last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31801recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31802&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31803
31804The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31805condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31806command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31807multiple different commands.
31808
31809The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31810measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31811&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31812increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31813other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31814
31815The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31816
31817
31818.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31819.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31820You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31821control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31822mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31823
31824If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31825previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31826
31827For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31828it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31829can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31830in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31831new rate.
31832.code
31833acl_check_connect:
31834 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31835 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31836 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31837# ...
31838acl_check_mail:
31839 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31840 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31841 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31842.endd
31843
31844If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31845processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31846it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31847in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31848same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31849multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31850checks.
31851
31852The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31853use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31854update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31855&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31856next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31857
31858
31859.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31860.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31861If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31862engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31863&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31864counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31865rest of the ACL.
31866
31867The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31868updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31869client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31870up to the given limit.
31871This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31872consists of refusing the message, and
31873is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31874If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31875likely not what is wanted.
31876
31877The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31878updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31879of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31880actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31881counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31882pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31883again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31884attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31885.code
31886 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31887.endd
31888
31889
31890.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31891.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31892The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31893rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31894mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31895sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31896&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31897measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31898options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31899
31900For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31901has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31902rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31903per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31904go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31905recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31906
31907When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31908&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31909rate.
31910
31911The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31912other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31913unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31914required increases with larger limits.
31915
31916The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31917will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31918the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31919the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31920events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31921times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31922throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31923limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31924are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31925as intended.
31926
31927
31928.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31929Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31930when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31931(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31932policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31933message. For example:
31934.code
31935# Log all senders' rates
31936warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31937 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31938
31939# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31940# at the decimal point.
31941warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31942 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31943 $sender_rate_limit }s
31944
31945# Keep authenticated users under control
31946deny authenticated = *
31947 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31948
31949# System-wide rate limit
31950defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31951 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31952
31953# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31954# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31955defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31956 messages per $sender_rate_period
31957 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31958 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31959 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31960.endd
31961&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31962especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31963bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31964making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31965RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31966this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31967hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31968
31969
31970
31971.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31972.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31973.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31974Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31975&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31976&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31977The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31978verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31979other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31980.code
31981verify = sender/callout
31982verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31983.endd
31984The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31985address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31986difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31987be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31988(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31989The available options are as follows:
31990
31991.ilist
31992If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31993remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31994check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31995.next
31996If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31997normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31998options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31999verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32000.next
32001The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32002discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32003.next
32004The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32005immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32006generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32007discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32008.endlist
32009
32010.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32011.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32012.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32013.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32014After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32015error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32016coding like this:
32017.code
32018warn !verify = sender
32019 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32020.endd
32021If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32022denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32023verification failure.
32024
32025In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32026appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32027
32028.ilist
32029&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32030was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32031.next
32032&%route%&: Routing failed.
32033.next
32034&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32035occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32036connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32037.next
32038&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32039.next
32040&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32041.endlist
32042
32043The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32044rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32045
32046The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32047address verification to:
32048
32049.ilist
32050&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32051.endlist
32052
32053
32054
32055
32056.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32057.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32058.cindex "callout" "verification"
32059.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32060For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32061checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32062the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32063&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32064a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32065address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32066sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32067deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32068sender's domain.
32069
32070Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32071request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32072described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32073lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32074cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32075caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32076
32077Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32078the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32079callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32080callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32081on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32082
32083If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32084second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32085one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32086&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32087router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32088&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32089&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32090supplies a host list.
32091Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32092
32093The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32094remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32095specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32096specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32097specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32098the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32099&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32100
32101For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32102test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32103following SMTP commands are sent:
32104.display
32105&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32106&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32107&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32108&`QUIT`&
32109.endd
32110LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32111set to &"lmtp"&.
32112
32113The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32114settings.
32115
32116A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32117for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32118the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32119that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32120do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32121&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32122
32123If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32124succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32125Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32126hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32127&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32128
32129.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32130A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32131output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32132clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32133disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32134
32135
32136
32137
32138.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32139.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32140The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32141optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32142.code
32143verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32144.endd
32145The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32146separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32147deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32148
32149
32150.vlist
32151.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32152.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32153This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32154For example:
32155.code
32156verify = sender/callout=5s
32157.endd
32158The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32159remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32160the &%connect%& parameter.
32161
32162
32163.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32164.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32165This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32166for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32167.code
32168verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32169.endd
32170If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32171
32172.vitem &*defer_ok*&
32173.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32174When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32175of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32176updated in this circumstance.
32177
32178.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32179.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32180This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32181&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32182accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32183unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32184
32185
32186.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32187.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32188When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32189verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32190sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32191whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32192MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32193as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32194(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32195address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32196.code
32197require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32198.endd
32199This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32200
32201
32202.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32203.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32204This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32205For example:
32206.code
32207verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32208.endd
32209This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32210commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32211be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32212very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32213(for example, when network connections are timing out).
32214
32215
32216.vitem &*no_cache*&
32217.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32218.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32219When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32220
32221.vitem &*postmaster*&
32222.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32223When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32224check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32225rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32226the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32227used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32228made, until the cache record expires.
32229
32230.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32231The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32232You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32233For example:
32234.code
32235require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32236.endd
32237If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32238one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32239.code
32240require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32241.endd
32242&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32243account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32244a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32245postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32246
32247
32248.vitem &*random*&
32249.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32250When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32251check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32252really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32253&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32254.code
32255$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32256.endd
32257The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32258parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32259specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32260a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32261succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32262
32263.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32264.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32265This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32266.code
32267deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32268.endd
32269.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32270It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32271performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32272that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32273domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32274
32275.vitem &*use_sender*&
32276This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32277.code
32278require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32279.endd
32280It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32281command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32282need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32283sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32284usefulness of callout caching.
32285
32286.vitem &*hold*&
32287This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32288.code
32289require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32290.endd
32291It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32292and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32293Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32294when that is used for the connections.
32295The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32296(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32297if the use_sender option is used,
32298if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32299and if no other callouts intervene.
32300.endlist
32301
32302If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32303command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32304&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32305usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32306that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32307Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32308these circumstances.
32309
32310However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32311host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32312callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32313sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32314callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32315own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32316is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32317
32318Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32319caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32320by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32321actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32322
32323
32324
32325
32326.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32327.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32328.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32329.cindex "caching" "callout"
32330Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32331used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32332option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32333different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32334a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32335entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32336
32337When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32338the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32339is not available.
32340
32341The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32342independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32343(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32344
32345If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32346commands up to and including
32347.code
32348MAIL FROM:<>
32349.endd
32350(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32351any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32352domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32353making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32354separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32355&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32356&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32357
32358Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32359cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32360Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32361ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32362will eventually be noticed.
32363
32364The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32365being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32366behaviour will be the same.
32367
32368
32369
32370.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32371.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32372See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32373verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32374failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32375relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32376you might see:
32377.code
32378MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32379250 OK
32380RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32381550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32382550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32383550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32384550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32385550 Sender verification failed
32386.endd
32387If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32388only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32389out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32390&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32391example:
32392.code
32393verify = sender/no_details
32394.endd
32395
32396.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32397.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32398.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32399A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32400during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32401or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32402it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32403
32404.ilist
32405When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32406continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32407verification also fails.
32408.next
32409When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32410verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32411.endlist
32412
32413This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32414way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32415example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32416.code
32417A.Wol: aw123
32418aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32419.endd
32420work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32421redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32422mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32423verification to succeed.
32424
32425It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32426redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32427generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32428option. For example:
32429.code
32430require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32431.endd
32432In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32433the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32434
32435When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32436redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32437also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32438address and a report is output for each of them.
32439
32440
32441
32442.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32443.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32444Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32445which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32446special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32447domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32448Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32449.code
32450verify = csa
32451.endd
32452This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32453valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32454succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32455&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32456&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32457be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32458
32459The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32460detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32461looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32462address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32463
32464.ilist
32465The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32466.next
32467The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32468.next
32469The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32470(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32471.next
32472The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32473that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32474.endlist
32475
32476The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32477use for the DNS query. The default is:
32478.code
32479verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32480.endd
32481This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32482is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32483address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32484the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32485meaningful to say:
32486.code
32487verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32488.endd
32489In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32490This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32491&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32492
32493If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32494is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32495making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32496using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32497default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32498default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32499(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32500of legitimate HELO domains.
32501
32502The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32503direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32504search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32505addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32506lookup such as:
32507.code
32508${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32509.endd
32510has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32511The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32512authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32513
32514
32515
32516
32517.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32518.cindex "BATV, verifying"
32519Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32520of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32521Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32522recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32523bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32524spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32525
32526There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32527&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32528the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32529address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32530item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32531The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32532&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32533The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32534
32535As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32536database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32537like this:
32538.code
32539PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32540 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32541 }{$value}}
32542.endd
32543Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32544list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32545use this:
32546.code
32547# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32548deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32549 senders = :
32550 recipients = +batv_senders
32551
32552# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32553deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32554 senders = :
32555 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32556 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32557 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32558.endd
32559The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32560to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32561send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32562recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32563the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32564
32565A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32566&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32567prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32568the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32569the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32570timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32571of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32572
32573There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32574you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32575deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32576router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32577.code
32578batv_redirect:
32579 driver = redirect
32580 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32581.endd
32582This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32583of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32584address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32585local addresses.
32586
32587To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32588can be used:
32589.code
32590external_smtp_batv:
32591 driver = smtp
32592 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32593 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32594 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32595 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32596 {$value}fail}}}
32597.endd
32598If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32599
32600
32601
32602.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32603.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32604.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32605.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32606An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32607delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32608within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32609passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32610.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32611but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32612
32613Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32614A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32615relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32616a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32617with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32618same host is fulfilling both functions,
32619. ///
32620. as illustrated in the diagram below,
32621. ///
32622but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32623not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32624system to arbitrary domains.
32625
32626
32627You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32628runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32629Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32630example, suppose you want to do the following:
32631
32632.ilist
32633Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32634locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32635&'my.dom2.example'&.
32636.next
32637Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32638These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32639.next
32640Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32641Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32642.endlist
32643
32644
32645In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32646.code
32647domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32648domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32649hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32650.endd
32651Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32652command:
32653.code
32654acl_check_rcpt:
32655 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32656 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32657.endd
32658The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32659the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32660statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32661hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32662than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32663default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32664in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32665
32666
32667
32668.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32669.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32670You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32671that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32672the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32673.ecindex IIDacl
32674
32675
32676
32677. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32678. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32679
32680.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32681.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32682The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32683as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32684was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32685maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32686specification.
32687
32688It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32689&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32690scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32691messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32692chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32693
32694If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32695Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32696&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32697
32698.ilist
32699Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32700for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32701.next
32702Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32703&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32704run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32705.next
32706An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32707of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32708.next
32709Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32710conditions.
32711.next
32712Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32713.endlist
32714
32715Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32716added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32717changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32718EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32719this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32720&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32721
32722All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32723temporarily created in a file called:
32724.display
32725<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32726.endd
32727The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32728expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32729first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32730scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32731removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32732.code
32733control = no_mbox_unspool
32734.endd
32735has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32736same directory by default.
32737
32738
32739
32740.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32741.cindex "virus scanning"
32742.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32743.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32744The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32745It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32746specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32747in memory and thus are much faster.
32748
32749.new
32750Since message data needs to have arrived,
32751the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
32752&%acl_smtp_data%&,
32753&%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
32754&%acl_smtp_mime%& or
32755&%acl_smtp_dkim%&
32756.wen
32757
32758A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32759if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32760
32761.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32762You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32763to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32764are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32765.display
32766&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32767.endd
32768If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32769.code
32770av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32771.endd
32772If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32773before use.
32774The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32775The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32776though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32777
32778.vlist
32779.vitem &%avast%&
32780.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32781This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32782Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32783You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32784at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32785This scanner type takes one option,
32786which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32787or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32788The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32789single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32790A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32791Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32792the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32793
32794.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32795If &`pass_unscanned`&
32796is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32797decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32798care.
32799
32800For example:
32801.code
32802av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32803av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32804av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32805.endd
32806If you omit the argument, the default path
32807&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32808is used.
32809If you use a remote host,
32810you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32811as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32812For information about available commands and their options you may use
32813.code
32814$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32815 FLAGS
32816 SENSITIVITY
32817 PACK
32818.endd
32819
32820If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32821permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32822written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32823
32824.vitem &%aveserver%&
32825.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32826This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32827at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32828which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32829example:
32830.code
32831av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32832.endd
32833
32834
32835.vitem &%clamd%&
32836.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32837This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32838&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32839unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32840in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32841
32842The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32843a UNIX socket specification,
32844a TCP socket specification,
32845or a (global) option.
32846
32847A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32848For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32849for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32850and the second a port number,
32851Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32852These per-server options are supported:
32853.code
32854retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32855.endd
32856
32857The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32858a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32859
32860If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32861
32862Examples:
32863.code
32864av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32865av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32866av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32867av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32868av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32869.endd
32870If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32871&`local`&
32872option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32873to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32874more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32875Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32876
32877The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32878randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32879that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32880socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32881unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32882When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32883not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32884selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32885email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32886.code
328872013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32888 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32889 (Connection refused)
32890.endd
32891
32892If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32893contributing the code for this scanner.
32894
32895.vitem &%cmdline%&
32896.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32897This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32898used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32899type takes 3 mandatory options:
32900
32901.olist
32902The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32903and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32904
32905.next
32906A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32907virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32908absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32909the &"trigger"& expression.
32910
32911.next
32912Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32913match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32914&"name"& expression.
32915.endlist olist
32916
32917For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32918.code
32919Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32920.endd
32921For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32922name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32923for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32924configuration setting:
32925.code
32926av_scanner = cmdline:\
32927 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32928 found in file:'(.+)'
32929.endd
32930.vitem &%drweb%&
32931.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32932The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32933takes one option,
32934either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32935or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32936The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32937single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32938For example:
32939.code
32940av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32941av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32942.endd
32943If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32944is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32945
32946.vitem &%f-protd%&
32947.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32948The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32949One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32950(or port-range).
32951For example:
32952.code
32953av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32954.endd
32955If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32956
32957.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32958.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32959The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32960One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32961For example:
32962.code
32963av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32964.endd
32965If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32966
32967.vitem &%fsecure%&
32968.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32969The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32970argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32971.code
32972av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32973.endd
32974If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32975Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32976
32977.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32978.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32979This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32980Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32981scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32982For example:
32983.code
32984av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32985.endd
32986The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32987
32988.vitem &%mksd%&
32989.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32990This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32991though some documentation was available in English.
32992The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32993and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32994we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32995to integrate.
32996The only option for this scanner type is
32997the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32998provided that mksd has
32999been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33000.code
33001av_scanner = mksd:2
33002.endd
33003You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33004
33005.vitem &%sock%&
33006.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33007This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33008running on the local machine.
33009There are four options:
33010an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33011a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33012the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33013an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33014and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33015For example:
33016.code
33017av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33018.endd
33019Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33020there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33021The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33022Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33023specify an empty element to get this.
33024
33025.vitem &%sophie%&
33026.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33027Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33028You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33029for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33030client communication. For example:
33031.code
33032av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33033.endd
33034The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33035the option.
33036.endlist
33037
33038When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33039the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33040ACL.
33041
33042The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33043makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33044The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33045for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33046However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33047which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33048message.
33049
33050The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33051use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33052The first element can then be one of
33053
33054.ilist
33055&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33056The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33057recommended usage.
33058.next
33059&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33060the condition fails immediately.
33061.next
33062A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33063condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33064expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33065Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33066unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33067.endlist
33068
33069You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33070messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33071Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33072
33073You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33074specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33075For example:
33076.code
33077malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33078.endd
33079A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33080
33081.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33082When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33083is set to record the actual address used.
33084
33085.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33086When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33087&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33088&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33089logging data.
33090
33091Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33092imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33093
33094Here is a very simple scanning example:
33095.code
33096deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33097 malware = *
33098.endd
33099The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33100.code
33101deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33102 malware = */defer_ok
33103.endd
33104The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33105aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33106.code
33107av_scanner = $acl_m0
33108.endd
33109in the main Exim configuration.
33110.code
33111deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33112 set acl_m0 = sophie
33113 malware = *
33114
33115deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33116 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33117 malware = *
33118.endd
33119
33120
33121.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33122.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33123.cindex "spam scanning"
33124.cindex "SpamAssassin"
33125.cindex "Rspamd"
33126The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33127score and a report for the message.
33128Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33129
33130For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33131Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33132&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33133
33134SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33135.code
33136perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33137.endd
33138SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33139documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33140nicely, however.
33141
33142.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33143By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33144intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33145&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33146you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33147configuration as follows (example):
33148.code
33149spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33150.endd
33151The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33152If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33153iptables firewall, consider setting
33154&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33155timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33156server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33157connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33158soon.
33159
33160
33161To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33162on TCP port 11333)
33163you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33164.code
33165spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33166.endd
33167
33168As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33169sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33170filename instead of an address/port pair:
33171.code
33172spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33173.endd
33174You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33175reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33176&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33177option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33178.code
33179spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33180 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33181 192.168.2.12 783
33182.endd
33183Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33184When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33185servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33186condition defers.
33187
33188Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33189Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33190and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33191take care to not double the separator.
33192
33193For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33194subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33195and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33196In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33197
33198Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33199are options.
33200The supported options are:
33201.code
33202pri=<priority> Selection priority
33203weight=<value> Selection bias
33204time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33205retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33206tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33207variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33208.endd
33209
33210The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33211higher values being tried first.
33212The default priority is 1.
33213
33214The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33215Within a priority set
33216servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33217The default value for selection bias is 1.
33218
33219Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33220in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33221Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33222characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33223
33224Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33225are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33226
33227The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33228The default value is two minutes.
33229
33230The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33231a failed connect is made.
33232The default is to not retry.
33233
33234The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33235a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33236used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33237expansion.
33238
33239.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33240When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33241is set to record the actual address used.
33242
33243.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33244Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33245.code
33246deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33247 spam = joe
33248.endd
33249The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33250relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33251to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33252default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33253Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33254right-hand side.
33255
33256The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33257principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33258have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33259&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33260read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33261are not set.
33262Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33263(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33264after the first),
33265or the use of PRDR,
33266.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33267are needed to use this feature.
33268
33269The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33270you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33271&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33272
33273
33274Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33275large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33276are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33277example:
33278.code
33279deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33280 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33281 spam = nobody
33282.endd
33283
33284The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33285SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33286&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33287it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33288
33289.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33290When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33291variables.
33292Except for &$spam_report$&,
33293these variables are saved with the received message so are
33294available for use at delivery time.
33295
33296.vlist
33297.vitem &$spam_score$&
33298The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33299for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33300
33301.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33302The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33303example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33304because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33305The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33306
33307.vitem &$spam_bar$&
33308A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33309integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33310&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33311headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33312spam bar is 50 characters.
33313
33314.vitem &$spam_report$&
33315A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33316message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33317This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33318Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33319when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33320unencoded in headers.
33321
33322.vitem &$spam_action$&
33323For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33324spam score versus threshold.
33325For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33326
33327.endlist
33328
33329The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33330spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33331does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33332
33333The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33334the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33335failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33336statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33337spam condition, like this:
33338.code
33339deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33340 spam = joe/defer_ok
33341.endd
33342This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33343
33344Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33345condition:
33346.code
33347# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33348warn spam = nobody:true
33349 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33350 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33351
33352# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33353# is over threshold
33354warn spam = nobody
33355 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33356
33357# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33358deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33359 spam = nobody:true
33360 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33361.endd
33362
33363
33364
33365.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33366.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33367.cindex "MIME content scanning"
33368.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33369.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33370The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33371each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33372of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33373specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33374options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33375cases.
33376
33377These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33378ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33379the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33380message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33381ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33382result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33383&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33384
33385You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33386only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33387condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33388&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33389&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33390
33391At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33392information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33393of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33394parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33395part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33396syntax is:
33397.display
33398&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33399.endd
33400The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33401the value can be:
33402
33403.olist
33404&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33405.next
33406The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33407&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33408a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33409full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33410.next
33411A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33412directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33413is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33414the full path and filename.
33415.next
33416If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33417filename, and the default path is then used.
33418.endlist
33419The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33420errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33421a file with its original, proposed filename using
33422.code
33423decode = $mime_filename
33424.endd
33425However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33426anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33427automatically unlinked.
33428
33429For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33430content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33431as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33432variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33433before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33434
33435The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33436used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33437respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33438
33439.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33440The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33441available in the MIME ACL:
33442
33443.vlist
33444.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33445If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33446have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33447has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33448contains the empty string.
33449
33450.vitem &$mime_charset$&
33451This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33452&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33453.code
33454us-ascii
33455gb2312 (Chinese)
33456iso-8859-1
33457.endd
33458Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33459case-insensitively.
33460
33461.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33462This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33463header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33464implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33465only used for display purposes.
33466
33467.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33468This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33469header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33470
33471.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33472This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33473This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33474
33475.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33476This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33477successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33478size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33479has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33480
33481.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33482This variable contains the normalized content of the
33483&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33484type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33485
33486.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33487If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33488value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33489are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33490.code
33491text/plain
33492text/html
33493application/octet-stream
33494image/jpeg
33495audio/midi
33496.endd
33497If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33498empty string.
33499
33500.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33501This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33502successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33503containing the decoded data.
33504.endlist
33505
33506.cindex "RFC 2047"
33507.vlist
33508.vitem &$mime_filename$&
33509This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33510proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33511&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33512RFC2047
33513or RFC2231
33514decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33515 If no filename was
33516found, this variable contains the empty string.
33517
33518.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33519This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33520attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33521content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33522
33523The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33524cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33525follows:
33526
33527.olist
33528The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33529
33530.next
33531If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33532so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33533
33534.next
33535If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33536and the rest are attachments.
33537
33538.next
33539All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33540.endlist olist
33541
33542As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33543alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33544coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33545.code
33546deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33547!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33548condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33549condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33550.endd
33551.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33552This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33553&"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33554Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33555want to carry out specific actions on them.
33556
33557.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33558This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33559checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33560decoding is fully recursive.
33561
33562.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33563This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33564starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33565counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33566&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33567complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33568parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33569.endlist
33570
33571
33572
33573.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33574.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33575.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33576You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33577the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33578
33579The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33580matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33581MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33582linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33583have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33584
33585The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33586to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33587part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33588is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33589and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3359032K characters are checked.
33591
33592The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33593literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33594expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33595with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33596Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33597.code
33598deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33599 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33600.endd
33601The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33602&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33603matching regular expression.
33604The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33605are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33606
33607&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33608CPU-intensive.
33609
33610.ecindex IIDcosca
33611
33612
33613
33614
33615. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33616. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33617
33618.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33619 "Local scan function"
33620.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33621.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33622.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33623In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33624want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33625
33626The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33627passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33628a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33629condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33630non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33631
33632To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33633possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33634in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33635can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33636
33637The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33638when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33639It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33640well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33641
33642Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33643option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33644Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33645Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33646before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33647are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33648incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33649For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33650code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33651
33652
33653
33654.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33655.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33656To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33657function is before building Exim, by setting
33658both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33659LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33660&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33661directory, so you might set
33662.code
33663HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33664LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33665.endd
33666for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33667Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33668be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33669function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33670commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33671_src/local_scan.c_.
33672
33673If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33674for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33675.code
33676LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33677.endd
33678in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33679
33680
33681
33682
33683.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33684.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33685.cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33686You must include this line near the start of your code:
33687.code
33688#include "local_scan.h"
33689.endd
33690This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33691prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33692almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33693for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33694It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33695strings and pointers to character strings:
33696.code
33697#define CS (char *)
33698#define CCS (const char *)
33699#define CSS (char **)
33700#define US (unsigned char *)
33701#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33702#define USS (unsigned char **)
33703.endd
33704The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33705.code
33706extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33707.endd
33708The arguments are as follows:
33709
33710.ilist
33711&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33712(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33713recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33714
33715The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33716character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33717id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33718macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33719case this changes in some future version.
33720.next
33721&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33722string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33723.endlist
33724
33725The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33726
33727.vlist
33728.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33729.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33730The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33731the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33732newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33733maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33734
33735.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33736This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33737queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33738
33739.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33740This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33741queued without immediate delivery.
33742
33743.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33744The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33745passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33746they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33747&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33748used.
33749
33750.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33751The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33752message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33753problem"& is used.
33754
33755.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33756This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33757message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33758&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33759&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33760&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33761same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33762
33763.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33764This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33765LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33766.endlist
33767
33768If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33769reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33770&%-oe%& command line options.
33771
33772
33773
33774.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33775.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33776It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33777that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33778want to do this, you must have the line
33779.code
33780LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33781.endd
33782in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33783&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33784file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33785to define them.
33786
33787The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33788&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33789and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33790alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33791variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33792entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33793.code
33794static int my_integer_option = 42;
33795static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33796
33797optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33798 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33799 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33800};
33801
33802int local_scan_options_count =
33803 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33804.endd
33805The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33806configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33807.code
33808begin local_scan
33809my_integer = 99
33810my_string = some string of text...
33811.endd
33812The available types of option data are as follows:
33813
33814.vlist
33815.vitem &*opt_bool*&
33816This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33817variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33818that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33819whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33820TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33821values.)
33822
33823.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33824This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33825The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33826multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33827
33828.vitem &*opt_int*&
33829This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33830&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33831Exim.
33832
33833.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33834This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33835&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33836printed with the suffix K or M.
33837
33838.vitem &*opt_octint*&
33839This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33840octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33841always output in octal.
33842
33843.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33844This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33845variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33846
33847.vitem &*opt_time*&
33848This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33849type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33850.endlist
33851
33852If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33853out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33854
33855
33856
33857.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33858.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33859The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33860are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33861Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33862including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33863C variables are as follows:
33864
33865.vlist
33866.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33867This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33868It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33869
33870.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33871This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33872It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33873
33874.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33875This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33876is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33877&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33878
33879.ilist
33880The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33881testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33882other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33883
33884.next
33885The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33886by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33887of debugging bits.
33888.endlist ilist
33889
33890Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33891selected, you should use code like this:
33892.code
33893if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33894 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33895.endd
33896.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33897After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33898variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33899
33900.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33901A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33902discussed below.
33903
33904.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33905A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33906
33907.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33908The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33909
33910.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33911This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33912&%-bh%& command line option.
33913
33914.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33915The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33916is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33917
33918.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33919The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33920command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33921specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33922
33923.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33924This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33925&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33926
33927.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33928The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33929
33930.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33931The number of accepted recipients.
33932
33933.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33934.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33935.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33936The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33937&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33938can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33939below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33940adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33941&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33942value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33943blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33944and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33945
33946.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33947The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33948
33949.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33950The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33951locally-submitted messages.
33952
33953.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33954The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33955was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33956
33957.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33958The name of the sending host, if known.
33959
33960.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33961The port on the sending host.
33962
33963.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33964This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33965
33966.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33967This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33968
33969.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33970The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33971requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33972.endlist
33973
33974
33975.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33976The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33977You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33978(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33979their type to *.
33980
33981
33982.vlist
33983.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33984A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33985
33986.vitem &*int&~type*&
33987A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33988characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33989Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33990with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33991rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33992lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33993
33994.vitem &*int&~slen*&
33995The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33996internal newlines.
33997
33998.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33999A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34000a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34001.endlist
34002
34003
34004
34005.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34006The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34007
34008.vlist
34009.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34010This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34011
34012.vitem &*int&~pno*&
34013This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34014the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34015and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34016
34017.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34018If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34019recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34020envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34021router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34022an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34023&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34024is NULL for all recipients.
34025.endlist
34026
34027
34028
34029.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34030.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34031The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34032These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34033release:
34034
34035.vlist
34036.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34037 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34038
34039This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34040&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34041be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34042for the process in &%newumask%&.
34043
34044Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34045and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34046standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34047descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34048argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34049
34050The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34051
34052.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34053This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34054seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34055return value is as follows:
34056
34057.ilist
34058>= 0
34059
34060The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34061ending status.
34062
34063.next
34064< 0 and > &--256
34065
34066The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34067signal number.
34068
34069.next
34070&--256
34071
34072The process timed out.
34073.next
34074&--257
34075
34076The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34077.endlist
34078
34079.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34080This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34081Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34082want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34083forks a subprocess that is running
34084.code
34085exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34086.endd
34087and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34088that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34089of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34090recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34091
34092When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34093finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34094fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34095addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34096
34097
34098.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34099 *sender_authentication)*&
34100This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34101that it runs is:
34102.display
34103&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34104.endd
34105The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34106
34107
34108.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34109This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34110output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34111calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34112conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34113.code
34114if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34115 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34116.endd
34117
34118.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34119This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34120expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34121The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34122expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34123the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34124block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34125&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34126
34127.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34128This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34129existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34130character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34131substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34132if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34133
34134.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34135 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34136This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34137chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34138
34139If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34140&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34141NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34142matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34143&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34144found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34145marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34146option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34147top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34148headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34149.code
34150header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34151 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34152.endd
34153Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34154there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34155
34156
34157.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34158This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34159occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34160particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34161match the specification, the function does nothing.
34162
34163
34164.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34165 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34166This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34167a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34168colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34169&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34170.code
34171if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34172.endd
34173.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34174.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34175This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34176The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34177back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34178zero-terminated.
34179
34180.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34181This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34182zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34183to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34184string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34185yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34186easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34187added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34188
34189.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34190This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34191matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34192.display
34193&`OK `& match succeeded
34194&`FAIL `& match failed
34195&`DEFER `& match deferred
34196.endd
34197DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34198inability to contact a database.
34199
34200.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34201 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34202This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34203controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34204&'lss_match_domain()'&.
34205
34206.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34207 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34208This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34209controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34210matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34211
34212.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34213 uschar&~*list)*&"
34214This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34215expected to be
34216.code
34217lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34218.endd
34219.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34220An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34221is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34222looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34223values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34224returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34225failed.
34226
34227.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34228 *format,&~...)*&"
34229This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34230is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34231&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34232them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34233arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34234contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34235
34236
34237.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34238This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34239is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34240with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34241
34242This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34243described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34244the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34245value afterwards. For example:
34246.code
34247 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34248 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34249 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34250.endd
34251
34252.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34253This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34254recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34255matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34256address.
34257.endlist
34258
34259
34260.cindex "RFC 2047"
34261.vlist
34262.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34263 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34264This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34265these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34266from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34267a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34268made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34269binary string is returned with an error message.
34270
34271The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34272maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34273encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34274
34275.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34276.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34277If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34278contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34279not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34280
34281The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34282&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34283which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34284
34285If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34286argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34287set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34288returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34289with translation.
34290
34291
34292.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34293This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34294below.
34295
34296.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34297The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34298output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34299stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34300SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34301is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34302opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34303test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34304is involved.
34305
34306If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34307output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34308
34309Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34310must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34311LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34312LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34313initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34314to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34315that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34316.code
34317smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34318return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34319.endd
34320Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34321the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34322&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34323multiple output lines.
34324
34325The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34326does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34327the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34328detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34329you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34330dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34331arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34332is an error.
34333
34334.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34335This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34336chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34337runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34338
34339.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34340This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34341permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34342
34343.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34344See below.
34345
34346.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34347See below.
34348
34349.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34350These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34351The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34352number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34353and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34354pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34355more discussion.
34356.endlist
34357
34358
34359
34360.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34361.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34362No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34363The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34364recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34365to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34366message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34367terminates.
34368
34369Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34370data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34371connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34372one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34373
34374If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34375in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34376.code
34377store_pool = POOL_PERM
34378.endd
34379before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34380restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34381the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34382set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34383
34384The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34385&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34386There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34387block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34388&%store_pool%&.
34389.ecindex IIDlosca
34390
34391
34392
34393
34394. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34395. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34396
34397.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34398.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34399.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34400.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34401The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34402that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34403also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34404they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34405
34406The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34407is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34408It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34409commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34410The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34411
34412The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34413is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34414the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34415If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34416of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34417prevent it happening on retries.
34418
34419.vindex "&$domain$&"
34420.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34421&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34422specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34423&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34424you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34425independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34426described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34427
34428
34429.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34430.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34431.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34432The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34433setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34434other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34435&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34436.code
34437system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34438system_filter_user = exim
34439.endd
34440If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34441&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34442specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34443&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34444&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34445by the &%reply%& command.
34446
34447
34448.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34449You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34450filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34451are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34452
34453If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34454you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34455
34456
34457
34458.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34459The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34460files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34461mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34462available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34463If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34464they cause errors.
34465
34466.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34467There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34468files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34469is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34470&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34471subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34472manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34473
34474&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34475specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34476succeed, it will not be tried again.
34477If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34478arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34479
34480When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34481&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34482users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34483to which users' filter files can refer.
34484
34485
34486
34487.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34488.vindex "&$recipients$&"
34489The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34490of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34491filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34492
34493
34494
34495.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34496.cindex "freezing messages"
34497.cindex "message" "freezing"
34498.cindex "message" "forced failure"
34499.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34500.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34501.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34502There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34503always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34504filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34505for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34506word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34507.code
34508fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34509.endd
34510The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34511
34512The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34513message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34514and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34515delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34516that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34517run.
34518
34519The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34520not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34521filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34522is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34523
34524.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34525.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34526The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34527well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34528up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34529log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34530two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34531strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34532message. For example:
34533.code
34534fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34535 because it contains attachments that we are \
34536 not prepared to receive."
34537.endd
34538
34539.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34540Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34541the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34542the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34543command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34544Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34545use, for example
34546.code
34547if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34548then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34549.endd
34550though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34551alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34552generated by the filter.
34553
34554The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34555&%defer%&,
34556&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34557set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34558as
34559.code
34560mail ...
34561freeze
34562.endd
34563to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34564failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34565take place.
34566
34567
34568
34569.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34570.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34571.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34572.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34573Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34574.code
34575headers add <string>
34576headers remove <string>
34577.endd
34578The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34579added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34580filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34581space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34582forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34583
34584You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34585continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34586including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34587example:
34588.code
34589headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34590 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34591 X-header-2: ...."
34592.endd
34593Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34594be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34595space after input continuations is ignored.
34596
34597The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34598This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34599those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34600&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34601header with the same name, they are all removed.
34602
34603The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34604of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34605from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34606modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34607Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34608used for all recipients of the message.
34609
34610During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34611header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34612that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34613routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34614routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34615until the message is actually being written (see section
34616&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34617
34618If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34619added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34620present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34621present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34622message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34623conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34624modified more than once.
34625
34626Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34627use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34628For example:
34629.code
34630headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34631headers remove "Subject"
34632headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34633headers remove "Old-Subject"
34634.endd
34635
34636
34637
34638.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34639.cindex "envelope from"
34640.cindex "envelope sender"
34641In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34642.code
34643errors_to <some address>
34644.endd
34645in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34646delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34647user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34648might use
34649.code
34650unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34651.endd
34652to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34653address if its delivery failed.
34654
34655
34656
34657.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34658.vindex "&$domain$&"
34659.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34660In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34661delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34662operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34663such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34664filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34665which implements such a filter:
34666.code
34667central_filter:
34668 check_local_user
34669 driver = redirect
34670 domains = +local_domains
34671 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34672 no_verify
34673 allow_filter
34674 allow_freeze
34675.endd
34676The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34677&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34678the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34679use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34680
34681Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34682specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34683its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34684address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34685normal way.
34686.ecindex IIDsysfil1
34687.ecindex IIDsysfil2
34688.ecindex IIDsysfil3
34689
34690
34691
34692
34693
34694
34695. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34696. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34697
34698.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34699.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34700Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34701all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34702these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34703this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34704removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34705before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34706
34707Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34708&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34709that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34710its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34711set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34712
34713&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34714or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34715loopback interface specially in any way.
34716
34717If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34718that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34719
34720
34721
34722
34723.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34724.cindex "message" "submission"
34725.cindex "submission mode"
34726Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34727&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34728received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34729state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34730.code
34731control = submission
34732.endd
34733in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34734&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34735a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34736known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34737example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34738interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34739.code
34740warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34741 control = submission
34742.endd
34743.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34744There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34745is used to separate options. For example:
34746.code
34747control = submission/sender_retain
34748.endd
34749Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34750true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34751of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34752the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34753authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34754&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34755attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34756
34757When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34758domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34759example:
34760.code
34761control = submission/domain=some.domain
34762.endd
34763The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34764&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34765that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34766&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34767.code
34768accept authenticated = *
34769 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34770 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34771 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34772.endd
34773Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34774option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34775the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34776.code
34777bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34778.endd
34779then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34780line would be:
34781.code
34782Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34783.endd
34784.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34785By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34786used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34787specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34788
34789&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34790ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34791untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34792specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34793does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34794spoof another's address.
34795
34796.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34797.cindex "line endings"
34798.cindex "carriage return"
34799.cindex "linefeed"
34800RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34801linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34802SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34803conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34804use CRLF or just CR.
34805
34806Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34807using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34808receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34809Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34810MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34811has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34812that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34813other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34814follows:
34815
34816.ilist
34817LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34818.next
34819CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34820is ignored.
34821.next
34822The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34823nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34824terminator.
34825.next
34826If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34827the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34828is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34829people trying to play silly games.
34830.next
34831If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34832bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34833line.
34834.endlist
34835
34836
34837
34838
34839
34840.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34841.cindex "unqualified addresses"
34842.cindex "address" "qualification"
34843By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34844host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34845SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34846messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34847requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34848
34849Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34850sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34851&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34852cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34853value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34854
34855.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34856.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34857Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34858that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34859line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34860are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34861other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34862&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34863
34864
34865
34866
34867.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34868.cindex "&""From""& line"
34869.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34870.cindex "sender" "address"
34871.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34872.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34873.cindex "envelope from"
34874.cindex "envelope sender"
34875.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34876Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34877with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34878&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34879.code
34880From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34881From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34882.endd
34883This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34884Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34885via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34886such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34887&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34888and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34889regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34890default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34891that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34892
34893.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34894When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34895a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34896contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34897then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34898qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34899the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34900
34901If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34902sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34903that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34904
34905Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34906treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34907as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34908incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34909
34910
34911
34912.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34913.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34914.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34915RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34916&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34917recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34918&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34919&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34920
34921.blockquote
34922&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34923processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34924.endblockquote
34925
34926This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34927address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34928follows:
34929
34930.ilist
34931A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34932is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34933.next
34934If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34935&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34936&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34937.next
34938For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34939also removed.
34940.next
34941For a locally-submitted message,
34942if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34943&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34944the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34945included in log lines in this case.
34946.next
34947The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34948&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34949.endlist
34950
34951
34952
34953
34954.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34955Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34956includes the header line:
34957.code
34958Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34959.endd
34960
34961.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34962.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34963If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34964message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34965extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34966existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34967
34968
34969.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34970.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34971.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34972If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34973Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34974&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34975
34976.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34977.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34978.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34979&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34980set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34981the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34982in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34983set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34984messages.
34985
34986
34987.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34988.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34989.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34990.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34991&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34992Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34993generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34994messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34995(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34996messages.
34997
34998
34999.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35000.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35001.cindex "header lines" "From:"
35002.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35003.cindex "message" "submission"
35004.cindex "submission mode"
35005If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35006adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35007
35008.ilist
35009The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35010message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35011.next
35012.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35013The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35014.olist
35015.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35016If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35017&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35018.next
35019If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35020part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35021.next
35022If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35023&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35024.endlist
35025.endlist
35026
35027A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35028
35029If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35030line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35031containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35032are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35033They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35034&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35035&%qualify_domain%&.
35036
35037For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35038&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35039user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35040name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35041
35042
35043.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35044.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35045.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35046.cindex "message" "submission"
35047.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35048If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35049&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35050&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35051to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35052creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35053message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35054followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35055in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35056&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35057
35058
35059.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35060.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35061.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35062A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35063contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35064Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35065
35066The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35067have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35068line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35069that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35070
35071Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35072changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35073-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35074
35075
35076.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35077.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35078.cindex "header lines" "References:"
35079Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35080header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35081section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35082header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35083responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35084processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35085than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35086incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3508711 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35088
35089
35090
35091.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35092.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35093.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35094.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35095&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35096it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35097transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35098transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35099default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35100
35101
35102
35103.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35104.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35105.cindex "message" "submission"
35106.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35107For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35108existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35109these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35110&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35111control setting.
35112
35113When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35114&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35115control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35116&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35117that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35118&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35119be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35120appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35121line is added to the message.
35122
35123If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35124the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35125&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35126options true at the same time.
35127
35128.cindex "submission mode"
35129By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35130received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35131a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35132not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35133
35134.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35135First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35136authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35137created as follows:
35138
35139.ilist
35140.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35141If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35142&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35143.next
35144If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35145is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35146.next
35147If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35148&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35149.endlist
35150
35151This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35152are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35153added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35154by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35155
35156.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35157&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35158the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35159except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35160
35161
35162
35163.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35164 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35165.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35166.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35167When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35168specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35169process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35170modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35171as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35172
35173In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35174specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35175addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35176changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35177transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35178they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35179
35180&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35181the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35182expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35183
35184For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35185option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35186newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35187.code
35188headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35189 X-added-second: another added header line
35190.endd
35191Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35192
35193Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35194specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35195Each header-line is separately expanded.
35196
35197The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35198list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35199often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35200not part of the names. For example:
35201.code
35202headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35203.endd
35204
35205Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35206specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35207Each item is separately expanded.
35208Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35209form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35210will act as list separators.
35211
35212When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35213items are expanded at routing time,
35214and then associated with all addresses that are
35215accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35216an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35217forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35218
35219.oindex "&%unseen%&"
35220However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35221the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35222&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35223
35224Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35225settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35226dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35227requirements.
35228
35229The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35230with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35231these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35232recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35233consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35234names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35235instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35236
35237After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35238lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35239the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35240header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35241
35242This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35243the following consequences:
35244
35245.ilist
35246The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35247remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35248to it, at all times.
35249.next
35250Header lines that are added by a router's
35251&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35252expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35253.next
35254Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35255in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35256.next
35257Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35258a later router or by a transport.
35259.next
35260An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35261removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35262.code
35263headers_remove = subject
35264headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35265.endd
35266.endlist
35267
35268&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35269for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35270
35271
35272
35273
35274
35275.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35276.cindex "address" "constructed"
35277.cindex "constructed address"
35278When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35279the form
35280.display
35281<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35282.endd
35283For example:
35284.code
35285Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35286.endd
35287The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35288otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35289&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35290ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35291upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35292&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35293The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35294there is no password file entry.
35295
35296.cindex "RFC 2047"
35297In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35298parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35299characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35300including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35301&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35302characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35303&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35304is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35305
35306
35307
35308.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35309.cindex "case of local parts"
35310.cindex "local part" "case of"
35311RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35312be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35313addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35314because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35315routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35316original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35317router option.
35318
35319.cindex "mixed-case login names"
35320If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35321assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35322your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35323correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35324.code
35325correct_case:
35326 driver = redirect
35327 domains = +local_domains
35328 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35329 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35330 @$domain
35331.endd
35332For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35333(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35334up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35335on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35336local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35337
35338
35339
35340.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35341.cindex "dot" "in local part"
35342.cindex "local part" "dots in"
35343RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35344part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35345middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35346empty components for compatibility.
35347
35348
35349
35350.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35351.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35352Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35353happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35354in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35355&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35356
35357Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35358in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35359routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35360example, a header such as
35361.code
35362To: hare@teaparty
35363.endd
35364might get rewritten as
35365.code
35366To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35367.endd
35368Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35369does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35370been routed.
35371
35372Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35373addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35374result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35375deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35376immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35377routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35378.ecindex IIDmesproc
35379
35380
35381
35382. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35383. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35384
35385.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35386.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35387.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35388Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35389LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35390closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35391processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35392
35393.ilist
35394SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35395.next
35396SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35397.next
35398Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35399.endlist
35400
35401For mail delivery, the following are available:
35402
35403.ilist
35404SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35405.next
35406LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35407&"lmtp"&);
35408.next
35409LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35410transport);
35411.next
35412Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35413the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35414.endlist
35415
35416&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35417stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35418used to contain the envelope information.
35419
35420
35421
35422.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35423.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35424.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35425.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35426.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35427.cindex "EHLO"
35428.cindex "HELO"
35429.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35430Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35431The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35432processing is the same in both cases.
35433
35434If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35435parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35436command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35437&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35438such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35439.cindex "transport" "filter"
35440.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35441transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35442suppressed.
35443
35444If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35445pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35446required for the transaction.
35447
35448If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35449was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35450server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35451Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35452is called for verification.
35453
35454If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35455the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35456in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35457
35458.cindex "carriage return"
35459.cindex "linefeed"
35460Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35461LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35462order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35463line terminator.
35464
35465If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35466characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35467same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35468even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35469of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35470they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35471each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35472in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35473significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35474
35475When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35476message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35477records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35478particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35479
35480.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35481Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35482a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35483See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35484
35485.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35486.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35487When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35488looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35489messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35490creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35491a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35492so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35493does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35494turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35495
35496The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35497limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35498
35499.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35500The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35501identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35502square bracket of the IP address.
35503
35504
35505
35506
35507.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35508.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35509.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35510.cindex "host" "error"
35511Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35512message errors, and recipient errors.
35513
35514.vlist
35515.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35516A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35517particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35518
35519.ilist
35520Connection refused or timed out,
35521.next
35522Any error response code on connection,
35523.next
35524Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35525.next
35526Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35527.next
35528I/O errors at any time,
35529.next
35530Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35531the &"."& at the end of the data.
35532.endlist ilist
35533
35534For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35535EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35536error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35537host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35538the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35539alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35540host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35541made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35542
35543.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35544.cindex "message" "error"
35545A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35546particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35547message errors are:
35548
35549.ilist
35550Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35551the data,
35552.next
35553Timeout after MAIL,
35554.next
35555Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35556timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35557connection at any other time.
35558.endlist ilist
35559
35560For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35561to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35562temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35563addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35564a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35565message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35566that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35567time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35568affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35569it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35570
35571If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35572to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35573over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35574response to MAIL.
35575
35576.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35577.cindex "recipient" "error"
35578A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35579recipient errors are:
35580
35581.ilist
35582Any error response to RCPT,
35583.next
35584Timeout after RCPT.
35585.endlist
35586
35587For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35588recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35589sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35590address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35591used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35592routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35593operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35594to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35595if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35596(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35597have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35598the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35599the retry clock is reset.
35600
35601The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35602host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35603other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35604in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35605proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35606than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35607if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35608through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35609recipient's retry time.
35610.endlist
35611
35612In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35613current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35614tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35615own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35616until the next delivery attempt.
35617
35618Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35619MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35620would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35621host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35622What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35623is created.
35624
35625The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35626these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35627procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35628response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35629it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35630message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35631helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35632
35633Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35634host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35635or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35636the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35637then to be treated as a host error.
35638
35639There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35640terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35641reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35642should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35643host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35644
35645
35646
35647
35648.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35649.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35650.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35651.cindex "inetd"
35652.cindex "daemon"
35653Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35654listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35655&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35656.code
35657smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35658.endd
35659Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35660agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35661a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35662the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35663with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35664stream and exits with an error code.
35665
35666By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35667disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35668unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35669&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35670
35671.cindex "carriage return"
35672.cindex "linefeed"
35673Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35674LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35675order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35676line terminator.
35677Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35678sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35679sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35680
35681.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35682.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35683One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35684HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35685commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35686the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35687Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35688match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35689
35690.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35691.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35692The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35693a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35694&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35695false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35696&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35697value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35698message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35699
35700When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35701its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35702logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35703
35704The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35705prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35706number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35707&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35708rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35709
35710The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35711subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35712for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35713things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35714processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35715sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35716it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35717
35718When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35719and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35720high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35721&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35722applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35723
35724Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35725can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35726&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35727number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35728SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35729&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35730subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35731a delivery process.
35732
35733The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35734&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35735started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35736handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35737however, available with &'inetd'&.
35738
35739Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35740are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35741to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35742section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35743
35744Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35745MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35746&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35747
35748
35749
35750.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35751.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35752If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35753commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35754the error response to the last command. The default value for
35755&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35756abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35757circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35758
35759
35760.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35761.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35762.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35763A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35764something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35765address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35766sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35767&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35768drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35769default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35770broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35771
35772
35773
35774.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35775.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35776The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35777DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35778many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35779denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35780client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35781defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35782
35783When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35784allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35785but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35786or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35787starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35788counted.
35789
35790The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35791STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35792RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35793
35794You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35795&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35796&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35797the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35798specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35799
35800
35801
35802
35803.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35804When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35805runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35806appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35807
35808.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35809When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35810setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35811(with a 252 SMTP response code)
35812in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35813When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35814called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35815SMTP response codes.
35816
35817.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35818If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35819When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35820EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35821than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35822as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35823of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35824VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35825RCPT failures.
35826
35827
35828
35829.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35830.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35831RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35832overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35833disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35834the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35835should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35836
35837The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35838delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35839the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35840text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35841specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35842the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35843argument. For example,
35844.code
35845ETRN #brigadoon
35846.endd
35847runs the command
35848.code
35849exim -R brigadoon
35850.endd
35851which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35852containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35853default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35854for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35855a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35856
35857.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35858Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35859record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35860the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35861the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35862a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35863left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35864Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35865
35866.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35867For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35868used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35869whatever the form of its argument. For
35870example:
35871.code
35872smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35873 $sender_host_address
35874.endd
35875.vindex "&$domain$&"
35876The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35877expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35878and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35879wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35880under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35881for it to change them before running the command.
35882
35883
35884
35885.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35886.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35887Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35888standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35889line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35890&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35891messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35892sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35893an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35894identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35895runs for RCPT commands:
35896.code
35897accept hosts = :
35898.endd
35899This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35900
35901
35902
35903.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35904.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35905.cindex "batched SMTP output"
35906Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35907batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35908be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35909delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35910envelope along with the message.
35911
35912The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35913MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35914the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35915HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35916can be used to specify it.
35917
35918Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35919one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35920to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35921this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35922chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35923
35924.vindex "&$host$&"
35925When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35926sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35927transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35928router:
35929.code
35930begin routers
35931route_append:
35932 driver = manualroute
35933 transport = smtp_appendfile
35934 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35935
35936begin transports
35937smtp_appendfile:
35938 driver = appendfile
35939 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35940 batch_max = 1000
35941 use_bsmtp
35942 user = exim
35943.endd
35944This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35945format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35946message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35947
35948
35949
35950.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35951.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35952.cindex "batched SMTP input"
35953The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35954reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35955is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35956sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35957rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35958and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35959as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35960
35961Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35962ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35963
35964If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35965the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35966standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35967make some use of automatically, for example:
35968.code
35969554 Unexpected end of file
35970Transaction started in line 10
35971Error detected in line 14
35972.endd
35973It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35974file, for example:
35975.code
35976An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35977The error message was:
35978
35979501 '>' missing at end of address
35980
35981The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35982The error was detected in line 12.
35983The SMTP command at fault was:
35984
35985rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35986
359871 previous message was successfully processed.
35988The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35989.endd
35990The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35991messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35992accepted.
35993.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35994.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35995
35996
35997
35998. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35999. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36000
36001.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36002 "Customizing messages"
36003When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36004configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36005to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36006the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36007string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36008
36009The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36010cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36011option. Exim also adds the line
36012.code
36013Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36014.endd
36015to all warning and bounce messages,
36016
36017
36018.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36019.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36020.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36021If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36022message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36023delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36024&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36025
36026When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36027constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36028separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36029opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36030logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36031item.
36032
36033.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36034.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36035Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36036expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36037the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36038&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36039option, rounded to a whole number.
36040
36041The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36042
36043.ilist
36044The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36045&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36046.next
36047The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36048failing addresses with their error messages.
36049.next
36050The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36051returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36052.next
36053The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36054The fields exist for back-compatibility
36055.endlist
36056
36057The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36058following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36059other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36060.code
36061Subject: Mail delivery failed
36062 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36063 {: returning message to sender}}
36064****
36065This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36066
36067A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36068 {that you sent }{sent by
36069
36070<$sender_address>
36071
36072}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36073This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36074****
36075The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36076****
36077------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36078 ------
36079****
36080------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36081 only the first
36082------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36083****
36084.endd
36085.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36086.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36087.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36088The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36089warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36090text sections:
36091
36092.ilist
36093The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36094&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36095.next
36096The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36097the delayed addresses.
36098.next
36099The third item then ends the message.
36100.endlist
36101
36102The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36103have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36104.code
36105Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36106 $warn_message_delay
36107****
36108This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36109
36110A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36111{that you sent }{sent by
36112
36113<$sender_address>
36114
36115}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36116more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36117
36118The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36119The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36120The date of the message is: $h_date
36121
36122The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36123****
36124No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36125continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36126intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36127mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36128the message will be returned to you.
36129.endd
36130.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36131.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36132However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36133appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36134&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36135minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36136of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36137multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36138handled them.
36139
36140
36141
36142
36143. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36144. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36145
36146.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36147This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36148common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36149
36150
36151
36152.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36153.cindex "smart host" "example router"
36154If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36155should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36156routing explicitly:
36157.code
36158send_to_smart_host:
36159 driver = manualroute
36160 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36161 transport = remote_smtp
36162.endd
36163You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36164If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36165receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36166synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36167&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36168
36169
36170
36171
36172.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36173.cindex "mailing lists"
36174Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36175requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36176Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36177
36178The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36179is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36180independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36181lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36182.code
36183lists:
36184 driver = redirect
36185 domains = lists.example
36186 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36187 forbid_pipe
36188 forbid_file
36189 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36190 no_more
36191.endd
36192This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36193in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36194such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36195routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36196
36197The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36198expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36199a mailing list.
36200
36201.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36202The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36203taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36204original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36205the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36206
36207For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36208&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36209&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36210&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36211There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36212the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36213such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36214or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36215&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36216
36217
36218
36219.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36220.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36221If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36222delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36223list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36224list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36225addresses are not rigorously checked.
36226
36227If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36228entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36229&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36230whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36231&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36232
36233
36234
36235.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36236.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36237Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36238in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36239recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36240cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36241delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36242account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36243the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36244message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36245
36246If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36247on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36248router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36249&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36250&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36251subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36252failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36253pre-existing messages.
36254
36255The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36256addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36257addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36258&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36259one level of expansion anyway.
36260
36261
36262
36263.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36264.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36265The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36266send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36267from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36268&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36269
36270The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36271of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36272.code
36273lists_request:
36274 driver = redirect
36275 domains = lists.example
36276 local_part_suffix = -request
36277 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36278 no_more
36279
36280lists_post:
36281 driver = redirect
36282 domains = lists.example
36283 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36284 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36285 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36286 forbid_pipe
36287 forbid_file
36288 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36289 no_more
36290
36291lists_closed:
36292 driver = redirect
36293 domains = lists.example
36294 allow_fail
36295 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36296.endd
36297All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36298they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36299&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36300mailing list.
36301
36302The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36303checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36304checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36305necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36306because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36307not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36308means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36309&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36310&"unrouteable address"& error.
36311
36312The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36313a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36314the address, giving a suitable error message.
36315
36316
36317
36318
36319.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36320.cindex "VERP"
36321.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36322.cindex "envelope from"
36323.cindex "envelope sender"
36324Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36325are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36326address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36327the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36328if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36329original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36330
36331.oindex &%errors_to%&
36332.oindex &%return_path%&
36333Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36334facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36335list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36336these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36337host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36338of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36339of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36340.code
36341verp_smtp:
36342 driver = smtp
36343 max_rcpt = 1
36344 return_path = \
36345 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36346 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36347.endd
36348This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36349SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36350&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36351local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36352example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36353&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36354&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36355rewritten as
36356.code
36357somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36358.endd
36359.vindex "&$local_part$&"
36360For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36361have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36362achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36363might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36364&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36365
36366Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36367probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36368extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36369can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36370.code
36371dnslookup:
36372 driver = dnslookup
36373 domains = ! +local_domains
36374 transport = \
36375 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36376 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36377 no_more
36378.endd
36379If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36380of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36381routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36382errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36383address.
36384
36385On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36386&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36387SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36388and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36389of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36390.code
36391verp_dnslookup:
36392 driver = dnslookup
36393 domains = ! +local_domains
36394 transport = remote_smtp
36395 errors_to = \
36396 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36397 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36398 no_more
36399.endd
36400Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36401configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36402Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36403router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36404them.
36405
36406The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36407message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36408host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36409a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36410a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36411than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36412used).
36413
36414
36415
36416
36417
36418
36419.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36420.cindex "virtual domains"
36421.cindex "domain" "virtual"
36422The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36423meanings:
36424
36425.ilist
36426A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36427aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36428top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36429.next
36430One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36431with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36432have login accounts on that host.
36433.endlist
36434
36435The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36436the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36437aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36438virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36439whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36440to a router of this form:
36441.code
36442virtual:
36443 driver = redirect
36444 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36445 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36446 no_more
36447.endd
36448The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36449is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36450domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36451part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36452setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36453string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36454
36455This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36456follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36457can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36458a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36459
36460The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36461way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36462valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36463.code
36464my_domains:
36465 driver = accept
36466 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36467 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36468 transport = my_mailboxes
36469.endd
36470The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36471can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36472file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36473option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36474because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36475follows:
36476.code
36477my_mailboxes:
36478 driver = appendfile
36479 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36480 user = mail
36481.endd
36482This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36483required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36484
36485The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36486requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36487up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36488information about the domains.
36489
36490
36491
36492.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36493.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36494.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36495.cindex "local part" "prefix"
36496.cindex "local part" "suffix"
36497Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36498incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36499allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36500identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36501parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36502&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36503example, consider this router:
36504.code
36505userforward:
36506 driver = redirect
36507 check_local_user
36508 file = $home/.forward
36509 local_part_suffix = -*
36510 local_part_suffix_optional
36511 allow_filter
36512.endd
36513.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36514It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36515&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36516cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36517.code
36518if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36519save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36520endif
36521.endd
36522If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36523fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36524&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36525control over which suffixes are valid.
36526
36527Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36528&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36529another MTA:
36530.code
36531userforward:
36532 driver = redirect
36533 check_local_user
36534 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36535 local_part_suffix = -*
36536 local_part_suffix_optional
36537 allow_filter
36538.endd
36539If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36540example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36541does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36542subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36543&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36544
36545
36546
36547.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36548.cindex "vacation processing"
36549The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36550a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36551(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36552This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36553that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36554
36555.ilist
36556A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36557can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36558alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36559&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36560.code
36561spqr, vacation-spqr
36562.endd
36563.next
36564The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36565vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36566user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36567ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36568to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36569message.
36570.endlist
36571
36572Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36573use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36574
36575
36576
36577.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36578.cindex "message" "copying every"
36579Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36580be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36581command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36582each day's messages.
36583
36584There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36585messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36586delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36587notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36588
36589
36590
36591.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36592.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36593It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36594Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36595arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36596permanently connected.
36597
36598Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36599particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36600Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36601
36602
36603.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36604It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36605host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36606approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36607being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36608some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36609to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36610resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36611
36612A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36613intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36614into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36615format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36616destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36617in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36618if required.
36619
36620On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36621you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36622intermittent host. For example:
36623.code
36624cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36625.endd
36626This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36627which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36628online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36629options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36630causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36631connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36632immediately.
36633
36634If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36635issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36636mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36637used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36638avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36639Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36640arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36641
36642
36643
36644.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36645The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36646increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36647connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36648delivered immediately.
36649
36650.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36651.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36652.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36653Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36654not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36655possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36656each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36657avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36658&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36659first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36660normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36661destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36662single SMTP connection.
36663
36664
36665
36666. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36667. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36668
36669.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36670 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36671.cindex "client, non-queueing"
36672.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36673On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36674email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36675configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36676However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36677configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36678&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36679messages this way.
36680
36681If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36682run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36683any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36684continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36685email is not desirable.
36686
36687There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36688&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36689any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36690host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36691informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36692to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36693to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36694
36695There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36696that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36697ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36698before sending a message to the smart host.
36699
36700Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36701tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36702overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36703
36704.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36705There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36706Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36707assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36708just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36709compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36710router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36711
36712When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36713following ways:
36714
36715.ilist
36716A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36717In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36718.next
36719Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36720assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36721&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36722does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36723successful, a zero return code is given.
36724.next
36725Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36726be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36727the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36728must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36729deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36730are.
36731.next
36732If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36733failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36734successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36735.next
36736Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36737is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36738smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36739the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36740there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36741.next
36742If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36743connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36744failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36745.next
36746When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36747(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36748value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36749are ever generated.
36750.next
36751No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36752.next
36753A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36754true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36755&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36756.endlist
36757
36758The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36759the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36760deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36761privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36762to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36763the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36764
36765
36766
36767
36768. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36769. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36770
36771.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36772.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36773.cindex "log" "types of"
36774Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36775and the panic log:
36776
36777.ilist
36778.cindex "main log"
36779The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36780line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36781down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36782out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36783them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36784they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36785analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36786&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36787.next
36788.cindex "reject log"
36789The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36790of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36791The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36792the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36793is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36794lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36795reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36796host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36797can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36798false.
36799.next
36800.cindex "panic log"
36801.cindex "system log"
36802When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36803error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36804are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36805other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36806therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36807regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36808panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36809is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36810message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36811.endlist
36812
36813Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36814example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36815In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36816.code
368172001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36818 by QUIT
36819.endd
36820By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36821ways of changing this:
36822
36823.ilist
36824You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36825you set
36826.code
36827timezone = UTC
36828.endd
36829the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36830.next
36831If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36832example:
36833.code
368342003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36835.endd
36836.endlist
36837
36838.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36839.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36840Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36841request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36842&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36843brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36844
36845
36846
36847
36848.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36849.cindex "log" "destination"
36850.cindex "log" "to file"
36851.cindex "log" "to syslog"
36852.cindex "syslog"
36853The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36854should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36855are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36856arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36857It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36858need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36859Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36860
36861The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36862&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36863configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36864references to the host name:
36865.code
36866log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36867.endd
36868It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36869rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36870start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36871before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36872configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36873log at all.
36874
36875The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36876list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36877facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36878colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36879otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36880point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36881implying the use of a default path.
36882
36883When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36884LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36885&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36886mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36887files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36888equivalent to the setting:
36889.code
36890log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36891.endd
36892If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36893or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36894that is where the logs are written.
36895
36896A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36897are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36898
36899Here are some examples of possible settings:
36900.display
36901&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36902&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36903&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36904&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36905.endd
36906If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36907error is logged.
36908
36909
36910
36911.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36912.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36913.cindex "cycling logs"
36914.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36915.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36916Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36917log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36918provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36919main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36920keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36921
36922An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36923and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36924example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36925message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36926that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36927something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36928ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36929&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36930does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36931tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36932for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36933renamed.
36934
36935
36936
36937.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36938.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36939Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36940periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36941for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36942&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36943the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36944point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36945.code
36946log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36947log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36948log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36949log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36950.endd
36951As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36952examples of names generated by the above examples:
36953.code
36954/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36955/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36956/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36957/var/log/exim/main.200212
36958.endd
36959When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36960files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36961will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36962run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36963
36964The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36965is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36966When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36967the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36968non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36969character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36970log names:
36971.code
36972/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36973/var/log/exim-panic.log
36974/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36975/var/log/exim/panic
36976.endd
36977
36978
36979.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36980.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36981The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36982except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36983Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36984that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36985&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36986by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36987&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36988SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36989&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36990LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36991the time and host name to each line.
36992The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36993
36994.ilist
36995&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36996.next
36997&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36998.next
36999&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37000.endlist
37001
37002Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37003written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37004these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37005by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37006
37007Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37008entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37009these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37010calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37011870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37012additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37013replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37014RFC 3164, you should set
37015.code
37016SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37017.endd
37018in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37019lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37020
37021To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37022entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37023where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37024components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37025because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37026delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37027870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37028&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37029name, and pid as added by syslog:
37030.code
37031[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37032[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37033[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37034[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37035[5/5] mple>)
37036.endd
37037The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37038(LOG_NOTICE):
37039.code
37040[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37041[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37042[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37043[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37044[5\18] .example>)
37045[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37046[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37047[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37048[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37049[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37050[11\18] 09:43 +0100
37051[12\18] F From: <>
37052[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37053[18\18] X-something: this is another header
37054[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37055[16\18] le>
37056[17\18] B Bcc:
37057[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37058.endd
37059Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37060without modification.
37061
37062If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37063display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37064the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37065where it is.
37066
37067
37068
37069.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37070One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37071successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37072picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37073timestamp. The flags are:
37074.display
37075&`<=`& message arrival
37076&`(=`& message fakereject
37077&`=>`& normal message delivery
37078&`->`& additional address in same delivery
37079&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37080&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37081&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37082&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37083.endd
37084
37085
37086.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37087.cindex "log" "reception line"
37088The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37089message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37090several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37091.code
370922002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37093 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37094 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37095.endd
37096The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37097bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37098generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37099.code
37100R=<message id>
37101.endd
37102which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37103
37104.cindex "HELO"
37105.cindex "EHLO"
37106For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37107record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37108received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37109host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37110above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37111&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37112by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37113verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37114EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37115name in parentheses.
37116
37117Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37118without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37119the log containing text like these examples:
37120.code
37121H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37122H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37123.endd
37124This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37125on.
37126
37127For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37128the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37129of Exim.
37130
37131.cindex "authentication" "logging"
37132.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37133For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37134message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37135of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37136extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37137session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37138suite that was used.
37139
37140.cindex log protocol
37141The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37142hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37143value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37144there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37145was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37146&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37147authenticator name.
37148
37149.cindex "size" "of message"
37150The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37151received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37152headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37153message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37154other).
37155
37156The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37157data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37158
37159
37160
37161.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37162.cindex "log" "delivery line"
37163The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37164delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37165deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37166to fit it on the page:
37167.code
371682002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37169 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
371702002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37171 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37172 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37173.endd
37174For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37175after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37176intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37177last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37178fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37179
37180If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37181followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37182If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37183option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37184
37185If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37186for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37187.display
37188&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37189.endd
37190If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37191parentheses afterwards.
37192
37193.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37194When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37195SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37196flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37197down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37198lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37199When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37200DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37201will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37202TLS cipher information is still available.
37203
37204.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37205.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37206When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37207line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37208rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37209
37210The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37211&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37212
37213The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37214data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37215
37216
37217.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37218.cindex "discarded messages"
37219.cindex "message" "discarded"
37220.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37221When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37222obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37223.code
372242002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37225 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37226.endd
37227is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37228because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37229.code
372301999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37231 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37232.endd
37233
37234
37235.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37236When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37237.code
372382002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37239 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37240.endd
37241In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37242last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37243written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37244.code
372452002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37246 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37247.endd
37248When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37249a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37250appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37251
37252
37253
37254.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37255.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37256If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37257following form is logged:
37258.code
372591995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37260 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37261.endd
37262If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37263the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37264.code
372652002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37266 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37267 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37268 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37269 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37270.endd
37271The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37272used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37273disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37274flagged with &`**`&.
37275
37276
37277
37278.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37279.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37280If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37281used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37282&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37283
37284
37285
37286.section "Completion" "SECID257"
37287A line of the form
37288.code
372892002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37290.endd
37291is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37292at the end of its processing.
37293
37294
37295
37296
37297.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37298.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37299A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37300the following table:
37301.display
37302&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37303&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37304&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37305&`CV `& certificate verification status
37306&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37307&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37308&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37309&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37310&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37311&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37312&`H `& host name and IP address
37313&`I `& local interface used
37314&`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37315&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37316&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37317&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37318&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37319&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37320&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37321&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37322&`Q `& alternate queue name
37323&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37324&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37325&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37326&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37327&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37328&`S `& size of message in bytes
37329&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37330&`ST `& shadow transport name
37331&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37332&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37333&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37334&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37335&`X `& TLS cipher suite
37336.endd
37337
37338
37339.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37340Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37341self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37342
37343.ilist
37344.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37345&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37346during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37347This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37348during the first delivery attempt.
37349.next
37350&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37351temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37352for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37353.next
37354.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37355&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37356some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37357common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37358&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37359doing.
37360.next
37361.cindex "error" "ignored"
37362&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37363message:
37364.olist
37365Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37366&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37367.next
37368A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37369failed. The delivery was discarded.
37370.next
37371A delivery set up by a router configured with
37372. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37373. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37374.code
37375 errors_to = <>
37376.endd
37377failed. The delivery was discarded.
37378.endlist olist
37379.next
37380.cindex DKIM "log line"
37381&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37382logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37383.endlist ilist
37384
37385
37386
37387
37388
37389.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37390.cindex "log" "selectors"
37391By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37392default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37393&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37394example:
37395.code
37396log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37397.endd
37398The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37399selection marked by asterisks:
37400.display
37401&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37402&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37403&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37404&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37405&` arguments `& command line arguments
37406&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37407&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37408&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37409&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37410&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37411&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37412&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37413&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37414&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37415&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37416&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37417&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37418&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37419&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37420&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37421&`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37422&` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37423&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37424&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37425&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37426&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37427&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37428&` pid `& Exim process id
37429&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37430&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37431&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37432&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37433&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37434&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37435&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37436&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37437&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37438&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37439&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37440&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37441&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37442&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37443&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37444&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37445&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37446&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37447&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37448&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37449&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37450&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37451&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37452&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37453&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37454
37455&` all `& all of the above
37456.endd
37457See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37458section &<<SECID99>>&
37459
37460More details on each of these items follows:
37461
37462.ilist
37463.cindex "8BITMIME"
37464.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37465&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37466which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37467that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37468&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37469&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37470.next
37471.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37472&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37473its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37474this log selector is set.
37475.next
37476.cindex "log" "rewriting"
37477.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37478&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37479rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37480such users cannot access the log).
37481.next
37482.cindex "log" "full parentage"
37483&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37484delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37485parentheses between them.
37486.next
37487.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37488.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37489&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37490to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37491feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37492&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37493privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37494that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37495are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37496because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37497only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37498between the caller and Exim.
37499.next
37500.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37501&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37502connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37503.next
37504.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37505.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37506&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37507started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37508messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37509process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37510.next
37511.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37512&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37513perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37514If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37515precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37516.next
37517.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37518.cindex "size" "of message"
37519&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37520the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37521.next
37522.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37523.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37524&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37525verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37526.next
37527.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37528.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37529&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37530.next
37531.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37532.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37533.cindex "black list (DNS)"
37534&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37535DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37536.next
37537.cindex log dnssec
37538.cindex dnssec logging
37539&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37540dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37541For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37542It does not cover helo-name verification.
37543For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37544.next
37545.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37546.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37547&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37548is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37549command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37550selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37551.next
37552.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37553&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37554any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37555log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37556routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37557.next
37558.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37559.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37560&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37561client's ident port times out.
37562.next
37563.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37564.cindex "log" "local interface"
37565.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37566.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37567.cindex "interface" "logging"
37568&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37569to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37570followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37571added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37572rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37573The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37574.next
37575.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37576.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37577.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37578&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37579of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37580on a proxied connection
37581or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37582See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37583.next
37584.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37585.cindex "port" "logging remote"
37586.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37587.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37588.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37589&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37590added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37591in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37592changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37593&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37594important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37595.next
37596.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37597&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37598connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37599.next
37600.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37601.cindex millisecond logging
37602.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37603&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37604appended to the seconds value.
37605.next
37606.new
37607.cindex "log" "message id"
37608&%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37609.next
37610&%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37611This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37612(submission mode) without one.
37613The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37614.wen
37615.next
37616.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37617.cindex "log" "local interface"
37618.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37619.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37620.cindex "interface" "logging"
37621&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37622interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37623followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37624off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37625.next
37626.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37627.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37628.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37629&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37630containing => tags) following the IP address.
37631The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37632&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37633This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37634configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37635local port is a random ephemeral port.
37636.next
37637.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37638.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37639&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37640immediately after the time and date.
37641.next
37642.cindex log pipelining
37643.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37644&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37645log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37646The field is a single "L".
37647
37648On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37649the field has a minus appended.
37650
37651.new
37652.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37653If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37654accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37655offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37656Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37657.wen
37658
37659.next
37660.cindex "log" "queue run"
37661.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37662&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37663.next
37664.cindex "log" "queue time"
37665&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37666local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37667&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37668includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37669This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37670delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37671message has been successfully received.
37672If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37673precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37674.next
37675&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37676the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37677example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37678message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37679.next
37680.cindex "log" "receive duration"
37681&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37682perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37683If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37684precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37685.next
37686.cindex "log" "recipients"
37687&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37688as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37689that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37690addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37691has taken place.
37692Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37693in the list.
37694.next
37695.cindex "log" "sender reception"
37696&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37697the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37698&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37699.next
37700.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37701&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37702rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37703log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37704rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37705.next
37706.cindex "log" "retry defer"
37707&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37708retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37709message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37710attempt.
37711.next
37712.cindex "log" "return path"
37713&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37714the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37715This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37716or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37717.next
37718.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37719&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37720and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37721This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37722necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37723.next
37724.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37725&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37726gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37727the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37728detail is lost.
37729.next
37730.cindex "log" "size rejection"
37731&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37732it is too big.
37733.next
37734.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37735.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37736&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37737queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37738it.
37739.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37740The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37741.next
37742.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37743.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37744.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37745&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37746outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37747A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37748response.
37749.next
37750.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37751.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37752&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37753established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37754&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37755only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37756processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37757dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37758not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37759of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37760
37761For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37762included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37763reset if the daemon is restarted.
37764Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37765subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37766whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37767match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37768logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37769.next
37770.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37771.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37772&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37773RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37774and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37775line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37776.next
37777.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37778.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37779&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37780connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37781the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37782does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37783an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37784already have their own log lines.
37785
37786The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37787way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37788If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37789an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37790DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37791the same logging options.
37792
37793Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37794is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37795.code
37796C=EHLO,QUIT
37797.endd
37798shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37799than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37800the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37801setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37802have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37803.next
37804&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37805colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37806log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37807was accepted or used.
37808.next
37809.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37810.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37811&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37812encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37813because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37814been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37815it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37816received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37817.next
37818.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37819.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37820.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37821.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37822.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37823&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37824encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37825external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37826using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37827.next
37828.cindex "log" "subject"
37829.cindex "subject, logging"
37830&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37831preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37832Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37833specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37834unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37835.next
37836.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37837.cindex log DANE
37838.cindex DANE logging
37839&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37840when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37841verified
37842using a CA trust anchor,
37843&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37844and &`CV=no`& if not.
37845.next
37846.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37847.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37848&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37849connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37850.next
37851.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37852.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37853&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37854connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37855added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37856.next
37857.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37858.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37859&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37860the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37861added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37862.next
37863.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37864&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37865result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37866.endlist
37867
37868
37869.section "Message log" "SECID260"
37870.cindex "message" "log file for"
37871.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37872.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37873.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37874In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37875that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37876they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37877message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37878makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37879to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37880is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37881only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37882
37883On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37884per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37885&%message_logs%& option false.
37886.ecindex IIDloggen
37887
37888
37889
37890
37891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37892. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37893
37894.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37895.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37896A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37897described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37898the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37899
37900.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37901.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37902 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37903.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37904.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37905.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37906.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37907 various criteria"
37908.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37909.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37910 "extract statistics from the log"
37911.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37912 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37913.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37914.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37915.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37916.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37917.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37918.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37919.endtable
37920
37921Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37922&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37923&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37924
37925
37926
37927
37928.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37929.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37930.cindex "process, querying"
37931.cindex "SIGUSR1"
37932On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37933(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37934a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37935Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37936processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37937second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37938order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37939send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37940
37941&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37942use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37943script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37944
37945
37946Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37947varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37948but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37949system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37950it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37951options:
37952.display
37953&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37954&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37955&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37956&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37957.endd
37958An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37959.code
37960164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3796110483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3796210492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37963 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3796410592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3796510628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37966.endd
37967The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37968been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37969
37970
37971
37972.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37973.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37974.cindex "queue" "grepping"
37975This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37976.code
37977exim -bpu
37978.endd
37979or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37980.code
37981exim -bp
37982.endd
37983The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37984contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37985
37986to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37987that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37988
37989.vlist
37990.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37991Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37992tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37993.code
37994exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37995.endd
37996.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37997Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37998tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37999
38000.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38001Match against the size field.
38002
38003.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38004Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38005
38006.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38007Match messages that are older than the given time.
38008
38009.vitem &*-z*&
38010Match only frozen messages.
38011
38012.vitem &*-x*&
38013Match only non-frozen messages.
38014
38015.new
38016.vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38017Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38018.wen
38019.endlist
38020
38021The following options control the format of the output:
38022
38023.vlist
38024.vitem &*-c*&
38025Display only the count of matching messages.
38026
38027.vitem &*-l*&
38028Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38029the default.
38030
38031.vitem &*-i*&
38032Display message ids only.
38033
38034.vitem &*-b*&
38035Brief format &-- one line per message.
38036
38037.vitem &*-R*&
38038Display messages in reverse order.
38039
38040.vitem &*-a*&
38041Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38042.endlist
38043
38044There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38045
38046
38047
38048.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38049.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38050.cindex "queue" "summary"
38051The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38052-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38053running a command such as
38054.code
38055exim -bp | exiqsumm
38056.endd
38057The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38058it, as in the following example:
38059.code
380603 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38061.endd
38062Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38063volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38064been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38065number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38066
38067A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38068domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38069the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38070respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38071domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38072separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38073sender.
38074
38075The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38076this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38077generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38078option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38079level"& addresses).
38080
38081
38082
38083
38084.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38085 "SECTextspeinf"
38086.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38087.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38088The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38089files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38090extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38091match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38092given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38093The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38094If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38095included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38096.display
38097&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38098.endd
38099If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38100
38101The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38102condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38103they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38104
38105By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38106makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38107large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38108option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38109case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38110
38111The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38112pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38113regular expression.
38114
38115The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38116if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38117
38118The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38119that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38120normally.
38121
38122Example of &%-M%&:
38123user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38124&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38125displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38126the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38127when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38128&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38129search term.
38130
38131If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38132ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38133whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38134If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38135autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38136
38137
38138.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38139.cindex "&'exipick'&"
38140John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38141lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38142of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38143the &%--help%& option.
38144
38145
38146.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38147.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38148.cindex "cycling logs"
38149.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38150The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38151&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38152you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38153&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38154for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38155There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38156.ilist
38157&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38158default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38159.next
38160&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38161&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38162overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38163configuration.
38164.endlist
38165
38166Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38167the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38168run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38169&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38170&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38171logs are handled similarly.
38172
38173If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38174&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38175to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38176any existing log files.
38177
38178If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38179the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38180using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38181setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38182root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38183.code
381841 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38185.endd
38186assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38187&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38188
38189
38190
38191.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38192.cindex "statistics"
38193.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38194A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38195information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38196. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38197. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38198
38199The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38200latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38201lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38202various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38203list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38204.code
38205eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38206.endd
38207By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38208messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38209both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38210are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38211addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38212options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38213also produced per user.
38214
38215The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38216histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38217hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38218example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38219as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38220
38221Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38222have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38223messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38224and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38225recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38226an entirely separate message.
38227
38228&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38229of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38230each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38231not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38232least one address that failed.
38233
38234The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38235or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38236transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38237(default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38238a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38239senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38240and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38241
38242The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38243came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38244without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38245
38246There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38247outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38248by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38249.code
38250perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38251.endd
38252
38253.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38254.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38255.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38256.cindex "checking access"
38257The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38258debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38259policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38260familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38261sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38262access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38263
38264The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38265two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38266.code
38267exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38268.endd
38269The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38270given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38271connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38272is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38273.code
38274Rejected:
38275550 Relay not permitted
38276.endd
38277When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38278for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38279options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38280that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38281you can use:
38282.code
38283exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38284 -f himself@there.example
38285.endd
38286Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38287mandatory arguments.
38288
38289Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38290while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38291&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38292
38293
38294
38295.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38296.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38297.cindex "building DBM files"
38298.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38299.cindex "lower casing"
38300.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38301The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38302the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38303&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38304names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38305can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38306
38307A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38308the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38309&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38310strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38311files.
38312
38313The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38314single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38315It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38316well.
38317
38318.cindex "USE_DB"
38319If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38320configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38321filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38322create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38323.code
38324exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38325.endd
38326reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38327&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38328
38329In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38330Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38331environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38332&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38333when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38334recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38335
38336If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38337finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38338option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38339this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38340&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38341There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38342&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38343return code is 2.
38344
38345
38346
38347
38348.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38349.cindex "retry" "times"
38350.cindex "&'exinext'&"
38351A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38352fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38353complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38354information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38355is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38356output. For example:
38357.code
38358$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38359kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38360 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38361 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38362 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38363roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38364 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38365 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38366 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38367 past final cutoff time
38368.endd
38369You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38370will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38371A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38372message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38373suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38374&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38375run very often.
38376
38377The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38378of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38379passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38380configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38381file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38382environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38383
38384
38385
38386.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38387.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38388.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38389Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38390uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38391arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38392second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38393
38394.ilist
38395&'retry'&: the database of retry information
38396.next
38397&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38398for remote hosts
38399.next
38400&'callout'&: the callout cache
38401.next
38402&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38403.next
38404&'misc'&: other hints data
38405.endlist
38406
38407The &'misc'& database is used for
38408
38409.ilist
38410Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38411.next
38412Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38413&(smtp)& transport)
38414.next
38415Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38416in a transport)
38417.endlist
38418
38419
38420
38421.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38422.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38423The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38424&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38425spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38426.code
38427exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38428.endd
38429Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38430.code
38431T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3843231-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38433.endd
38434The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38435of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38436transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38437a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38438address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38439transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38440to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38441and a textual description of the error.
38442
38443The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38444the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38445ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38446exceeded.
38447
38448Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38449consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38450waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38451one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38452may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38453may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38454cross-references.
38455
38456
38457
38458.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38459.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38460The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38461database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38462days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38463updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38464since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38465for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38466updated sufficiently often.
38467
38468The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38469followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38470the retry database:
38471.code
38472exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38473.endd
38474Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38475message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38476they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38477are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38478types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38479message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38480queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38481&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38482For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38483removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38484whenever it removes information from the database.
38485
38486Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38487needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38488down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38489first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38490records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38491
38492It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38493hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38494a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38495work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38496but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38497After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38498point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38499tidied.
38500
38501&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38502databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38503
38504
38505
38506
38507.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38508.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38509The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38510Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38511getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38512is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38513key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38514displayed.
38515
38516If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38517except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38518out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38519data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38520by new data, for example:
38521.code
38522> 4 951102:1000
38523.endd
38524resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38525sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38526used as optional separators.
38527
38528
38529
38530
38531.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38532.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38533.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38534.cindex "locking mailboxes"
38535The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38536Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38537&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38538a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38539the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38540argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38541second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38542is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38543is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38544
38545.vlist
38546.vitem &%-fcntl%&
38547Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38548
38549.vitem &%-flock%&
38550Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38551supports it.
38552
38553.vitem &%-interval%&
38554This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38555interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38556
38557.vitem &%-lockfile%&
38558Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38559
38560.vitem &%-mbx%&
38561Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38562
38563.vitem &%-q%&
38564Suppress verification output.
38565
38566.vitem &%-retries%&
38567This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38568the lock (default 10).
38569
38570.vitem &%-restore_time%&
38571This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38572locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38573example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38574subsequently sees.
38575
38576.vitem &%-timeout%&
38577This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38578timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38579default), a non-blocking call is used.
38580
38581.vitem &%-v%&
38582Generate verbose output.
38583.endlist
38584
38585If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38586default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38587mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38588&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38589requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38590file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38591more than 30 minutes old.
38592
38593The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38594&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38595to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38596&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38597number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38598can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38599
38600The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38601&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38602suppresses all output except error messages.
38603
38604A command such as
38605.code
38606exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38607.endd
38608runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38609.display
38610&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38611<&'some commands'&>
38612&`End`&
38613.endd
38614runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38615suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38616such as
38617.code
38618exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38619 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38620.endd
38621Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38622second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38623.ecindex IIDutils
38624
38625
38626. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38627. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38628
38629.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38630.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38631.cindex "X-windows"
38632.cindex "&'eximon'&"
38633.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38634.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38635The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38636about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38637perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38638such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38639monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38640
38641
38642
38643.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38644The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38645script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38646binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38647be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38648&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38649parameters are for.
38650
38651The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38652a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38653preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38654.code
38655EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38656.endd
38657(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38658the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38659overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38660&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38661syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38662
38663X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38664way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38665.code
38666Eximon*background: gray94
38667.endd
38668changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38669stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38670black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38671data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38672&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38673For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38674reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38675.code
38676xrdb -merge <<End
38677Eximon*highlight: gray
38678End
38679.endd
38680.cindex "admin user"
38681In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38682&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38683
38684The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38685contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38686if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38687binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38688versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38689
38690The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38691more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38692main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38693delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38694different parts of the display.
38695
38696
38697
38698
38699.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38700.cindex "stripchart"
38701The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38702be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38703&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38704configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38705it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38706hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38707received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38708period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38709parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38710
38711The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38712displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38713title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38714For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38715
38716It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38717a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38718to a single partition.
38719
38720.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38721This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38722the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38723this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38724100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38725SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38726&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38727
38728
38729
38730
38731.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38732.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38733.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38734.cindex "window size"
38735Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38736to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38737shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38738stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38739the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38740in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38741
38742When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38743currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38744size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38745remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38746
38747The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38748stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38749the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38750The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38751&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38752the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38753
38754Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38755built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38756START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38757
38758
38759
38760.section "The log display" "SECID267"
38761.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38762The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38763the main log is maintained.
38764To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38765removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38766The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38767syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38768to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38769
38770The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38771move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38772scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38773LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38774to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38775much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38776a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38777only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38778available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38779normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38780configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38781
38782Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38783and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38784respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38785It cannot go further back up the log.
38786
38787The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38788normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38789by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38790by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38791back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38792the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38793
38794Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38795There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38796the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38797happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38798&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38799^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38800
38801The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38802widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38803&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38804eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38805However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38806provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38807come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38808unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38809on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38810window.
38811
38812
38813
38814.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38815.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38816The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38817are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38818as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38819parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38820at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38821the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38822there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38823to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38824
38825When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38826and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38827with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38828pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38829type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38830such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38831of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38832
38833If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38834are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38835example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38836&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38837has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38838cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38839a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38840
38841While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38842else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38843queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38844pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38845
38846The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38847time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38848message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38849a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38850recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38851listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38852an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38853not shown.
38854
38855.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38856If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38857
38858The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38859of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38860The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38861available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38862display is updated.
38863
38864
38865
38866.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38867.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38868If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38869pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38870line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38871any selected text.
38872
38873If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38874MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38875set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38876value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38877run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38878.code
38879EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38880.endd
38881The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38882follows:
38883
38884.ilist
38885&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38886in a new text window.
38887.next
38888&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38889information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38890&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38891.next
38892&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38893displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38894amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38895option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38896.next
38897&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38898delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38899frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38900a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38901up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38902.next
38903&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38904that the message be frozen.
38905.next
38906.cindex "thawing messages"
38907.cindex "unfreezing messages"
38908.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38909&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38910that the message be thawed.
38911.next
38912.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38913&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38914that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38915for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38916.next
38917&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38918that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38919message.
38920.next
38921&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38922be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38923is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38924Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38925causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38926additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38927which case no action is taken.
38928.next
38929&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38930can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38931is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38932Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38933causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38934recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38935case no action is taken.
38936.next
38937&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38938mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38939.next
38940&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38941sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38942&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38943in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38944bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38945not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38946the address is qualified with that domain.
38947.endlist
38948
38949When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38950other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38951particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38952output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38953from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38954&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38955if no output is generated.
38956
38957The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38958thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38959&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38960force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38961
38962In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38963cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38964and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38965.ecindex IIDeximon
38966
38967
38968
38969
38970
38971. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38972. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38973
38974.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38975.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38976This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38977which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38978
38979For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38980Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38981existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38982chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38983security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38984its security as compared with other MTAs.
38985
38986What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38987have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38988absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38989as soon as possible.
38990
38991
38992.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38993.cindex "security" "build-time features"
38994There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38995to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38996Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38997penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38998
38999.ilist
39000ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39001start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39002filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39003the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39004&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39005default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39006
39007If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39008which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39009into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39010configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39011.next
39012
39013If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39014or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39015file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39016the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39017root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39018right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39019reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39020it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39021privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39022separate commands.
39023
39024.next
39025The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39026with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39027CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39028requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39029the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39030but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39031previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39032.next
39033If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39034is disabled.
39035.next
39036FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39037never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39038option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39039to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39040is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39041.endlist
39042
39043
39044
39045.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39046.cindex "setuid"
39047.cindex "root privilege"
39048The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39049privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39050example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39051may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39052discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39053is required for two things:
39054
39055.ilist
39056To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39057the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39058not required.
39059.next
39060To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39061perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39062configuration.
39063.endlist
39064
39065It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39066receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39067obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39068For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39069&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39070group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39071is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39072&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39073
39074Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39075abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39076&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39077
39078After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39079uid and gid in the following cases:
39080
39081.ilist
39082.oindex "&%-C%&"
39083.oindex "&%-D%&"
39084If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39085the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39086calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39087the calling process.
39088However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39089option may not be used at all.
39090If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39091can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39092user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39093.next
39094.oindex "&%-be%&"
39095.oindex "&%-bf%&"
39096.oindex "&%-bF%&"
39097If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39098(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39099calling process.
39100.next
39101If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39102process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39103uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39104runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39105testing address verification
39106.oindex "&%-bv%&"
39107.oindex "&%-bh%&"
39108(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39109option).
39110.next
39111For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39112remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39113.endlist
39114
39115The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39116
39117.ilist
39118A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39119user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39120function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39121will be used during message reception.
39122.next
39123A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39124job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39125.next
39126A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39127but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39128subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39129deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39130remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39131subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39132while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39133generating bounce and warning messages.
39134
39135While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39136process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39137this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39138gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39139.next
39140A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39141the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39142.endlist
39143
39144
39145
39146
39147.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39148.cindex "privilege, running without"
39149.cindex "unprivileged running"
39150.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39151Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39152operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39153by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39154gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39155(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39156routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39157to any other uid.
39158
39159.cindex SIGHUP
39160.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39161Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39162that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39163correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39164
39165An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39166to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39167process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39168when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39169SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39170
39171It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39172stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39173been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39174effect.
39175
39176If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39177set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39178to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39179
39180In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39181those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39182Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39183that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39184discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39185have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39186number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39187address this problem at this time.
39188
39189For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39190is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39191&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39192be used in the most straightforward way.
39193
39194If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39195number of restrictions on what you can do:
39196
39197.ilist
39198You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39199&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39200normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39201work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39202explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39203.next
39204Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39205not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39206.next
39207Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39208the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39209and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39210enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39211.next
39212Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39213some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39214
39215.olist
39216They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39217implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39218mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39219.next
39220You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39221owned by the Exim user.
39222.next
39223You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39224on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39225mailboxes need to be created manually.
39226.endlist olist
39227.endlist ilist
39228
39229
39230These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39231However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39232gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39233gives more security at essentially no cost.
39234
39235If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39236&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39237
39238
39239
39240
39241.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39242Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39243are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39244
39245
39246
39247.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39248.cindex "security" "local commands"
39249.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39250There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39251commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39252configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39253run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39254
39255.ilist
39256Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39257injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39258be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39259allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39260has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39261.next
39262A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39263&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39264&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39265hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39266NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39267forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39268need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39269.next
39270The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39271administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39272Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39273.next
39274Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39275taint checking might apply to their usage.
39276.next
39277Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39278administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39279instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39280.next
39281Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39282Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39283each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39284of opaque strings.
39285The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39286real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39287injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39288Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39289.endlist
39290
39291
39292
39293
39294.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39295.cindex "security" "data sources"
39296.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39297.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39298.cindex "PCRE" "security"
39299If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39300are some issues to be aware of:
39301
39302.ilist
39303Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39304.next
39305Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39306.next
39307Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39308data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39309"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39310expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39311when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39312possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39313data.
39314.next
39315It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39316&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39317items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39318.next
39319Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39320expected to yield one result.
39321.endlist
39322
39323
39324
39325
39326.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39327.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39328.cindex "IP source routing"
39329Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39330some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39331IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39332IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39333
39334
39335
39336.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39337Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39338be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39339
39340
39341
39342
39343.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39344.cindex "trusted users"
39345.cindex "admin user"
39346.cindex "privileged user"
39347.cindex "user" "trusted"
39348.cindex "user" "admin"
39349Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39350able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39351addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39352local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39353permit a remote host to be specified.
39354
39355.oindex "&%-f%&"
39356However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39357in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39358message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39359but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39360permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39361the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39362
39363Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39364other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39365the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39366as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39367group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39368
39369Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39370can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39371them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39372the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39373includes the contents of files on the spool.
39374
39375.oindex "&%-M%&"
39376.oindex "&%-q%&"
39377By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39378delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39379restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39380Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39381queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39382setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39383
39384Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39385the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39386the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39387group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39388the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39389unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39390files.
39391
39392By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39393introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39394setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39395This affects most of the checking options,
39396such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39397
39398
39399.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39400.cindex "spool directory" "files"
39401Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39402set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39403&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39404any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39405
39406
39407
39408.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39409Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39410of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39411with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39412to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39413this.
39414
39415
39416
39417.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39418The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39419are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39420Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39421converted output.
39422
39423
39424
39425.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39426Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39427to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39428does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39429arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39430
39431
39432
39433.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39434Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39435defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39436loading it.
39437
39438
39439.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39440.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39441A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39442&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39443The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39444that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39445conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39446
39447The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39448the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39449string.
39450
39451
39452
39453.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39454Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39455formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39456the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39457
39458
39459
39460.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39461These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39462enough to hold the result.
39463.ecindex IIDsecurcon
39464
39465
39466
39467
39468. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39469. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39470
39471.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39472.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39473.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39474.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39475.cindex "spool files" "editing"
39476A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39477followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39478the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39479kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39480two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39481is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39482themselves are recoverable.
39483
39484The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39485Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39486and should not be used as such.
39487
39488Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39489need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39490on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39491
39492.ilist
39493You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39494fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39495which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39496place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39497lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39498.next
39499.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39500If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39501&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39502cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39503.next
39504If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39505.next
39506If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39507signature.
39508.endlist
39509All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39510
39511Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39512its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39513files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39514the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39515the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39516is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39517file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39518-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39519attempt.
39520
39521Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39522These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39523They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39524relics of crashes and can be removed.
39525
39526.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39527.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39528.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39529The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39530process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39531gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39532message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39533normally the Exim user.
39534
39535The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39536transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39537empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39538in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39539created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39540&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39541leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39542&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39543
39544The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39545was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39546start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39547warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39548
39549There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39550order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39551
39552.vlist
39553.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39554This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39555&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39556recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39557this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39558identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39559the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39560the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39561the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39562newlines.
39563
39564.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39565A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39566defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39567The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39568starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39569character. It may contain internal newlines.
39570
39571.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39572A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39573Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39574length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39575starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39576character. It may contain internal newlines.
39577
39578.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39579This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39580&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39581
39582.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39583This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39584lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39585transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39586messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39587
39588.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39589This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39590(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39591time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39592hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39593
39594.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39595The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39596&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39597
39598.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39599The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39600&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39601
39602.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39603This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39604present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39605
39606.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39607This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39608present if the number is greater than zero.
39609
39610.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39611This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39612file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39613
39614.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39615.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39616The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39617
39618.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39619This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39620command.
39621
39622.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39623This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39624the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39625messages.
39626
39627.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39628If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39629the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39630&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39631
39632.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39633This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39634address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39635
39636.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39637.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39638.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39639This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39640if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39641received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39642
39643.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39644For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39645unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39646ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39647supplied by the remote host, if any.
39648
39649.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39650This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39651which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39652generated messages.
39653
39654.vitem &%-local%&
39655The message is from a local sender.
39656
39657.vitem &%-localerror%&
39658The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39659
39660.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39661This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39662when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39663variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39664
39665.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39666The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39667Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39668
39669.vitem &%-N%&
39670A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39671actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39672&%-N%& is assumed.
39673
39674.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39675This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39676the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39677
39678.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39679The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39680to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39681
39682.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39683If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39684of &$spam_score_int$&.
39685
39686.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39687The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39688rather than Unix-format.
39689The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39690There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39691
39692.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39693A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39694certificate was verified by the server.
39695
39696.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39697When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39698name of the cipher suite that was used.
39699
39700.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39701When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39702was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39703certificate.
39704.endlist
39705
39706.new
39707Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39708corresponding data is untrusted.
39709.wen
39710
39711Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39712is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39713line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39714is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39715the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39716balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39717to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39718original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39719addresses are complete.
39720
39721If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39722the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39723Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39724tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39725right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39726follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39727.code
39728YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39729NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39730NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39731.endd
39732After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39733This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39734recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39735delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39736example:
39737.code
397384
39739editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39740darcy@austen.fict.example
39741rdo@foundation
39742alice@wonderland.fict.example
39743.endd
39744However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39745result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39746line is of the following form:
39747.display
39748<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39749 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39750.endd
39751The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39752the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39753fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39754original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39755envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39756length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39757characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39758that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39759
39760
39761A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39762which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39763when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39764character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39765embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39766following:
39767
39768.table2 50pt
39769.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39770.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39771.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39772.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39773.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39774.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39775.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39776.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39777.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39778.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39779.endtable
39780
39781Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39782purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39783typical set of headers:
39784.code
39785111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39786id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39787049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39788038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39789042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39790049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39791099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39792darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39793104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39794darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39795038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39796.endd
39797The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39798&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39799unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39800.ecindex IIDforspo1
39801.ecindex IIDforspo2
39802.ecindex IIDforspo3
39803
39804.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39805The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39806an ASCII newline character.
39807However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39808can have an alternate format.
39809This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39810The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39811suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39812ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39813Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39814There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39815
39816. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39817. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39818
39819.chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39820 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
39821
39822.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39823.cindex "DKIM"
39824
39825DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39826linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39827be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39828DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39829
39830As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39831by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39832any original DKIM signature.
39833
39834DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39835It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39836
39837Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39838.olist
39839Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39840It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39841(including transport filters)
39842except cutthrough delivery.
39843.next
39844Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39845ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39846different signature contexts.
39847.endlist
39848
39849In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39850default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39851Exim's standard controls.
39852
39853Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39854on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39855
39856Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39857When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39858exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39859signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39860.code
398612009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39862 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39863 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39864 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39865.endd
39866
39867You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39868or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39869control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39870where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39871senders).
39872
39873
39874.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39875.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39876
39877For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39878Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39879.code
39880rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39881
39882Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39883Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39884.endd
39885
39886Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39887in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39888for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39889(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39890but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39891
39892Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39893These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39894
39895.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39896The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39897After expansion, this can be a list.
39898Each element in turn,
39899.new
39900lowercased,
39901.wen
39902is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39903while expanding the remaining signing options.
39904If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39905and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39906
39907.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39908This sets the key selector string.
39909After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39910Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39911variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39912option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39913If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39914and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39915
39916.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39917This sets the private key to use.
39918You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39919&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39920The result can either
39921.ilist
39922be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39923.next
39924with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39925be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39926.next
39927start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39928the private key
39929.next
39930be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39931be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39932is set.
39933.endlist
39934
39935To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39936.code
39937openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39938openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39939.endd
39940Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39941for the DNS TXT record.
39942See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39943
39944Under GnuTLS:
39945.code
39946certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39947certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39948.endd
39949
39950Note that RFC 8301 says:
39951.code
39952Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39953Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39954.endd
39955
39956.new
39957EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39958.wen
39959They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39960As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39961(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39962for some transition period.
39963The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39964for EC keys.
39965
39966OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39967.code
39968openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39969certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39970.endd
39971
39972To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39973.code
39974openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39975certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39976.endd
39977
39978.new
39979Exim also supports an alternate format
39980of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39981of the standard, but not adopted.
39982A future release will probably drop that support.
39983.wen
39984
39985.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39986Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39987.ilist
39988&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39989.next
39990&`sha256`& &-- the default
39991.next
39992&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39993.endlist
39994
39995Note that RFC 8301 says:
39996.code
39997rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39998.endd
39999
40000.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40001If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40002the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40003syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40004local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40005tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40006
40007.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40008This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40009The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40010The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40011only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40012
40013.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40014This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40015should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40016either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40017unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40018variables here.
40019
40020.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40021If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40022list of header names.
40023Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40024in the message signature.
40025When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40026whether or not each header is present in the message.
40027The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40028"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
40029
40030If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40031will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40032message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40033
40034A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
40035If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40036will be signed.
40037If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40038will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40039name will be appended.
40040
40041.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40042This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40043If not set, no such information will be included.
40044Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40045for the expiry tag
40046(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40047both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40048
40049RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40050
40051
40052.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40053.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40054
40055Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40056messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40057.new
40058.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40059Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40060the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40061The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40062processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40063.wen
40064
40065.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40066Performing verification sets up information used by the
40067&%authresults%& expansion item.
40068
40069.new
40070For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40071of this section can be ignored.
40072.wen
40073
40074The results of verification are made available to the
40075&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40076A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40077By default, the ACL is called once for each
40078syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40079If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40080If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40081summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40082
40083To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40084a large number of expansion variables
40085containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40086runtime of the ACL.
40087
40088Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40089more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40090&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40091&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40092
40093The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40094list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40095called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40096the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40097list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40098&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40099it defaults as:
40100.code
40101dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40102.endd
40103This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40104DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40105call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40106.code
40107dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40108.endd
40109This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40110and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40111You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40112.code
40113dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40114.endd
40115
40116If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40117&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40118
40119.new
40120Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40121(such as the From: header)
40122care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40123and for the domain part if identities.
40124The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40125.wen
40126
40127If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40128for each matching signature.
40129
40130
40131Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40132available (from most to least important):
40133
40134
40135.vlist
40136.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40137The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40138an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40139&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40140
40141.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40142Within the DKIM ACL,
40143a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40144.ilist
40145&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40146identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40147.next
40148&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40149More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40150.next
40151&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40152available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40153.next
40154&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40155.endlist
40156
40157This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40158This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40159hash-method or key-size:
40160.code
40161 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40162 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40163 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40164 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40165 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40166 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40167 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40168.endd
40169
40170So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40171after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40172colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40173This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40174
40175.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40176A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40177"fail" or "invalid". One of
40178.ilist
40179&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40180key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40181.next
40182&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40183record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40184.next
40185&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40186body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40187means that the message body was modified in transit.
40188.next
40189&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40190could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40191re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40192DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40193.endlist
40194
40195This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40196
40197.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40198The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40199an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40200reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40201
40202.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40203The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40204if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40205identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40206
40207.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40208The key record selector string.
40209
40210.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40211The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40212If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40213may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40214The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40215for EC keys.
40216
40217Note that RFC 8301 says:
40218.code
40219rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40220
40221DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40222algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40223.endd
40224
40225To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40226and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40227.new
40228or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40229processing of such signatures.
40230.wen
40231
40232.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40233The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40234
40235.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40236The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40237
40238.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40239A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40240(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40241Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40242not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40243strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40244
40245.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40246The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40247limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40248that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40249&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40250is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40251A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40252shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40253
40254.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40255UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40256When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40257
40258.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40259UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40260signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40261signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40262integer size comparisons against this value.
40263Note that Exim does not check this value.
40264
40265.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40266A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40267
40268.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40269"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40270
40271.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40272"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40273
40274.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40275Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40276in the key record.
40277
40278.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40279Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40280in the key record.
40281
40282.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40283Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40284
40285.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40286Number of bits in the key.
40287
40288Note that RFC 8301 says:
40289.code
40290Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40291less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40292.endd
40293
40294To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40295and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40296As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40297
40298.endlist
40299
40300In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40301
40302.vlist
40303.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40304ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40305for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40306(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40307verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40308
40309.code
40310# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40311warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40312 sender_domains = gmail.com
40313 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40314 dkim_status = none
40315.endd
40316
40317Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40318for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40319
40320.vitem &%dkim_status%&
40321ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40322results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40323to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40324
40325.code
40326deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40327 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40328 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40329 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40330.endd
40331
40332The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40333see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40334for more information of what they mean.
40335.endlist
40336
40337
40338
40339
40340.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40341.cindex SPF verification
40342
40343SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40344messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40345For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40346the &url(http://openspf.org).
40347. --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40348. --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40349. --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40350. --- discussion.
40351
40352Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40353This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40354
40355SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40356&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40357&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40358There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40359publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40360
40361For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40362.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40363Performing verification sets up information used by the
40364&%authresults%& expansion item.
40365
40366
40367.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40368.cindex ACL "spf condition"
40369The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40370It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40371and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40372Valid strings are:
40373.vlist
40374.vitem &%pass%&
40375The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40376
40377.vitem &%fail%&
40378The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40379domain in the envelope-from address.
40380
40381.vitem &%softfail%&
40382The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40383is a forgery.
40384
40385.vitem &%none%&
40386The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40387
40388.vitem &%neutral%&
40389The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40390published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40391its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40392
40393.vitem &%permerror%&
40394This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40395You may deny messages when this occurs.
40396
40397.vitem &%temperror%&
40398This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40399SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40400.endlist
40401
40402You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40403its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40404"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40405short-circuit fashion.
40406
40407Example:
40408.code
40409deny spf = fail
40410 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40411 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40412 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40413 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40414 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40415 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40416 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40417 ip=$sender_host_address
40418.endd
40419
40420When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40421variables:
40422
40423.cindex SPF "verification variables"
40424.vlist
40425.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40426.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40427 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40428 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40429 it for logging purposes.
40430
40431.vitem &$spf_received$&
40432.vindex &$spf_received$&
40433 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40434 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40435 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40436 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40437
40438 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40439 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40440
40441.vitem &$spf_result$&
40442.vindex &$spf_result$&
40443 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40444 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40445 temperror.
40446
40447.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40448.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40449 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40450 and required in order to obtain a result.
40451
40452.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40453.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40454 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40455 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40456.endlist
40457
40458
40459.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40460.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40461.cindex SPF "best guess"
40462In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40463"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40464SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40465capability.
40466Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40467for a description of what it means.
40468. --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40469
40470To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40471of the spf one. For example:
40472
40473.code
40474deny spf_guess = fail
40475 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40476.endd
40477
40478In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40479should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40480is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40481reject message.
40482
40483When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40484variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40485
40486Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40487what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40488&%spf_guess%& option.
40489For example, the following:
40490
40491.code
40492spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40493.endd
40494
40495would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40496
40497
40498.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40499.cindex lookup spf
40500A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40501address as the key and an IP address
40502.new
40503(v4 or v6)
40504.wen
40505as the database:
40506
40507.code
40508 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40509.endd
40510
40511The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40512&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40513
40514
40515
40516
40517
40518.new
40519.section DMARC SECDMARC
40520.cindex DMARC verification
40521
40522DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40523to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40524email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40525should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40526&url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40527
40528If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40529the libopendmarc library is used.
40530
40531For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40532&url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40533to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite rpm package
40534repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40535SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40536This description assumes
40537that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40538are in /usr/local/lib.
40539
40540. subsection
40541
40542There are three main-configuration options:
40543.cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40544
40545The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40546.oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40547defines the location of a text file of valid
40548top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40549during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40550the most current version can be downloaded
40551from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/, currently pointing
40552at https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat)
40553See also util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40554The default for the option is /etc/exim/opendmarc.tlds.
40555
40556
40557The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40558.oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40559defines the location of a file to log results
40560of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40561contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40562which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40563reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40564directory of this file is writable by the user
40565exim runs as.
40566The default is unset.
40567
40568The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40569.oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40570defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40571forensic report detailing alignment failures
40572if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40573and you have configured Exim to send them.
40574If set, this is expanded and used for the
40575From: header line; the address is extracted
40576from it and used for the envelope from.
40577If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40578the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40579envelope from.
40580
40581. I wish we had subsections...
40582
40583.cindex DMARC controls
40584By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40585non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40586status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40587use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40588DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40589DMARC with a control setting:
40590.code
40591 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40592.endd
40593A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40594exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40595Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40596results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40597be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40598reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40599forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40600exim will send these forensic emails. It's also advised that you
40601configure a dmarc_forensic_sender because the default sender address
40602construction might be inadequate.
40603.code
40604 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40605.endd
40606(AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40607not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40608your exim config. If you don't tell it to send them, it will not
40609send them.)
40610
40611There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40612the DATA acl.
40613
40614. subsection
40615
40616DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40617"dmarc_status" ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40618call the "spf" condition first in the ACLs, then the "dmarc_status"
40619condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40620for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40621up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40622occurs until a "dmarc_status" condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40623
40624The dmarc_status condition takes a list of strings on its
40625right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40626on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40627mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40628.display
40629&'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40630&'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40631&'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40632&'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40633&'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40634&'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40635&'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40636&'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40637.endd
40638You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40639meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40640"accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40641short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40642DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40643strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40644fails.
40645
40646Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40647supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40648result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40649
40650Performing the check sets up information used by the
40651&%authresults%& expansion item.
40652
40653Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40654processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40655expansion variables are available:
40656
40657&$dmarc_status$&
40658.vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40659.cindex DMARC result
40660is a one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40661thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40662DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40663(if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40664in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40665
40666&$dmarc_status_text$&
40667.vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40668is a slightly longer, human readable status.
40669
40670&$dmarc_used_domain$&
40671.vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40672is the domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40673
40674&$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40675.vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40676is the policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40677are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40678is any error, including no DMARC record.
40679
40680. subsection
40681
40682By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
40683non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
40684create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
40685you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
40686DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
40687than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
40688processing or failure delivery issues).
40689
40690In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
40691tools, you need to:
40692.ilist
40693Configure the global setting dmarc_history_file
40694.next
40695Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
40696import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
40697.endlist
40698
40699In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
40700.ilist
40701Configure the global setting dmarc_forensic_sender
40702.next
40703Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
40704enable sending DMARC forensic reports
40705.endlist
40706
40707. subsection
40708
40709Example usage:
40710.code
40711(RCPT ACL)
40712 warn domains = +local_domains
40713 hosts = +local_hosts
40714 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40715
40716 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
40717 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40718
40719 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
40720 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
40721
40722(DATA ACL)
40723 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
40724 !authenticated = *
40725 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
40726
40727 warn dmarc_status = !accept
40728 !authenticated = *
40729 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
40730
40731 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
40732 !authenticated = *
40733 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
40734 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
40735
40736 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
40737 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
40738 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
40739
40740 deny dmarc_status = reject
40741 !authenticated = *
40742 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
40743
40744 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
40745.endd
40746
40747.wen
40748
40749
40750
40751
40752. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40753. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40754
40755.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40756 "Proxy support"
40757.cindex "proxy support"
40758.cindex "proxy" "access via"
40759
40760A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40761Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40762
40763
40764.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40765.cindex proxy inbound
40766.cindex proxy "server side"
40767.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40768.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40769
40770Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40771that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40772To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40773in Local/Makefile.
40774
40775It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40776&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40777
40778The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40779such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40780to distribute load.
40781Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40782the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40783There is no logging if a host passes or
40784fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40785recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40786
40787Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40788main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40789hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40790Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40791automatically determines which version is in use.
40792
40793The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40794and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40795negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40796Exim and the proxy server.
40797
40798The following expansion variables are usable
40799(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40800of the proxy):
40801.display
40802&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40803&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40804&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40805&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40806&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40807.endd
40808If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40809there was a protocol error.
40810The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40811will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40812
40813Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40814per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40815evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40816handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40817With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40818to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40819In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40820need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40821A possible solution is:
40822.display
40823 # Set max number of connections per host
40824 LIMIT = 5
40825 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40826 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40827
40828 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40829 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40830.endd
40831
40832
40833
40834.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40835.cindex proxy outbound
40836.cindex proxy "client side"
40837.cindex proxy SOCKS
40838.cindex SOCKS proxy
40839Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40840using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40841The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40842Local/Makefile.
40843
40844Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40845on an smtp transport.
40846The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40847(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40848Each proxy specifier is a list
40849(space-separated by default) where the initial element
40850is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40851
40852Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40853The list of options is in the following table:
40854.display
40855&'auth '& authentication method
40856&'name '& authentication username
40857&'pass '& authentication password
40858&'port '& tcp port
40859&'tmo '& connection timeout
40860&'pri '& priority
40861&'weight '& selection bias
40862.endd
40863
40864More details on each of these options follows:
40865
40866.ilist
40867.cindex authentication "to proxy"
40868.cindex proxy authentication
40869&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40870Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40871for access to the proxy.
40872Default is &"none"&.
40873.next
40874&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40875Default is empty.
40876.next
40877&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40878Default is empty.
40879.next
40880&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40881Default is 1080.
40882.next
40883&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40884Default is 5.
40885.next
40886&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40887higher values being tried first.
40888The default priority is 1.
40889.next
40890&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40891Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40892weighted by this value.
40893The default value for selection bias is 1.
40894.endlist
40895
40896Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40897and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40898overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40899
40900.section Logging SECTproxyLog
40901To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40902add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40903This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40904
40905. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40906. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40907
40908.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40909 "Internationalisation""
40910.cindex internationalisation "email address"
40911.cindex EAI
40912.cindex i18n
40913.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40914
40915Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40916To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40917Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40918
40919If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40920instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40921requirement, upon libidn2.
40922
40923.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40924.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40925The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40926a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40927accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40928SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40929
40930If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40931international handling for the message is enabled and
40932the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40933
40934The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40935message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40936whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40937when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40938
40939Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40940UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40941require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40942the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40943
40944HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40945components expanded to a-label form,
40946and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40947form of the name.
40948
40949.cindex log protocol
40950.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40951.cindex i18n logging
40952Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40953prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40954
40955The following expansion operators can be used:
40956.code
40957${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40958${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40959${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40960${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40961.endd
40962
40963.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40964.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40965The RCPT ACL
40966may use the following modifier:
40967.display
40968control = utf8_downconvert
40969control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40970.endd
40971This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40972a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40973Message Submission Agent context.
40974If a value is appended it may be:
40975.display
40976&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40977&`0 `& no downconversion
40978&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40979.endd
40980
40981If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40982is initially set to -1.
40983
40984The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40985If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40986and it overrides any previously set value.
40987
40988
40989There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40990Configurations supporting these should inspect
40991&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40992
40993There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40994Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40995for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40996
40997There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40998and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40999
41000
41001
41002.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41003To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41004the following expansion operator can be used:
41005.code
41006${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41007.endd
41008
41009The string is converted from the charset specified by
41010the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41011or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41012to the
41013modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41014with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41015(which has to be a single character)
41016are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41017<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41018
41019The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41020The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41021
41022This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41023by many other IMAP servers.
41024
41025Examples:
41026.display
41027&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41028&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41029&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41030.endd
41031
41032Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41033must be representable in UTF-16.
41034
41035
41036. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41037. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41038
41039.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41040 "Events"
41041.cindex events
41042
41043The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41044of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41045actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41046processing actions.
41047
41048Most installations will never need to use Events.
41049The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41050in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41051
41052There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41053The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41054a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41055
41056Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41057An example might look like:
41058.cindex logging custom
41059.code
41060event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41061{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41062 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41063 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41064 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41065 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41066 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41067 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41068 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41069} {}}
41070.endd
41071
41072Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41073The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41074expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41075
41076.new
41077The current list of events is:
41078.wen
41079.display
41080&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41081&`msg:complete after main `& per message
41082&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41083&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41084&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41085&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
41086&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41087&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41088&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41089&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41090&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41091&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41092&`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41093.endd
41094New event types may be added in future.
41095
41096The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41097event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41098or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41099
41100The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41101before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41102can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41103
41104The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41105should define the event action.
41106
41107An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41108with the event type:
41109.display
41110&`dane:fail `& failure reason
41111&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41112&`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41113&`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41114&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41115&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41116&`msg:host:defer `& error string
41117&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41118&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41119&`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41120.endd
41121
41122The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41123
41124For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41125however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41126the course of its processing:
41127.ilist
41128variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41129transport call
41130.next
41131acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41132and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41133.endlist
41134Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41135a useful way of writing to the main log.
41136
41137The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41138return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41139following will be forced:
41140.display
41141&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41142&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41143&`smtp:connect `& close connection
41144.endd
41145All other message types ignore the result string, and
41146no other use is made of it.
41147
41148For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41149then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41150the target system.
41151
41152For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41153chain element received on the connection.
41154For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41155loaded locally.
41156
41157. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41158. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41159
41160.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41161 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41162.cindex "adding drivers"
41163.cindex "new drivers, adding"
41164.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41165The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41166authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41167
41168.olist
41169Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41170existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41171.next
41172Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41173.display
41174<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41175.endd
41176where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41177code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41178should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41179.next
41180Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41181.code
41182#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41183.endd
41184.next
41185Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41186and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41187.next
41188Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41189near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41190Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41191As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41192simple form that most lookups have.
41193.next
41194Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41195&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41196driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41197.next
41198Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41199definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41200.next
41201Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41202&_src_&.
41203.next
41204Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41205as for other drivers and lookups.
41206.endlist
41207
41208Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41209proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41210occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41211options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41212searched using a binary chop procedure.
41213
41214There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41215the interface that is expected.
41216
41217
41218
41219
41220. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41221. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41222
41223. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41224. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41225. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41226. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41227. processors.
41228. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41229
41230.literal xml
41231<?sdop
41232 format="newpage"
41233 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41234 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41235?>
41236.literal off
41237
41238.makeindex "Options index" "option"
41239.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41240.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41241
41242
41243. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41244. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////